Index: ChangeLog
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3 @c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003
4 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 @c
6 @c %**start of header
7 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9 @setfilename gdb.info
10 @c
11 @include gdb-cfg.texi
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @syncodeindex ky cp
24
25 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
26 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
27 @syncodeindex vr cp
28 @syncodeindex fn cp
29
30 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
31 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
32 @set EDITION Ninth
33
34 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
35 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
36
37 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
38
39 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
40 @c manuals to an info tree.
41 @dircategory Programming & development tools.
42 @direntry
43 * Gdb: (gdb). The @sc{gnu} debugger.
44 @end direntry
45
46 @ifinfo
47 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
48
49
50 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
51 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
52 Version @value{GDBVN}.
53
54 Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,@*
55 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
56
57 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
58 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
59 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
60 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
61 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
62 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
63
64 (a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
65 freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
66 published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
67 development.''
68 @end ifinfo
69
70 @titlepage
71 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
72 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
73 @sp 1
74 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
75 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
76 @page
77 @tex
78 {\parskip=0pt
79 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
80 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
81 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
82 }
83 @end tex
84
85 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
86 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
87 1996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
88 @sp 2
89 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
90 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, @*
91 Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA @*
92 ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
93
94 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
95 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
96 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
97 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
98 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
99 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
100
101 (a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
102 freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
103 published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
104 development.''
105 @end titlepage
106 @page
107
108 @ifnottex
109 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
110
111 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
112
113 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
114
115 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} Version
116 @value{GDBVN}.
117
118 Copyright (C) 1988-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
119
120 @menu
121 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
122 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
123
124 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
125 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
126 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
127 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
128 * Stack:: Examining the stack
129 * Source:: Examining source files
130 * Data:: Examining data
131 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
132 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
133 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
134
135 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
136
137 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
138 * Altering:: Altering execution
139 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
140 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
141 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
142 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
143 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
144 * Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
145 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
146 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
147 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
148 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
149 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
150
151 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
152 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
153
154 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
155 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
156 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
157 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
158 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
159 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
160 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
161 how you can copy and share GDB
162 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
163 * Index:: Index
164 @end menu
165
166 @end ifnottex
167
168 @contents
169
170 @node Summary
171 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
172
173 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
174 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
175 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
176
177 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
178 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
179
180 @itemize @bullet
181 @item
182 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
183
184 @item
185 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
186
187 @item
188 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
189
190 @item
191 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
192 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
193 @end itemize
194
195 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C++.
196 For more information, see @ref{Support,,Supported languages}.
197 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
198
199 @cindex Modula-2
200 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
201 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
202
203 @cindex Pascal
204 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
205 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
206 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
207 syntax.
208
209 @cindex Fortran
210 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
211 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
212 underscore.
213
214 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
215 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
216
217 @menu
218 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
219 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
220 @end menu
221
222 @node Free Software
223 @unnumberedsec Free software
224
225 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
226 General Public License
227 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
228 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
229 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
230 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
231 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
232 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
233
234 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
235 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
236 from anyone else.
237
238 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
239
240 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
241 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
242 include with the free software. Many of our most important
243 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
244 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
245 when an important free software package does not come with a free
246 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
247 gaps today.
248
249 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
250 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
251 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
252 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
253 them from the free software world.
254
255 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
256 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
257 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
258 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
259 contract to make it non-free.
260
261 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
262 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
263 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
264 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
265 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
266 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
267 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
268
269 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
270 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
271 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
272 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
273
274 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
275 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
276 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
277 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
278 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
279 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
280 community.
281
282 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
283 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
284 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
285 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
286 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
287 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
288 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
289 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
290 of the manual.
291
292 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
293 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
294 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
295 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
296 manual to replace it.
297
298 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
299 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
300 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
301 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
302 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
303 the free software community.
304
305 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
306 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
307 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
308 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
309 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
310 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
311 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
312 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
313 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
314
315 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
316 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
317 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
318 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
319 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
320 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
321 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
322 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
323
324 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
325 published by other publishers, at
326 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
327
328 @node Contributors
329 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
330
331 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
332 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
333 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
334 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
335 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
336 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
337 blow-by-blow account.
338
339 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
340
341 @quotation
342 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
343 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
344 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
345 @end quotation
346
347 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
348 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
349 releases:
350 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
351 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
352 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
353 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
354 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
355 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
356 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
357 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
358 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
359
360 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
361 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
362
363 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
364 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
365 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
366 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
367 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
368
369 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
370 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
371 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
372
373 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
374 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
375
376 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
377
378 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
379 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
380 support.
381 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
382 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
383 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
384 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
385 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
386 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
387 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
388 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
389 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
390 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
391 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
392 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
393 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
394 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
395 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
396 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
397
398 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
399
400 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
401 libraries.
402
403 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
404 about several machine instruction sets.
405
406 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
407 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
408 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
409 and RDI targets, respectively.
410
411 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
412 command-line editing and command history.
413
414 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
415 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
416
417 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
418 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
419 symbols.
420
421 Hitachi America, Ltd. sponsored the support for H8/300, H8/500, and
422 Super-H processors.
423
424 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
425
426 Mitsubishi sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D processors.
427
428 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
429
430 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
431
432 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
433
434 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
435 watchpoints.
436
437 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
438
439 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
440
441 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
442 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
443
444 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
445 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
446 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
447 compiler, and the terminal user interface: Ben Krepp, Richard Title,
448 John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann, Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve
449 Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase provided HP-specific
450 information in this manual.
451
452 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
453 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
454
455 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
456 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
457 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
458 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
459 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
460 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
461 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
462 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
463 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
464 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
465 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
466 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
467 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
468 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
469 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
470
471 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
472 Hat.
473
474 @node Sample Session
475 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
476
477 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
478 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
479 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
480
481 @iftex
482 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
483 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
484 @end iftex
485
486 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
487 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
488
489 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
490 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
491 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
492 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
493 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
494 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
495 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
496 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
497 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
498
499 @smallexample
500 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
501 $ @b{./m4}
502 @b{define(foo,0000)}
503
504 @b{foo}
505 0000
506 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
507
508 @b{bar}
509 0000
510 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
511
512 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
513 @b{baz}
514 @b{C-d}
515 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
516 @end smallexample
517
518 @noindent
519 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
520
521 @smallexample
522 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
523 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
524 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
525 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
526 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
527 the conditions.
528 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
529 for details.
530
531 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
532 (@value{GDBP})
533 @end smallexample
534
535 @noindent
536 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
537 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
538 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
539 that examples fit in this manual.
540
541 @smallexample
542 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
543 @end smallexample
544
545 @noindent
546 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
547 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
548 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
549 @code{break} command.
550
551 @smallexample
552 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
553 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
554 @end smallexample
555
556 @noindent
557 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
558 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
559 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
560
561 @smallexample
562 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
563 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
564 @b{define(foo,0000)}
565
566 @b{foo}
567 0000
568 @end smallexample
569
570 @noindent
571 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
572 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
573 context where it stops.
574
575 @smallexample
576 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
577
578 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
579 at builtin.c:879
580 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
581 @end smallexample
582
583 @noindent
584 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
585 the next line of the current function.
586
587 @smallexample
588 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
589 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
590 : nil,
591 @end smallexample
592
593 @noindent
594 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
595 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
596 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
597 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
598
599 @smallexample
600 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
601 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
602 at input.c:530
603 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
604 @end smallexample
605
606 @noindent
607 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
608 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
609 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
610 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
611 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
612 stack frame for each active subroutine.
613
614 @smallexample
615 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
616 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
617 at input.c:530
618 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
619 at builtin.c:882
620 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
621 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
622 at macro.c:71
623 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
624 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
625 @end smallexample
626
627 @noindent
628 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
629 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
630 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
631
632 @smallexample
633 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
634 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
635 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
636 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
637 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
638 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
639 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
640 : xstrdup(rq);
641 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
642 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
643 @end smallexample
644
645 @noindent
646 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
647 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
648 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
649 (@code{print}) to see their values.
650
651 @smallexample
652 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
653 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
654 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
655 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
656 @end smallexample
657
658 @noindent
659 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
660 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
661 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
662
663 @smallexample
664 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
665 533 xfree(rquote);
666 534
667 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
668 : xstrdup (lq);
669 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
670 : xstrdup (rq);
671 537
672 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
673 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
674 540 @}
675 541
676 542 void
677 @end smallexample
678
679 @noindent
680 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
681 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
682
683 @smallexample
684 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
685 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
686 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
687 540 @}
688 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
689 $3 = 9
690 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
691 $4 = 7
692 @end smallexample
693
694 @noindent
695 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
696 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
697 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
698 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
699 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
700 assignments.
701
702 @smallexample
703 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
704 $5 = 7
705 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
706 $6 = 9
707 @end smallexample
708
709 @noindent
710 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
711 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
712 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
713 example that caused trouble initially:
714
715 @smallexample
716 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
717 Continuing.
718
719 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
720
721 baz
722 0000
723 @end smallexample
724
725 @noindent
726 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
727 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
728 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
729
730 @smallexample
731 @b{C-d}
732 Program exited normally.
733 @end smallexample
734
735 @noindent
736 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
737 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
738 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
739
740 @smallexample
741 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
742 @end smallexample
743
744 @node Invocation
745 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
746
747 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
748 The essentials are:
749 @itemize @bullet
750 @item
751 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
752 @item
753 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{C-d} to exit.
754 @end itemize
755
756 @menu
757 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
758 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
759 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
760 * Logging output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
761 @end menu
762
763 @node Invoking GDB
764 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
765
766 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
767 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
768
769 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
770 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
771
772 The command-line options described here are designed
773 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
774 options may effectively be unavailable.
775
776 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
777 specifying an executable program:
778
779 @smallexample
780 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
781 @end smallexample
782
783 @noindent
784 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
785 specified:
786
787 @smallexample
788 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
789 @end smallexample
790
791 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
792 to debug a running process:
793
794 @smallexample
795 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
796 @end smallexample
797
798 @noindent
799 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
800 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
801
802 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
803 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
804 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
805 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
806 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
807
808 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
809 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
810 option processing.
811 @smallexample
812 gdb --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
813 @end smallexample
814 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
815 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
816
817 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
818 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
819
820 @smallexample
821 @value{GDBP} -silent
822 @end smallexample
823
824 @noindent
825 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
826 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
827
828 @noindent
829 Type
830
831 @smallexample
832 @value{GDBP} -help
833 @end smallexample
834
835 @noindent
836 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
837 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
838
839 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
840 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
841 @samp{-x} option is used.
842
843
844 @menu
845 * File Options:: Choosing files
846 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
847 @end menu
848
849 @node File Options
850 @subsection Choosing files
851
852 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
853 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
854 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
855 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
856 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
857 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
858 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
859 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
860 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
861 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
862 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
863 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
864 prefixing it with @file{./}, eg. @file{./12345}.
865
866 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
867 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
868 argument and ignore it.
869
870 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
871 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
872 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
873 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
874 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
875
876 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
877 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
878 @c it.
879
880 @table @code
881 @item -symbols @var{file}
882 @itemx -s @var{file}
883 @cindex @code{--symbols}
884 @cindex @code{-s}
885 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
886
887 @item -exec @var{file}
888 @itemx -e @var{file}
889 @cindex @code{--exec}
890 @cindex @code{-e}
891 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
892 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
893
894 @item -se @var{file}
895 @cindex @code{--se}
896 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
897 file.
898
899 @item -core @var{file}
900 @itemx -c @var{file}
901 @cindex @code{--core}
902 @cindex @code{-c}
903 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
904
905 @item -c @var{number}
906 @item -pid @var{number}
907 @itemx -p @var{number}
908 @cindex @code{--pid}
909 @cindex @code{-p}
910 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
911 If there is no such process, @value{GDBN} will attempt to open a core
912 file named @var{number}.
913
914 @item -command @var{file}
915 @itemx -x @var{file}
916 @cindex @code{--command}
917 @cindex @code{-x}
918 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
919 Files,, Command files}.
920
921 @item -directory @var{directory}
922 @itemx -d @var{directory}
923 @cindex @code{--directory}
924 @cindex @code{-d}
925 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
926
927 @item -m
928 @itemx -mapped
929 @cindex @code{--mapped}
930 @cindex @code{-m}
931 @emph{Warning: this option depends on operating system facilities that are not
932 supported on all systems.}@*
933 If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the @code{mmap}
934 system call, you can use this option
935 to have @value{GDBN} write the symbols from your
936 program into a reusable file in the current directory. If the program you are debugging is
937 called @file{/tmp/fred}, the mapped symbol file is @file{/tmp/fred.syms}.
938 Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions notice the presence of this file,
939 and can quickly map in symbol information from it, rather than reading
940 the symbol table from the executable program.
941
942 The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where @value{GDBN}
943 is run. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN} symbol
944 table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
945
946 @item -r
947 @itemx -readnow
948 @cindex @code{--readnow}
949 @cindex @code{-r}
950 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
951 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
952 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
953
954 @end table
955
956 You typically combine the @code{-mapped} and @code{-readnow} options in
957 order to build a @file{.syms} file that contains complete symbol
958 information. (@xref{Files,,Commands to specify files}, for information
959 on @file{.syms} files.) A simple @value{GDBN} invocation to do nothing
960 but build a @file{.syms} file for future use is:
961
962 @smallexample
963 gdb -batch -nx -mapped -readnow programname
964 @end smallexample
965
966 @node Mode Options
967 @subsection Choosing modes
968
969 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
970 batch mode or quiet mode.
971
972 @table @code
973 @item -nx
974 @itemx -n
975 @cindex @code{--nx}
976 @cindex @code{-n}
977 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
978 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
979 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
980 files}.
981
982 @item -quiet
983 @itemx -silent
984 @itemx -q
985 @cindex @code{--quiet}
986 @cindex @code{--silent}
987 @cindex @code{-q}
988 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
989 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
990
991 @item -batch
992 @cindex @code{--batch}
993 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
994 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
995 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
996 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
997 in the command files.
998
999 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1000 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1001 make this more useful, the message
1002
1003 @smallexample
1004 Program exited normally.
1005 @end smallexample
1006
1007 @noindent
1008 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1009 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1010 mode.
1011
1012 @item -nowindows
1013 @itemx -nw
1014 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1015 @cindex @code{-nw}
1016 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1017 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1018 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1019
1020 @item -windows
1021 @itemx -w
1022 @cindex @code{--windows}
1023 @cindex @code{-w}
1024 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1025 used if possible.
1026
1027 @item -cd @var{directory}
1028 @cindex @code{--cd}
1029 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1030 instead of the current directory.
1031
1032 @item -fullname
1033 @itemx -f
1034 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1035 @cindex @code{-f}
1036 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1037 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1038 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1039 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1040 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1041 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1042 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1043 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1044 frame.
1045
1046 @item -epoch
1047 @cindex @code{--epoch}
1048 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1049 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1050 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1051 separate window.
1052
1053 @item -annotate @var{level}
1054 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1055 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1056 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1057 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1058 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1059 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1060 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1061 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1062 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1063
1064 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseeded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1065 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1066
1067 @item -async
1068 @cindex @code{--async}
1069 Use the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1070 @value{GDBN} processes all events, such as user keyboard input, via a
1071 special event loop. This allows @value{GDBN} to accept and process user
1072 commands in parallel with the debugged process being
1073 run@footnote{@value{GDBN} built with @sc{djgpp} tools for
1074 MS-DOS/MS-Windows supports this mode of operation, but the event loop is
1075 suspended when the debuggee runs.}, so you don't need to wait for
1076 control to return to @value{GDBN} before you type the next command.
1077 (@emph{Note:} as of version 5.1, the target side of the asynchronous
1078 operation is not yet in place, so @samp{-async} does not work fully
1079 yet.)
1080 @c FIXME: when the target side of the event loop is done, the above NOTE
1081 @c should be removed.
1082
1083 When the standard input is connected to a terminal device, @value{GDBN}
1084 uses the asynchronous event loop by default, unless disabled by the
1085 @samp{-noasync} option.
1086
1087 @item -noasync
1088 @cindex @code{--noasync}
1089 Disable the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1090
1091 @item --args
1092 @cindex @code{--args}
1093 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1094 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1095 This option stops option processing.
1096
1097 @item -baud @var{bps}
1098 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1099 @cindex @code{--baud}
1100 @cindex @code{-b}
1101 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1102 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1103
1104 @item -tty @var{device}
1105 @itemx -t @var{device}
1106 @cindex @code{--tty}
1107 @cindex @code{-t}
1108 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1109 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1110
1111 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1112 @item -tui
1113 @cindex @code{--tui}
1114 Activate the Terminal User Interface when starting.
1115 The Terminal User Interface manages several text windows on the terminal,
1116 showing source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1117 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}).
1118 Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs
1119 (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1120
1121 @c @item -xdb
1122 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1123 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1124 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1125 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1126 @c systems.
1127
1128 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1129 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1130 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1131 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1132 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1133 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1134
1135 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1136 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1137 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included in @var{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1138 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3,
1139 can be selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}. Earlier @sc{gdb/mi}
1140 interfaces are not supported.
1141
1142 @item -write
1143 @cindex @code{--write}
1144 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1145 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1146 (@pxref{Patching}).
1147
1148 @item -statistics
1149 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1150 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1151 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1152
1153 @item -version
1154 @cindex @code{--version}
1155 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1156 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1157
1158 @end table
1159
1160 @node Quitting GDB
1161 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1162 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1163 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1164
1165 @table @code
1166 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1167 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1168 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1169 @itemx q
1170 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1171 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{C-d}). If you
1172 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1173 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1174 error code.
1175 @end table
1176
1177 @cindex interrupt
1178 An interrupt (often @kbd{C-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1179 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1180 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1181 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1182 until a time when it is safe.
1183
1184 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1185 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1186 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
1187
1188 @node Shell Commands
1189 @section Shell commands
1190
1191 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1192 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1193 just use the @code{shell} command.
1194
1195 @table @code
1196 @kindex shell
1197 @cindex shell escape
1198 @item shell @var{command string}
1199 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1200 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1201 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1202 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1203 @end table
1204
1205 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1206 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1207 @value{GDBN}:
1208
1209 @table @code
1210 @kindex make
1211 @cindex calling make
1212 @item make @var{make-args}
1213 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1214 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1215 @end table
1216
1217 @node Logging output
1218 @section Logging output
1219 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1220
1221 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1222 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1223
1224 @table @code
1225 @kindex set logging
1226 @item set logging on
1227 Enable logging.
1228 @item set logging off
1229 Disable logging.
1230 @item set logging file @var{file}
1231 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1232 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1233 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1234 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1235 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1236 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1237 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1238 @kindex show logging
1239 @item show logging
1240 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1241 @end table
1242
1243 @node Commands
1244 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1245
1246 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1247 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1248 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1249 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1250 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1251
1252 @menu
1253 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1254 * Completion:: Command completion
1255 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1256 @end menu
1257
1258 @node Command Syntax
1259 @section Command syntax
1260
1261 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1262 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1263 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1264 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1265 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1266 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1267
1268 @cindex abbreviation
1269 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1270 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1271 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1272 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1273 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1274 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1275 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1276
1277 @cindex repeating commands
1278 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1279 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1280 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1281 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1282 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1283 repeat.
1284
1285 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1286 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1287 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1288
1289 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1290 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1291 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1292 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1293 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1294
1295 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1296 @cindex comment
1297 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1298 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1299 Files,,Command files}).
1300
1301 @cindex repeating command sequences
1302 @kindex C-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1303 The @kbd{C-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1304 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @kbd{RET}, and
1305 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1306 for editing.
1307
1308 @node Completion
1309 @section Command completion
1310
1311 @cindex completion
1312 @cindex word completion
1313 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1314 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1315 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1316 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1317
1318 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1319 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1320 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1321 enter it). For example, if you type
1322
1323 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1324 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1325 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1326 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1327 @smallexample
1328 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1329 @end smallexample
1330
1331 @noindent
1332 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1333 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1334
1335 @smallexample
1336 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1337 @end smallexample
1338
1339 @noindent
1340 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1341 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1342 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1343 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1344 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1345 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1346
1347 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1348 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1349 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1350 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1351 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1352 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1353 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1354 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1355 example:
1356
1357 @smallexample
1358 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1359 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1360 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1361 make_abs_section make_function_type
1362 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1363 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1364 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1365 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1366 @end smallexample
1367
1368 @noindent
1369 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1370 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1371 command.
1372
1373 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1374 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1375 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1376 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1377 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1378
1379 @cindex quotes in commands
1380 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1381 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1382 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1383 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1384 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1385 @value{GDBN} commands.
1386
1387 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1388 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1389 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1390 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1391 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1392 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1393 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1394 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1395 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1396 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1397 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1398
1399 @smallexample
1400 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1401 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1402 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1403 @end smallexample
1404
1405 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1406 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1407 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1408 place:
1409
1410 @smallexample
1411 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1412 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1413 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1414 @end smallexample
1415
1416 @noindent
1417 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1418 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1419 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1420
1421 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
1422 expressions, ,C@t{++} expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1423 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1424 see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
1425
1426
1427 @node Help
1428 @section Getting help
1429 @cindex online documentation
1430 @kindex help
1431
1432 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1433 using the command @code{help}.
1434
1435 @table @code
1436 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1437 @item help
1438 @itemx h
1439 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1440 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1441
1442 @smallexample
1443 (@value{GDBP}) help
1444 List of classes of commands:
1445
1446 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1447 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1448 data -- Examining data
1449 files -- Specifying and examining files
1450 internals -- Maintenance commands
1451 obscure -- Obscure features
1452 running -- Running the program
1453 stack -- Examining the stack
1454 status -- Status inquiries
1455 support -- Support facilities
1456 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without@*
1457 stopping the program
1458 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1459
1460 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1461 commands in that class.
1462 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1463 documentation.
1464 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1465 (@value{GDBP})
1466 @end smallexample
1467 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1468
1469 @item help @var{class}
1470 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1471 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1472 help display for the class @code{status}:
1473
1474 @smallexample
1475 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1476 Status inquiries.
1477
1478 List of commands:
1479
1480 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1481 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1482 info -- Generic command for showing things
1483 about the program being debugged
1484 show -- Generic command for showing things
1485 about the debugger
1486
1487 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1488 documentation.
1489 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1490 (@value{GDBP})
1491 @end smallexample
1492
1493 @item help @var{command}
1494 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1495 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1496
1497 @kindex apropos
1498 @item apropos @var{args}
1499 The @code{apropos @var{args}} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1500 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1501 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1502
1503 @smallexample
1504 apropos reload
1505 @end smallexample
1506
1507 @noindent
1508 results in:
1509
1510 @smallexample
1511 @c @group
1512 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1513 multiple times in one run
1514 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1515 multiple times in one run
1516 @c @end group
1517 @end smallexample
1518
1519 @kindex complete
1520 @item complete @var{args}
1521 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1522 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1523 command you want completed. For example:
1524
1525 @smallexample
1526 complete i
1527 @end smallexample
1528
1529 @noindent results in:
1530
1531 @smallexample
1532 @group
1533 if
1534 ignore
1535 info
1536 inspect
1537 @end group
1538 @end smallexample
1539
1540 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1541 @end table
1542
1543 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1544 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1545 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1546 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1547 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1548 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1549
1550 @c @group
1551 @table @code
1552 @kindex info
1553 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1554 @item info
1555 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1556 program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1557 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1558 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1559 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1560 @w{@code{help info}}.
1561
1562 @kindex set
1563 @item set
1564 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1565 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1566 @code{set prompt $}.
1567
1568 @kindex show
1569 @item show
1570 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1571 @value{GDBN} itself.
1572 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1573 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1574 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1575 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1576
1577 @kindex info set
1578 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1579 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1580 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1581 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1582 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1583 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1584 @end table
1585 @c @end group
1586
1587 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1588 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1589
1590 @table @code
1591 @kindex show version
1592 @cindex version number
1593 @item show version
1594 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1595 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1596 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1597 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1598 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1599 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1600 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1601 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1602 @value{GDBN}.
1603
1604 @kindex show copying
1605 @item show copying
1606 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1607
1608 @kindex show warranty
1609 @item show warranty
1610 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1611 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1612
1613 @end table
1614
1615 @node Running
1616 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1617
1618 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1619 debugging information when you compile it.
1620
1621 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1622 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1623 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1624 kill a child process.
1625
1626 @menu
1627 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1628 * Starting:: Starting your program
1629 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1630 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1631
1632 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1633 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1634 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1635 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1636
1637 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1638 * Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1639 @end menu
1640
1641 @node Compilation
1642 @section Compiling for debugging
1643
1644 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1645 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1646 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1647 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1648 and addresses in the executable code.
1649
1650 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1651 the compiler.
1652
1653 Most compilers do not include information about preprocessor macros in
1654 the debugging information if you specify the @option{-g} flag alone,
1655 because this information is rather large. Version 3.1 of @value{NGCC},
1656 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you specify the
1657 options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1658 debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1659 ``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact ways
1660 to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1661 @option{-g} alone.
1662
1663 Many C compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O}
1664 options together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1665 executables containing debugging information.
1666
1667 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1668 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1669 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1670 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1671 in pushing your luck.
1672
1673 @cindex optimized code, debugging
1674 @cindex debugging optimized code
1675 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1676 optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1677 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1678 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1679 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1680 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1681
1682 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1683 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1684 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1685 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1686
1687 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1688 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1689 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1690
1691 @need 2000
1692 @node Starting
1693 @section Starting your program
1694 @cindex starting
1695 @cindex running
1696
1697 @table @code
1698 @kindex run
1699 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1700 @item run
1701 @itemx r
1702 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1703 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1704 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1705 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1706 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
1707
1708 @end table
1709
1710 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1711 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1712 that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1713 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1714
1715 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1716 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1717 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1718 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1719 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1720 divided into four categories:
1721
1722 @table @asis
1723 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1724 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1725 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1726 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1727 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1728 the arguments.
1729 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1730 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1731 @xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1732
1733 @item The @emph{environment.}
1734 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1735 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1736 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1737 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1738
1739 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1740 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1741 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1742 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1743
1744 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1745 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1746 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1747 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1748 set a different device for your program.
1749 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1750
1751 @cindex pipes
1752 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1753 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1754 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1755 wrong program.
1756 @end table
1757
1758 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1759 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1760 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1761 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1762 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1763
1764 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1765 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1766 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1767 your current breakpoints.
1768
1769 @node Arguments
1770 @section Your program's arguments
1771
1772 @cindex arguments (to your program)
1773 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
1774 @code{run} command.
1775 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1776 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1777 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1778 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
1779 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1780
1781 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1782 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1783 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1784 the program, not by the shell.
1785
1786 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1787 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1788
1789 @table @code
1790 @kindex set args
1791 @item set args
1792 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1793 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1794 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1795 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1796 it again without arguments.
1797
1798 @kindex show args
1799 @item show args
1800 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1801 @end table
1802
1803 @node Environment
1804 @section Your program's environment
1805
1806 @cindex environment (of your program)
1807 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1808 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1809 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1810 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1811 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1812 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1813 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1814
1815 @table @code
1816 @kindex path
1817 @item path @var{directory}
1818 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
1819 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1820 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
1821 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1822 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1823 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1824 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
1825
1826 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1827 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1828 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1829 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1830 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1831 @var{directory} to the search path.
1832 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1833 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1834
1835 @kindex show paths
1836 @item show paths
1837 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1838 environment variable).
1839
1840 @kindex show environment
1841 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1842 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1843 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1844 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1845 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1846
1847 @kindex set environment
1848 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
1849 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1850 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1851 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1852 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
1853 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
1854 null value.
1855 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
1856 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
1857
1858 For example, this command:
1859
1860 @smallexample
1861 set env USER = foo
1862 @end smallexample
1863
1864 @noindent
1865 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
1866 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
1867 are not actually required.)
1868
1869 @kindex unset environment
1870 @item unset environment @var{varname}
1871 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
1872 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
1873 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
1874 rather than assigning it an empty value.
1875 @end table
1876
1877 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
1878 the shell indicated
1879 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
1880 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
1881 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
1882 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
1883 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
1884 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
1885 @file{.profile}.
1886
1887 @node Working Directory
1888 @section Your program's working directory
1889
1890 @cindex working directory (of your program)
1891 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
1892 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
1893 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
1894 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
1895 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
1896
1897 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
1898 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1899 specify files}.
1900
1901 @table @code
1902 @kindex cd
1903 @item cd @var{directory}
1904 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
1905
1906 @kindex pwd
1907 @item pwd
1908 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
1909 @end table
1910
1911 @node Input/Output
1912 @section Your program's input and output
1913
1914 @cindex redirection
1915 @cindex i/o
1916 @cindex terminal
1917 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
1918 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
1919 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
1920 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
1921 running your program.
1922
1923 @table @code
1924 @kindex info terminal
1925 @item info terminal
1926 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
1927 program is using.
1928 @end table
1929
1930 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
1931 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
1932
1933 @smallexample
1934 run > outfile
1935 @end smallexample
1936
1937 @noindent
1938 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
1939
1940 @kindex tty
1941 @cindex controlling terminal
1942 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
1943 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
1944 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
1945 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
1946 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
1947
1948 @smallexample
1949 tty /dev/ttyb
1950 @end smallexample
1951
1952 @noindent
1953 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
1954 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
1955 that as their controlling terminal.
1956
1957 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
1958 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
1959 terminal.
1960
1961 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
1962 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
1963 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal.
1964
1965 @node Attach
1966 @section Debugging an already-running process
1967 @kindex attach
1968 @cindex attach
1969
1970 @table @code
1971 @item attach @var{process-id}
1972 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
1973 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
1974 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
1975 find out the process-id of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
1976 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
1977
1978 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
1979 executing the command.
1980 @end table
1981
1982 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
1983 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
1984 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
1985 also have permission to send the process a signal.
1986
1987 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
1988 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
1989 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
1990 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
1991 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1992 Specify Files}.
1993
1994 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
1995 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
1996 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
1997 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
1998 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
1999 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2000 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2001
2002 @table @code
2003 @kindex detach
2004 @item detach
2005 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2006 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2007 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2008 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2009 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2010 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2011 executing the command.
2012 @end table
2013
2014 If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
2015 attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
2016 for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
2017 control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
2018 confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
2019 messages}).
2020
2021 @node Kill Process
2022 @section Killing the child process
2023
2024 @table @code
2025 @kindex kill
2026 @item kill
2027 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2028 @end table
2029
2030 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2031 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2032 is running.
2033
2034 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2035 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2036 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2037 outside the debugger.
2038
2039 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2040 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2041 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2042 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2043 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2044 breakpoint settings).
2045
2046 @node Threads
2047 @section Debugging programs with multiple threads
2048
2049 @cindex threads of execution
2050 @cindex multiple threads
2051 @cindex switching threads
2052 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2053 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2054 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2055 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2056 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2057 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2058 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2059
2060 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2061 programs:
2062
2063 @itemize @bullet
2064 @item automatic notification of new threads
2065 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2066 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2067 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2068 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2069 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2070 @end itemize
2071
2072 @quotation
2073 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2074 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2075 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2076 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2077 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2078 like this:
2079
2080 @smallexample
2081 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2082 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2083 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2084 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2085 @end smallexample
2086 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2087 @c doesn't support threads"?
2088 @end quotation
2089
2090 @cindex focus of debugging
2091 @cindex current thread
2092 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2093 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2094 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2095 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2096 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2097
2098 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2099 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2100 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2101 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2102 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2103 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2104 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2105 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2106 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2107 LynxOS, you might see
2108
2109 @smallexample
2110 [New process 35 thread 27]
2111 @end smallexample
2112
2113 @noindent
2114 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2115 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2116 further qualifier.
2117
2118 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2119 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2120 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2121 @c program?
2122 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2123 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2124 @c threads ab initio?
2125
2126 @cindex thread number
2127 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2128 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2129 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2130
2131 @table @code
2132 @kindex info threads
2133 @item info threads
2134 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2135 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2136
2137 @enumerate
2138 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2139
2140 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2141
2142 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2143 @end enumerate
2144
2145 @noindent
2146 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2147 indicates the current thread.
2148
2149 For example,
2150 @end table
2151 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2152
2153 @smallexample
2154 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2155 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2156 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2157 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2158 at threadtest.c:68
2159 @end smallexample
2160
2161 On HP-UX systems:
2162
2163 @cindex thread number
2164 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2165 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2166 number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2167 thread in your program.
2168
2169 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2170 @cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2171 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2172 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2173 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2174 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2175 both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2176 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2177 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2178 HP-UX, you see
2179
2180 @smallexample
2181 [New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2182 @end smallexample
2183
2184 @noindent
2185 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2186
2187 @table @code
2188 @kindex info threads
2189 @item info threads
2190 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2191 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2192
2193 @enumerate
2194 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2195
2196 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2197
2198 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2199 @end enumerate
2200
2201 @noindent
2202 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2203 indicates the current thread.
2204
2205 For example,
2206 @end table
2207 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2208
2209 @smallexample
2210 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2211 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2212 at quicksort.c:137
2213 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2214 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2215 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2216 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2217 @end smallexample
2218
2219 @table @code
2220 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2221 @item thread @var{threadno}
2222 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2223 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2224 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2225 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2226 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2227
2228 @smallexample
2229 @c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2230 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2231 [Switching to process 35 thread 23]
2232 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2233 @end smallexample
2234
2235 @noindent
2236 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2237 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2238 threads.
2239
2240 @kindex thread apply
2241 @item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}
2242 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply a command to one or
2243 more threads. Specify the numbers of the threads that you want affected
2244 with the command argument @var{threadno}. @var{threadno} is the internal
2245 @value{GDBN} thread number, as shown in the first field of the @samp{info
2246 threads} display. To apply a command to all threads, use
2247 @code{thread apply all} @var{args}.
2248 @end table
2249
2250 @cindex automatic thread selection
2251 @cindex switching threads automatically
2252 @cindex threads, automatic switching
2253 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2254 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2255 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2256 message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2257 thread.
2258
2259 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
2260 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2261 programs with multiple threads.
2262
2263 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
2264 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2265
2266 @node Processes
2267 @section Debugging programs with multiple processes
2268
2269 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2270 @cindex multiple processes
2271 @cindex processes, multiple
2272 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2273 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2274 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2275 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2276 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2277 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2278 will cause it to terminate.
2279
2280 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2281 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2282 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2283 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2284 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2285 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2286 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2287 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2288 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2289 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2290
2291 On HP-UX (11.x and later only?), @value{GDBN} provides support for
2292 debugging programs that create additional processes using the
2293 @code{fork} or @code{vfork} function.
2294
2295 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2296 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2297
2298 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2299 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2300
2301 @table @code
2302 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2303 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2304 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2305 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2306 process. The @var{mode} can be:
2307
2308 @table @code
2309 @item parent
2310 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2311 unimpeded. This is the default.
2312
2313 @item child
2314 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2315 unimpeded.
2316
2317 @item ask
2318 The debugger will ask for one of the above choices.
2319 @end table
2320
2321 @item show follow-fork-mode
2322 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2323 @end table
2324
2325 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2326 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2327 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2328 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2329 the child process's @code{main}.
2330
2331 When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2332 child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2333
2334 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2335 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2336 use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2337 argument.
2338
2339 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2340 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2341 Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
2342
2343 @node Stopping
2344 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
2345
2346 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2347 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2348 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2349
2350 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2351 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2352 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2353 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2354 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2355 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2356 explicitly request this information at any time.
2357
2358 @table @code
2359 @kindex info program
2360 @item info program
2361 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
2362 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
2363 @end table
2364
2365 @menu
2366 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2367 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
2368 * Signals:: Signals
2369 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
2370 @end menu
2371
2372 @node Breakpoints
2373 @section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2374
2375 @cindex breakpoints
2376 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2377 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2378 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2379 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2380 Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2381 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2382 program.
2383
2384 In HP-UX, SunOS 4.x, SVR4, and Alpha OSF/1 configurations, you can set
2385 breakpoints in shared libraries before the executable is run. There is
2386 a minor limitation on HP-UX systems: you must wait until the executable
2387 is run in order to set breakpoints in shared library routines that are
2388 not called directly by the program (for example, routines that are
2389 arguments in a @code{pthread_create} call).
2390
2391 @cindex watchpoints
2392 @cindex memory tracing
2393 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
2394 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2395 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2396 when the value of an expression changes. You must use a different
2397 command to set watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting
2398 watchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a watchpoint like
2399 any other breakpoint: you enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints
2400 and watchpoints using the same commands.
2401
2402 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2403 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2404 Automatic display}.
2405
2406 @cindex catchpoints
2407 @cindex breakpoint on events
2408 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2409 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
2410 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2411 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2412 catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2413 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
2414 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
2415
2416 @cindex breakpoint numbers
2417 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
2418 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2419 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2420 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2421 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2422 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2423 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2424 enable it again.
2425
2426 @cindex breakpoint ranges
2427 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
2428 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2429 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2430 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2431 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2432 all breakpoint in that range are operated on.
2433
2434 @menu
2435 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2436 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2437 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2438 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2439 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2440 * Conditions:: Break conditions
2441 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
2442 * Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
2443 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
2444 @end menu
2445
2446 @node Set Breaks
2447 @subsection Setting breakpoints
2448
2449 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
2450 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2451 @c
2452 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2453
2454 @kindex break
2455 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2456 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
2457 @cindex latest breakpoint
2458 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
2459 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
2460 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
2461 Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2462 convenience variables.
2463
2464 You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2465
2466 @table @code
2467 @item break @var{function}
2468 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
2469 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
2470 C@t{++}, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
2471 @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
2472
2473 @item break +@var{offset}
2474 @itemx break -@var{offset}
2475 Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
2476 at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2477 (@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
2478
2479 @item break @var{linenum}
2480 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
2481 The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2482 The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
2483 code on that line.
2484
2485 @item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2486 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2487
2488 @item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2489 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2490 @var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2491 superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2492 functions.
2493
2494 @item break *@var{address}
2495 Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2496 breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2497 information or source files.
2498
2499 @item break
2500 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2501 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2502 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2503 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2504 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2505 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2506 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2507 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2508 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2509 inside loops.
2510
2511 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2512 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2513 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2514 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2515 existed when your program stopped.
2516
2517 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2518 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2519 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2520 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2521 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2522 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2523 ,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2524
2525 @kindex tbreak
2526 @item tbreak @var{args}
2527 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2528 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2529 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2530 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2531
2532 @kindex hbreak
2533 @item hbreak @var{args}
2534 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2535 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
2536 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2537 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
2538 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2539 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2540 provided by SPARClite DSU and some x86-based targets. These targets
2541 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2542 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2543 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2544 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2545 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2546 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2547 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
2548 @xref{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
2549
2550
2551 @kindex thbreak
2552 @item thbreak @var{args}
2553 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2554 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
2555 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
2556 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2557 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
2558 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2559 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2560 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
2561
2562 @kindex rbreak
2563 @cindex regular expression
2564 @item rbreak @var{regex}
2565 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
2566 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2567 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2568 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2569 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2570 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2571
2572 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2573 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2574 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2575 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2576 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2577 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
2578
2579 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
2580 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2581 classes.
2582
2583 @kindex info breakpoints
2584 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2585 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2586 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2587 @itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2588 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2589 not deleted, with the following columns for each breakpoint:
2590
2591 @table @emph
2592 @item Breakpoint Numbers
2593 @item Type
2594 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2595 @item Disposition
2596 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2597 @item Enabled or Disabled
2598 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2599 that are not enabled.
2600 @item Address
2601 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address.
2602 @item What
2603 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2604 line number.
2605 @end table
2606
2607 @noindent
2608 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
2609 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
2610 are listed after that.
2611
2612 @noindent
2613 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
2614 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
2615 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
2616 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
2617 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
2618
2619 @noindent
2620 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
2621 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
2622 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
2623 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
2624 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
2625 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
2626 @end table
2627
2628 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
2629 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
2630 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
2631 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
2632
2633 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
2634 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
2635 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
2636 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
2637 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
2638 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
2639 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
2640 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
2641
2642
2643 @node Set Watchpoints
2644 @subsection Setting watchpoints
2645
2646 @cindex setting watchpoints
2647 @cindex software watchpoints
2648 @cindex hardware watchpoints
2649 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
2650 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
2651 this may happen.
2652
2653 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
2654 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
2655 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
2656 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
2657 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
2658 culprit.)
2659
2660 On some systems, such as HP-UX, @sc{gnu}/Linux and some other x86-based targets,
2661 @value{GDBN} includes support for
2662 hardware watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your
2663 program.
2664
2665 @table @code
2666 @kindex watch
2667 @item watch @var{expr}
2668 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when @var{expr}
2669 is written into by the program and its value changes.
2670
2671 @kindex rwatch
2672 @item rwatch @var{expr}
2673 Set a watchpoint that will break when watch @var{expr} is read by the program.
2674
2675 @kindex awatch
2676 @item awatch @var{expr}
2677 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read or written into
2678 by the program.
2679
2680 @kindex info watchpoints
2681 @item info watchpoints
2682 This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
2683 it is the same as @code{info break}.
2684 @end table
2685
2686 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
2687 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
2688 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
2689 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
2690 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
2691 statement, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
2692
2693 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
2694
2695 @smallexample
2696 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
2697 @end smallexample
2698
2699 @noindent
2700 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
2701
2702 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
2703 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
2704 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
2705 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
2706 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
2707 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
2708 will print a message like this:
2709
2710 @smallexample
2711 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
2712 @end smallexample
2713
2714 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
2715 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
2716 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
2717 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
2718 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
2719 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
2720 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
2721 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
2722
2723 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
2724 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
2725 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
2726 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
2727 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
2728 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
2729
2730 @smallexample
2731 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
2732 @end smallexample
2733
2734 @noindent
2735 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
2736
2737 The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
2738 or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
2739 data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
2740 hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
2741 both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
2742 watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
2743 @strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
2744 watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
2745 @value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
2746 Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
2747
2748 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
2749 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
2750 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
2751
2752 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
2753 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
2754 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
2755 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
2756 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
2757 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
2758 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
2759 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
2760 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
2761
2762 @quotation
2763 @cindex watchpoints and threads
2764 @cindex threads and watchpoints
2765 @emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
2766 usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
2767 can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
2768 you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
2769 thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
2770 can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
2771 @value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
2772 the expression.
2773
2774 @c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
2775 @emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
2776 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
2777 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
2778 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
2779 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
2780 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
2781 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
2782 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
2783 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
2784 @end quotation
2785
2786 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
2787
2788 @node Set Catchpoints
2789 @subsection Setting catchpoints
2790 @cindex catchpoints, setting
2791 @cindex exception handlers
2792 @cindex event handling
2793
2794 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
2795 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
2796 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
2797
2798 @table @code
2799 @kindex catch
2800 @item catch @var{event}
2801 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
2802 @table @code
2803 @item throw
2804 @kindex catch throw
2805 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
2806
2807 @item catch
2808 @kindex catch catch
2809 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
2810
2811 @item exec
2812 @kindex catch exec
2813 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2814
2815 @item fork
2816 @kindex catch fork
2817 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2818
2819 @item vfork
2820 @kindex catch vfork
2821 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2822
2823 @item load
2824 @itemx load @var{libname}
2825 @kindex catch load
2826 The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
2827 @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2828
2829 @item unload
2830 @itemx unload @var{libname}
2831 @kindex catch unload
2832 The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
2833 of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2834 @end table
2835
2836 @item tcatch @var{event}
2837 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
2838 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
2839
2840 @end table
2841
2842 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
2843
2844 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
2845 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
2846
2847 @itemize @bullet
2848 @item
2849 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
2850 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
2851 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
2852 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
2853 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
2854 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
2855 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
2856 disabled within interactive calls.
2857
2858 @item
2859 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
2860
2861 @item
2862 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
2863 @end itemize
2864
2865 @cindex raise exceptions
2866 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
2867 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
2868 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
2869 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
2870 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
2871 out where the exception was raised.
2872
2873 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
2874 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
2875 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
2876 which has the following ANSI C interface:
2877
2878 @smallexample
2879 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
2880 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
2881 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
2882 @end smallexample
2883
2884 @noindent
2885 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
2886 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
2887 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
2888
2889 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
2890 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
2891 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
2892 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
2893 raised.
2894
2895
2896 @node Delete Breaks
2897 @subsection Deleting breakpoints
2898
2899 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2900 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2901 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2902 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
2903 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
2904 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
2905
2906 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
2907 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
2908 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
2909 their breakpoint numbers.
2910
2911 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
2912 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
2913 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
2914
2915 @table @code
2916 @kindex clear
2917 @item clear
2918 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
2919 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
2920 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
2921 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
2922
2923 @item clear @var{function}
2924 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
2925 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the function @var{function}.
2926
2927 @item clear @var{linenum}
2928 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2929 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified line.
2930
2931 @cindex delete breakpoints
2932 @kindex delete
2933 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
2934 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2935 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
2936 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
2937 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
2938 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
2939 @end table
2940
2941 @node Disabling
2942 @subsection Disabling breakpoints
2943
2944 @kindex disable breakpoints
2945 @kindex enable breakpoints
2946 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
2947 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
2948 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
2949 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
2950
2951 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
2952 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
2953 or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
2954 @code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
2955 catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
2956
2957 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
2958 states of enablement:
2959
2960 @itemize @bullet
2961 @item
2962 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
2963 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
2964 @item
2965 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
2966 @item
2967 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
2968 disabled.
2969 @item
2970 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
2971 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
2972 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
2973 @end itemize
2974
2975 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
2976 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
2977
2978 @table @code
2979 @kindex disable breakpoints
2980 @kindex disable
2981 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
2982 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2983 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
2984 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
2985 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
2986 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
2987 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
2988
2989 @kindex enable breakpoints
2990 @kindex enable
2991 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2992 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
2993 become effective once again in stopping your program.
2994
2995 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
2996 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
2997 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
2998
2999 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
3000 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
3001 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
3002 @end table
3003
3004 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
3005 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
3006 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3007 ,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
3008 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
3009 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
3010 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
3011 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
3012 stepping}.)
3013
3014 @node Conditions
3015 @subsection Break conditions
3016 @cindex conditional breakpoints
3017 @cindex breakpoint conditions
3018
3019 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
3020 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
3021 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
3022 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
3023 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
3024 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
3025 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
3026 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
3027
3028 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
3029 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
3030 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
3031 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
3032 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
3033
3034 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
3035 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
3036 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3037 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3038 one.
3039
3040 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3041 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3042 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3043 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3044 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3045 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3046 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
3047 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3048 conditions for the
3049 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3050 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
3051
3052 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3053 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3054 Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3055 with the @code{condition} command.
3056
3057 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3058 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3059 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3060 catchpoint.
3061
3062 @table @code
3063 @kindex condition
3064 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3065 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3066 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3067 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3068 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3069 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3070 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
3071 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3072 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3073 prints an error message:
3074
3075 @smallexample
3076 No symbol "foo" in current context.
3077 @end smallexample
3078
3079 @noindent
3080 @value{GDBN} does
3081 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
3082 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3083 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
3084
3085 @item condition @var{bnum}
3086 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3087 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3088 @end table
3089
3090 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3091 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3092 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3093 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3094 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3095 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3096 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3097 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3098 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3099 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3100 your program reaches it.
3101
3102 @table @code
3103 @kindex ignore
3104 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3105 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3106 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3107 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3108 takes no action.
3109
3110 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3111 a count of zero.
3112
3113 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3114 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3115 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3116 Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
3117
3118 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3119 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3120 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3121
3122 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3123 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3124 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3125 variables}.
3126 @end table
3127
3128 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3129
3130
3131 @node Break Commands
3132 @subsection Breakpoint command lists
3133
3134 @cindex breakpoint commands
3135 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3136 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3137 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3138 enable other breakpoints.
3139
3140 @table @code
3141 @kindex commands
3142 @kindex end
3143 @item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3144 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3145 @itemx end
3146 Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3147 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3148 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
3149
3150 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3151 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3152
3153 With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3154 breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3155 recently encountered).
3156 @end table
3157
3158 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3159 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3160
3161 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3162 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3163 that resumes execution.
3164
3165 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3166 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3167 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3168 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3169 ambiguities about which list to execute.
3170
3171 @kindex silent
3172 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3173 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3174 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3175 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3176 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3177 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3178
3179 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3180 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3181 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
3182
3183 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3184 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3185
3186 @smallexample
3187 break foo if x>0
3188 commands
3189 silent
3190 printf "x is %d\n",x
3191 cont
3192 end
3193 @end smallexample
3194
3195 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3196 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3197 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3198 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3199 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3200 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3201 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3202
3203 @smallexample
3204 break 403
3205 commands
3206 silent
3207 set x = y + 4
3208 cont
3209 end
3210 @end smallexample
3211
3212 @node Breakpoint Menus
3213 @subsection Breakpoint menus
3214 @cindex overloading
3215 @cindex symbol overloading
3216
3217 Some programming languages (notably C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit a
3218 single function name
3219 to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3220 This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3221 @samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3222 a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3223 something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3224 particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3225 you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3226 waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3227 options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3228 sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3229 @kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3230 breakpoints.
3231
3232 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3233 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3234 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3235
3236 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3237 @smallexample
3238 @group
3239 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3240 [0] cancel
3241 [1] all
3242 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3243 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3244 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3245 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3246 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3247 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3248 > 2 4 6
3249 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3250 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3251 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3252 Multiple breakpoints were set.
3253 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3254 breakpoints.
3255 (@value{GDBP})
3256 @end group
3257 @end smallexample
3258
3259 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
3260 @node Error in Breakpoints
3261 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3262 @c
3263 @c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3264 @c
3265 Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3266 any other process is running that program. In this situation,
3267 attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
3268 @value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3269
3270 @smallexample
3271 Cannot insert breakpoints.
3272 The same program may be running in another process.
3273 @end smallexample
3274
3275 When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3276
3277 @enumerate
3278 @item
3279 Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3280
3281 @item
3282 Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
3283 name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
3284 that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
3285 Then start your program again.
3286
3287 @item
3288 Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3289 linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3290 to nonsharable executables.
3291 @end enumerate
3292 @c @end ifclear
3293
3294 A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3295 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3296
3297 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3298 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3299 @smallexample
3300 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3301 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3302 @end smallexample
3303
3304 @noindent
3305 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3306 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3307 watchpoints it needs to insert.
3308
3309 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3310 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3311
3312
3313 @node Continuing and Stepping
3314 @section Continuing and stepping
3315
3316 @cindex stepping
3317 @cindex continuing
3318 @cindex resuming execution
3319 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3320 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3321 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3322 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
3323 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3324 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
3325 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3326 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3327
3328 @table @code
3329 @kindex continue
3330 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3331 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
3332 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3333 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3334 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3335 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3336 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3337 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3338 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3339 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3340
3341 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3342 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3343 @code{continue} is ignored.
3344
3345 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3346 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3347 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3348 @code{continue}.
3349 @end table
3350
3351 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3352 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3353 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3354 different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3355
3356 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3357 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3358 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3359 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3360 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3361 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3362
3363 @table @code
3364 @kindex step
3365 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
3366 @item step
3367 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3368 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3369 abbreviated @code{s}.
3370
3371 @quotation
3372 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3373 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3374 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3375 @c distinction here.
3376 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3377 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3378 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3379 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3380 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3381 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3382 below.
3383 @end quotation
3384
3385 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
3386 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3387 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
3388 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
3389 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
3390 called within the line.
3391
3392 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3393 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
3394 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
3395 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
3396 was any debugging information about the routine.
3397
3398 @item step @var{count}
3399 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
3400 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3401 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
3402
3403 @kindex next
3404 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
3405 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3406 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
3407 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3408 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3409 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3410 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3411 is abbreviated @code{n}.
3412
3413 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3414
3415
3416 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3417 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
3418 @c
3419 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3420 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3421 @c function are executed without stopping.
3422
3423 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3424 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3425 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
3426
3427 @kindex set step-mode
3428 @item set step-mode
3429 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
3430 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
3431 @itemx set step-mode on
3432 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
3433 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
3434 information rather than stepping over it.
3435
3436 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
3437 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
3438 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
3439
3440 @item set step-mode off
3441 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
3442 debug information. This is the default.
3443
3444 @kindex finish
3445 @item finish
3446 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
3447 returns. Print the returned value (if any).
3448
3449 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
3450 ,Returning from a function}).
3451
3452 @kindex until
3453 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
3454 @item until
3455 @itemx u
3456 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
3457 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
3458 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
3459 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
3460 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
3461 than the address of the jump.
3462
3463 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
3464 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
3465 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
3466 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
3467 through the next iteration.
3468
3469 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
3470 stack frame.
3471
3472 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
3473 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
3474 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
3475 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
3476 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
3477
3478 @smallexample
3479 (@value{GDBP}) f
3480 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
3481 206 expand_input();
3482 (@value{GDBP}) until
3483 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
3484 @end smallexample
3485
3486 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
3487 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
3488 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
3489 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
3490 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
3491 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
3492 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
3493
3494 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
3495 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
3496 argument.
3497
3498 @item until @var{location}
3499 @itemx u @var{location}
3500 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
3501 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
3502 the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3503 ,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints, and
3504 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
3505 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
3506 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
3507 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
3508 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
3509 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e. after the inner
3510 invocations have returned.
3511
3512 @smallexample
3513 94 int factorial (int value)
3514 95 @{
3515 96 if (value > 1) @{
3516 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
3517 98 @}
3518 99 return (value);
3519 100 @}
3520 @end smallexample
3521
3522
3523 @kindex advance @var{location}
3524 @itemx advance @var{location}
3525 Continue running the program up to the given location. An argument is
3526 required, anything of the same form as arguments for the @code{break}
3527 command. Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
3528 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
3529 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
3530 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
3531
3532
3533 @kindex stepi
3534 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
3535 @item stepi
3536 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
3537 @itemx si
3538 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
3539
3540 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
3541 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
3542 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
3543 Display,, Automatic display}.
3544
3545 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
3546
3547 @need 750
3548 @kindex nexti
3549 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
3550 @item nexti
3551 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
3552 @itemx ni
3553 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
3554 proceed until the function returns.
3555
3556 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
3557 @end table
3558
3559 @node Signals
3560 @section Signals
3561 @cindex signals
3562
3563 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
3564 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
3565 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
3566 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{C-c});
3567 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
3568 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
3569 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
3570 requested an alarm).
3571
3572 @cindex fatal signals
3573 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
3574 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
3575 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
3576 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
3577 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
3578 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
3579
3580 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
3581 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
3582 signal.
3583
3584 @cindex handling signals
3585 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
3586 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
3587 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
3588 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
3589 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
3590
3591 @table @code
3592 @kindex info signals
3593 @item info signals
3594 @itemx info handle
3595 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
3596 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
3597 the defined types of signals.
3598
3599 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
3600
3601 @kindex handle
3602 @item handle @var{signal} @var{keywords}@dots{}
3603 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
3604 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
3605 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
3606 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
3607 known signals. The @var{keywords} say what change to make.
3608 @end table
3609
3610 @c @group
3611 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
3612 Their full names are:
3613
3614 @table @code
3615 @item nostop
3616 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
3617 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
3618
3619 @item stop
3620 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
3621 the @code{print} keyword as well.
3622
3623 @item print
3624 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
3625
3626 @item noprint
3627 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
3628 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
3629
3630 @item pass
3631 @itemx noignore
3632 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
3633 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
3634 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
3635
3636 @item nopass
3637 @itemx ignore
3638 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
3639 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
3640 @end table
3641 @c @end group
3642
3643 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
3644 program until you
3645 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
3646 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
3647 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
3648 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
3649 program sees that signal when you continue.
3650
3651 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
3652 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
3653 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
3654 erroneous signals.
3655
3656 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
3657 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
3658 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
3659 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
3660 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
3661 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
3662 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
3663 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
3664 program a signal}.
3665
3666 @node Thread Stops
3667 @section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3668
3669 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
3670 programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
3671 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
3672
3673 @table @code
3674 @cindex breakpoints and threads
3675 @cindex thread breakpoints
3676 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
3677 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
3678 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
3679 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
3680 writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
3681
3682 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
3683 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
3684 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
3685 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
3686 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
3687
3688 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
3689 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
3690 program.
3691
3692 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
3693 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
3694 breakpoint condition, like this:
3695
3696 @smallexample
3697 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
3698 @end smallexample
3699
3700 @end table
3701
3702 @cindex stopped threads
3703 @cindex threads, stopped
3704 Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
3705 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
3706 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
3707 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
3708 underfoot.
3709
3710 @cindex continuing threads
3711 @cindex threads, continuing
3712 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
3713 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
3714 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
3715
3716 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
3717 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
3718 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
3719 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
3720 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
3721 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
3722 stops.
3723
3724 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
3725 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
3726 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
3727 first thread completes whatever you requested.
3728
3729 On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
3730 thread to run.
3731
3732 @table @code
3733 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
3734 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
3735 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
3736 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
3737 mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
3738 ``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
3739 stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
3740 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
3741 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
3742 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
3743 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
3744 @value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
3745
3746 @item show scheduler-locking
3747 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
3748 @end table
3749
3750
3751 @node Stack
3752 @chapter Examining the Stack
3753
3754 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
3755 stopped and how it got there.
3756
3757 @cindex call stack
3758 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
3759 is generated.
3760 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
3761 the arguments of the call,
3762 and the local variables of the function being called.
3763 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
3764 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
3765 stack}.
3766
3767 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
3768 stack allow you to see all of this information.
3769
3770 @cindex selected frame
3771 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
3772 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
3773 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
3774 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
3775 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
3776 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3777
3778 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
3779 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
3780 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
3781
3782 @menu
3783 * Frames:: Stack frames
3784 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
3785 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
3786 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
3787
3788 @end menu
3789
3790 @node Frames
3791 @section Stack frames
3792
3793 @cindex frame, definition
3794 @cindex stack frame
3795 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
3796 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
3797 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
3798 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
3799 which the function is executing.
3800
3801 @cindex initial frame
3802 @cindex outermost frame
3803 @cindex innermost frame
3804 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
3805 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
3806 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
3807 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
3808 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
3809 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
3810 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
3811 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
3812
3813 @cindex frame pointer
3814 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
3815 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
3816 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
3817 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
3818 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register} while execution is
3819 going on in that frame.
3820
3821 @cindex frame number
3822 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
3823 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
3824 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
3825 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
3826 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
3827
3828 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
3829 @c underflow problems.
3830 @cindex frameless execution
3831 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
3832 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{GCC} option
3833 @smallexample
3834 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
3835 @end smallexample
3836 generates functions without a frame.)
3837 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
3838 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
3839 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
3840 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
3841 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
3842 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
3843 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
3844
3845 @table @code
3846 @kindex frame@r{, command}
3847 @cindex current stack frame
3848 @item frame @var{args}
3849 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
3850 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
3851 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
3852 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
3853
3854 @kindex select-frame
3855 @cindex selecting frame silently
3856 @item select-frame
3857 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
3858 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
3859 @code{frame}.
3860 @end table
3861
3862 @node Backtrace
3863 @section Backtraces
3864
3865 @cindex backtraces
3866 @cindex tracebacks
3867 @cindex stack traces
3868 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
3869 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
3870 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
3871 stack.
3872
3873 @table @code
3874 @kindex backtrace
3875 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
3876 @item backtrace
3877 @itemx bt
3878 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
3879 frames in the stack.
3880
3881 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
3882 character, normally @kbd{C-c}.
3883
3884 @item backtrace @var{n}
3885 @itemx bt @var{n}
3886 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
3887
3888 @item backtrace -@var{n}
3889 @itemx bt -@var{n}
3890 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
3891 @end table
3892
3893 @kindex where
3894 @kindex info stack
3895 @kindex info s @r{(@code{info stack})}
3896 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
3897 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
3898
3899 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
3900 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
3901 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
3902 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
3903 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
3904 line number.
3905
3906 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
3907 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
3908
3909 @smallexample
3910 @group
3911 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
3912 at builtin.c:993
3913 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
3914 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
3915 at macro.c:71
3916 (More stack frames follow...)
3917 @end group
3918 @end smallexample
3919
3920 @noindent
3921 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
3922 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
3923 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
3924
3925 @kindex set backtrace-below-main
3926 @kindex show backtrace-below-main
3927
3928 Most programs have a standard entry point---a place where system libraries
3929 and startup code transition into user code. For C this is @code{main}.
3930 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace it will terminate
3931 the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly system-specific (and generally
3932 uninteresting) code. If you need to examine the startup code, then you can
3933 change this behavior.
3934
3935 @table @code
3936 @item set backtrace-below-main off
3937 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
3938 default.
3939
3940 @item set backtrace-below-main
3941 @itemx set backtrace-below-main on
3942 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point to the top of the stack.
3943
3944 @item show backtrace-below-main
3945 Display the current backtrace policy.
3946 @end table
3947
3948 @node Selection
3949 @section Selecting a frame
3950
3951 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
3952 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
3953 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
3954 of the stack frame just selected.
3955
3956 @table @code
3957 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
3958 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
3959 @item frame @var{n}
3960 @itemx f @var{n}
3961 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
3962 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
3963 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
3964 @code{main}.
3965
3966 @item frame @var{addr}
3967 @itemx f @var{addr}
3968 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
3969 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
3970 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
3971 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
3972 switches between them.
3973
3974 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
3975 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
3976
3977 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
3978 pointer and a program counter.
3979
3980 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
3981 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
3982 @c note to future updaters: this is conditioned on a flag
3983 @c SETUP_ARBITRARY_FRAME in the tm-*.h files. The above is up to date
3984 @c as of 27 Jan 1994.
3985
3986 @kindex up
3987 @item up @var{n}
3988 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3989 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
3990 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
3991
3992 @kindex down
3993 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
3994 @item down @var{n}
3995 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3996 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
3997 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
3998 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
3999 @end table
4000
4001 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
4002 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
4003 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
4004 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
4005
4006 @need 1000
4007 For example:
4008
4009 @smallexample
4010 @group
4011 (@value{GDBP}) up
4012 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
4013 at env.c:10
4014 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
4015 @end group
4016 @end smallexample
4017
4018 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
4019 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
4020 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
4021 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
4022 @xref{List, ,Printing source lines},
4023 for details.
4024
4025 @table @code
4026 @kindex down-silently
4027 @kindex up-silently
4028 @item up-silently @var{n}
4029 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
4030 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
4031 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
4032 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
4033 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
4034 distracting.
4035 @end table
4036
4037 @node Frame Info
4038 @section Information about a frame
4039
4040 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
4041 stack frame.
4042
4043 @table @code
4044 @item frame
4045 @itemx f
4046 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
4047 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
4048 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
4049 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
4050 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4051
4052 @kindex info frame
4053 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
4054 @item info frame
4055 @itemx info f
4056 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
4057 including:
4058
4059 @itemize @bullet
4060 @item
4061 the address of the frame
4062 @item
4063 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
4064 @item
4065 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
4066 @item
4067 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
4068 @item
4069 the address of the frame's arguments
4070 @item
4071 the address of the frame's local variables
4072 @item
4073 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
4074 @item
4075 which registers were saved in the frame
4076 @end itemize
4077
4078 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
4079 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
4080 the usual conventions.
4081
4082 @item info frame @var{addr}
4083 @itemx info f @var{addr}
4084 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
4085 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
4086 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
4087 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
4088 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4089
4090 @kindex info args
4091 @item info args
4092 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
4093
4094 @item info locals
4095 @kindex info locals
4096 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
4097 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
4098 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
4099
4100 @kindex info catch
4101 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
4102 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
4103 @item info catch
4104 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
4105 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
4106 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
4107 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
4108 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
4109
4110 @end table
4111
4112
4113 @node Source
4114 @chapter Examining Source Files
4115
4116 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
4117 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
4118 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
4119 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
4120 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
4121 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
4122 source files by explicit command.
4123
4124 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
4125 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
4126 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
4127
4128 @menu
4129 * List:: Printing source lines
4130 * Edit:: Editing source files
4131 * Search:: Searching source files
4132 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
4133 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
4134 @end menu
4135
4136 @node List
4137 @section Printing source lines
4138
4139 @kindex list
4140 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
4141 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
4142 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
4143 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
4144
4145 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
4146
4147 @table @code
4148 @item list @var{linenum}
4149 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
4150 current source file.
4151
4152 @item list @var{function}
4153 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4154 @var{function}.
4155
4156 @item list
4157 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4158 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4159 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4160 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4161 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4162
4163 @item list -
4164 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4165 @end table
4166
4167 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4168 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4169
4170 @table @code
4171 @kindex set listsize
4172 @item set listsize @var{count}
4173 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4174 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4175
4176 @kindex show listsize
4177 @item show listsize
4178 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4179 @end table
4180
4181 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4182 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4183 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4184 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4185 each repetition moves up in the source file.
4186
4187 @cindex linespec
4188 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4189 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
4190 of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
4191 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4192
4193 @table @code
4194 @item list @var{linespec}
4195 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4196
4197 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
4198 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4199 linespecs.
4200
4201 @item list ,@var{last}
4202 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4203
4204 @item list @var{first},
4205 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4206
4207 @item list +
4208 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4209
4210 @item list -
4211 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4212
4213 @item list
4214 As described in the preceding table.
4215 @end table
4216
4217 Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4218 kinds of linespec.
4219
4220 @table @code
4221 @item @var{number}
4222 Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4223 When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4224 the same source file as the first linespec.
4225
4226 @item +@var{offset}
4227 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4228 When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4229 two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4230 first linespec.
4231
4232 @item -@var{offset}
4233 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4234
4235 @item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4236 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4237
4238 @item @var{function}
4239 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4240 For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4241
4242 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4243 Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4244 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4245 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4246 identically named functions in different source files.
4247
4248 @item *@var{address}
4249 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4250 @var{address} may be any expression.
4251 @end table
4252
4253 @node Edit
4254 @section Editing source files
4255 @cindex editing source files
4256
4257 @kindex edit
4258 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
4259 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
4260 The editing program of your choice
4261 is invoked with the current line set to
4262 the active line in the program.
4263 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
4264 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program.
4265
4266 Here are the forms of the @code{edit} command most commonly used:
4267
4268 @table @code
4269 @item edit
4270 Edit the current source file at the active line number in the program.
4271
4272 @item edit @var{number}
4273 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
4274
4275 @item edit @var{function}
4276 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
4277
4278 @item edit @var{filename}:@var{number}
4279 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4280
4281 @item edit @var{filename}:@var{function}
4282 Specifies the line that begins the body of the
4283 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4284 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4285 identically named functions in different source files.
4286
4287 @item edit *@var{address}
4288 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4289 @var{address} may be any expression.
4290 @end table
4291
4292 @subsection Choosing your editor
4293 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
4294 @footnote{
4295 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
4296 following command-line syntax:
4297 @smallexample
4298 ex +@var{number} file
4299 @end smallexample
4300 The optional numeric value +@var{number} designates the active line in
4301 the file.}. By default, it is @value{EDITOR}, but you can change this
4302 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
4303 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
4304 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
4305 @smallexample
4306 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
4307 export EDITOR
4308 gdb ...
4309 @end smallexample
4310 or in the @code{csh} shell,
4311 @smallexample
4312 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
4313 gdb ...
4314 @end smallexample
4315
4316 @node Search
4317 @section Searching source files
4318 @cindex searching
4319 @kindex reverse-search
4320
4321 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
4322 regular expression.
4323
4324 @table @code
4325 @kindex search
4326 @kindex forward-search
4327 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
4328 @itemx search @var{regexp}
4329 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
4330 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
4331 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
4332 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
4333 @code{fo}.
4334
4335 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
4336 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
4337 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
4338 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
4339 this command as @code{rev}.
4340 @end table
4341
4342 @node Source Path
4343 @section Specifying source directories
4344
4345 @cindex source path
4346 @cindex directories for source files
4347 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
4348 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
4349 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
4350 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
4351 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
4352 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
4353 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name. Note that
4354 the executable search path is @emph{not} used for this purpose. Neither is
4355 the current working directory, unless it happens to be in the source
4356 path.
4357
4358 If @value{GDBN} cannot find a source file in the source path, and the
4359 object program records a directory, @value{GDBN} tries that directory
4360 too. If the source path is empty, and there is no record of the
4361 compilation directory, @value{GDBN} looks in the current directory as a
4362 last resort.
4363
4364 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
4365 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
4366 each line is in the file.
4367
4368 @kindex directory
4369 @kindex dir
4370 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
4371 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
4372 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
4373
4374 @table @code
4375 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
4376 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
4377 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
4378 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
4379 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
4380 part of absolute file names) or
4381 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
4382 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
4383
4384 @kindex cdir
4385 @kindex cwd
4386 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
4387 @vindex $cwdr@r{, convenience variable}
4388 @cindex compilation directory
4389 @cindex current directory
4390 @cindex working directory
4391 @cindex directory, current
4392 @cindex directory, compilation
4393 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
4394 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
4395 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
4396 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
4397 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
4398 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
4399
4400 @item directory
4401 Reset the source path to empty again. This requires confirmation.
4402
4403 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
4404 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
4405
4406 @item show directories
4407 @kindex show directories
4408 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
4409 @end table
4410
4411 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
4412 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
4413 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
4414
4415 @enumerate
4416 @item
4417 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to empty.
4418
4419 @item
4420 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
4421 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
4422 directories in one command.
4423 @end enumerate
4424
4425 @node Machine Code
4426 @section Source and machine code
4427
4428 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
4429 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
4430 a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
4431 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
4432 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
4433 well as hex.
4434
4435 @table @code
4436 @kindex info line
4437 @item info line @var{linespec}
4438 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
4439 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
4440 the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
4441 source lines}).
4442 @end table
4443
4444 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
4445 the object code for the first line of function
4446 @code{m4_changequote}:
4447
4448 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
4449 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
4450 @smallexample
4451 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
4452 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
4453 @end smallexample
4454
4455 @noindent
4456 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
4457 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
4458 @smallexample
4459 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
4460 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
4461 @end smallexample
4462
4463 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
4464 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
4465 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
4466 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
4467 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
4468 ,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
4469 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4470 variables}).
4471
4472 @table @code
4473 @kindex disassemble
4474 @cindex assembly instructions
4475 @cindex instructions, assembly
4476 @cindex machine instructions
4477 @cindex listing machine instructions
4478 @item disassemble
4479 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
4480 instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
4481 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
4482 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
4483 surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
4484 (first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
4485 @end table
4486
4487 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
4488 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
4489
4490 @smallexample
4491 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
4492 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
4493 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
4494 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
4495 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4496 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
4497 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
4498 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
4499 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
4500 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4501 End of assembler dump.
4502 @end smallexample
4503
4504 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
4505 mnemonics or other syntax.
4506
4507 @table @code
4508 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
4509 @cindex assembly instructions
4510 @cindex instructions, assembly
4511 @cindex machine instructions
4512 @cindex listing machine instructions
4513 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
4514 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
4515 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
4516 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
4517 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
4518
4519 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
4520 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
4521 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
4522 assemblers for x86-based targets.
4523 @end table
4524
4525
4526 @node Data
4527 @chapter Examining Data
4528
4529 @cindex printing data
4530 @cindex examining data
4531 @kindex print
4532 @kindex inspect
4533 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
4534 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
4535 @c different window or something like that.
4536 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
4537 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
4538 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
4539 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
4540 Different Languages}).
4541
4542 @table @code
4543 @item print @var{expr}
4544 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
4545 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
4546 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
4547 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
4548 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
4549 formats}.
4550
4551 @item print
4552 @itemx print /@var{f}
4553 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
4554 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
4555 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
4556 @end table
4557
4558 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
4559 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
4560 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4561
4562 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
4563 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
4564 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
4565 Table}.
4566
4567 @menu
4568 * Expressions:: Expressions
4569 * Variables:: Program variables
4570 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
4571 * Output Formats:: Output formats
4572 * Memory:: Examining memory
4573 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
4574 * Print Settings:: Print settings
4575 * Value History:: Value history
4576 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
4577 * Registers:: Registers
4578 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
4579 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
4580 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
4581 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
4582 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
4583 character set than GDB does
4584 @end menu
4585
4586 @node Expressions
4587 @section Expressions
4588
4589 @cindex expressions
4590 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
4591 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
4592 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
4593 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
4594 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
4595 you compiled your program to include this information; see
4596 @ref{Compilation}.
4597
4598 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
4599 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
4600 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
4601 memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
4602
4603 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
4604 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
4605 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
4606 languages.
4607
4608 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
4609 expressions regardless of your programming language.
4610
4611 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
4612 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
4613 at that address in memory.
4614 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
4615
4616 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
4617 to programming languages:
4618
4619 @table @code
4620 @item @@
4621 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
4622 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
4623
4624 @item ::
4625 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
4626 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
4627
4628 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
4629 @cindex type casting memory
4630 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
4631 @cindex casts, to view memory
4632 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
4633 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
4634 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
4635 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
4636 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
4637 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
4638 @end table
4639
4640 @node Variables
4641 @section Program variables
4642
4643 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
4644 in your program.
4645
4646 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
4647 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
4648
4649 @itemize @bullet
4650 @item
4651 global (or file-static)
4652 @end itemize
4653
4654 @noindent or
4655
4656 @itemize @bullet
4657 @item
4658 visible according to the scope rules of the
4659 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
4660 @end itemize
4661
4662 @noindent This means that in the function
4663
4664 @smallexample
4665 foo (a)
4666 int a;
4667 @{
4668 bar (a);
4669 @{
4670 int b = test ();
4671 bar (b);
4672 @}
4673 @}
4674 @end smallexample
4675
4676 @noindent
4677 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
4678 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
4679 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
4680 the block where @code{b} is declared.
4681
4682 @cindex variable name conflict
4683 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
4684 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
4685 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
4686 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
4687 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
4688 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
4689 using the colon-colon notation:
4690
4691 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
4692 @iftex
4693 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
4694 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
4695 @end iftex
4696 @smallexample
4697 @var{file}::@var{variable}
4698 @var{function}::@var{variable}
4699 @end smallexample
4700
4701 @noindent
4702 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
4703 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
4704 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
4705 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
4706
4707 @smallexample
4708 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
4709 @end smallexample
4710
4711 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
4712 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
4713 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
4714 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
4715 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
4716 @c conflict?? --mew
4717
4718 @cindex wrong values
4719 @cindex variable values, wrong
4720 @quotation
4721 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
4722 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
4723 scope, and just before exit.
4724 @end quotation
4725 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
4726 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
4727 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
4728 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
4729 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
4730 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
4731 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
4732 variable definitions may be gone.
4733
4734 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
4735 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
4736 when compiling.
4737
4738 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
4739 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
4740 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
4741 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
4742 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
4743 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
4744 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
4745
4746 @smallexample
4747 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4748 @end smallexample
4749
4750 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
4751 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
4752 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler
4753 usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
4754 produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
4755 COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
4756 an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
4757 for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}.
4758
4759
4760 @node Arrays
4761 @section Artificial arrays
4762
4763 @cindex artificial array
4764 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
4765 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
4766 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
4767 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
4768 program.
4769
4770 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
4771 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
4772 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
4773 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
4774 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
4775 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
4776 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
4777 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
4778 example. If a program says
4779
4780 @smallexample
4781 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
4782 @end smallexample
4783
4784 @noindent
4785 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
4786
4787 @smallexample
4788 p *array@@len
4789 @end smallexample
4790
4791 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
4792 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
4793 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
4794 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
4795 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
4796
4797 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
4798 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
4799 The value need not be in memory:
4800 @smallexample
4801 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
4802 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4803 @end smallexample
4804
4805 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
4806 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
4807 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
4808 @smallexample
4809 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
4810 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4811 @end smallexample
4812
4813 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
4814 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
4815 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
4816 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
4817 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4818 variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
4819 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
4820 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
4821 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
4822 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
4823
4824 @smallexample
4825 set $i = 0
4826 p dtab[$i++]->fv
4827 @key{RET}
4828 @key{RET}
4829 @dots{}
4830 @end smallexample
4831
4832 @node Output Formats
4833 @section Output formats
4834
4835 @cindex formatted output
4836 @cindex output formats
4837 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
4838 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
4839 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
4840 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
4841 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
4842
4843 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
4844 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
4845 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
4846 letters supported are:
4847
4848 @table @code
4849 @item x
4850 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
4851 hexadecimal.
4852
4853 @item d
4854 Print as integer in signed decimal.
4855
4856 @item u
4857 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
4858
4859 @item o
4860 Print as integer in octal.
4861
4862 @item t
4863 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
4864 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
4865 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
4866 see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
4867
4868 @item a
4869 @cindex unknown address, locating
4870 @cindex locate address
4871 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
4872 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
4873 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
4874
4875 @smallexample
4876 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
4877 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
4878 @end smallexample
4879
4880 @noindent
4881 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
4882 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
4883
4884 @item c
4885 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant.
4886
4887 @item f
4888 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
4889 using typical floating point syntax.
4890 @end table
4891
4892 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
4893
4894 @smallexample
4895 p/x $pc
4896 @end smallexample
4897
4898 @noindent
4899 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
4900 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
4901
4902 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
4903 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
4904 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
4905
4906 @node Memory
4907 @section Examining memory
4908
4909 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
4910 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
4911
4912 @cindex examining memory
4913 @table @code
4914 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
4915 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
4916 @itemx x @var{addr}
4917 @itemx x
4918 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
4919 @end table
4920
4921 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
4922 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
4923 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
4924 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
4925 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
4926
4927 @table @r
4928 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
4929 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
4930 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
4931 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
4932 @c 4.1.2.
4933
4934 @item @var{f}, the display format
4935 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print},
4936 @samp{s} (null-terminated string), or @samp{i} (machine instruction).
4937 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially.
4938 The default changes each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
4939
4940 @item @var{u}, the unit size
4941 The unit size is any of
4942
4943 @table @code
4944 @item b
4945 Bytes.
4946 @item h
4947 Halfwords (two bytes).
4948 @item w
4949 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
4950 @item g
4951 Giant words (eight bytes).
4952 @end table
4953
4954 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
4955 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
4956 @samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
4957
4958 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
4959 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
4960 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
4961 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
4962 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
4963 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
4964 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
4965 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
4966 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
4967 a value from memory).
4968 @end table
4969
4970 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
4971 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
4972 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
4973 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
4974 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
4975
4976 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
4977 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
4978 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
4979 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
4980 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
4981
4982 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
4983 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
4984 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
4985 including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
4986 alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
4987 Code,,Source and machine code}.
4988
4989 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
4990 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
4991 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
4992 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
4993 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
4994 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
4995 for successive uses of @code{x}.
4996
4997 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
4998 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
4999 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
5000 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
5001 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
5002 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
5003 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
5004 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
5005 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
5006
5007 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
5008 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
5009 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
5010
5011 @node Auto Display
5012 @section Automatic display
5013 @cindex automatic display
5014 @cindex display of expressions
5015
5016 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
5017 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
5018 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
5019 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
5020 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
5021 The automatic display looks like this:
5022
5023 @smallexample
5024 2: foo = 38
5025 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
5026 @end smallexample
5027
5028 @noindent
5029 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
5030 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
5031 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
5032 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
5033 format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
5034 or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
5035 supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
5036
5037 @table @code
5038 @kindex display
5039 @item display @var{expr}
5040 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
5041 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
5042
5043 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
5044
5045 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
5046 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
5047 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
5048 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
5049 @xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
5050
5051 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
5052 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
5053 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
5054 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
5055 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
5056 @end table
5057
5058 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
5059 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
5060 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
5061
5062 @table @code
5063 @kindex delete display
5064 @kindex undisplay
5065 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
5066 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5067 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
5068
5069 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
5070 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
5071
5072 @kindex disable display
5073 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5074 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
5075 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
5076 enabled again later.
5077
5078 @kindex enable display
5079 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5080 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
5081 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
5082
5083 @item display
5084 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
5085 done when your program stops.
5086
5087 @kindex info display
5088 @item info display
5089 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
5090 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
5091 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
5092 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
5093 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
5094 @end table
5095
5096 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
5097 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
5098 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
5099 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
5100 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
5101 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
5102 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
5103 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
5104 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
5105 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
5106
5107 @node Print Settings
5108 @section Print settings
5109
5110 @cindex format options
5111 @cindex print settings
5112 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
5113 and symbols are printed.
5114
5115 @noindent
5116 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
5117
5118 @table @code
5119 @kindex set print address
5120 @item set print address
5121 @itemx set print address on
5122 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
5123 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
5124 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
5125 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
5126 @code{set print address on}:
5127
5128 @smallexample
5129 @group
5130 (@value{GDBP}) f
5131 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
5132 at input.c:530
5133 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
5134 @end group
5135 @end smallexample
5136
5137 @item set print address off
5138 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
5139 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
5140
5141 @smallexample
5142 @group
5143 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
5144 (@value{GDBP}) f
5145 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
5146 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
5147 @end group
5148 @end smallexample
5149
5150 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
5151 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
5152 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
5153 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
5154
5155 @kindex show print address
5156 @item show print address
5157 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
5158 @end table
5159
5160 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
5161 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
5162 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
5163 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
5164 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
5165 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
5166 it prints a symbolic address:
5167
5168 @table @code
5169 @kindex set print symbol-filename
5170 @item set print symbol-filename on
5171 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
5172 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5173
5174 @item set print symbol-filename off
5175 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
5176 default.
5177
5178 @kindex show print symbol-filename
5179 @item show print symbol-filename
5180 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
5181 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5182 @end table
5183
5184 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
5185 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
5186 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
5187
5188 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
5189 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
5190
5191 @table @code
5192 @kindex set print max-symbolic-offset
5193 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
5194 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
5195 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
5196 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
5197 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
5198
5199 @kindex show print max-symbolic-offset
5200 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
5201 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
5202 symbolic address.
5203 @end table
5204
5205 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
5206 @cindex pointer, finding referent
5207 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
5208 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
5209 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
5210 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
5211 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
5212 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
5213
5214 @smallexample
5215 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
5216 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
5217 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
5218 @end smallexample
5219
5220 @quotation
5221 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
5222 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
5223 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
5224 @end quotation
5225
5226 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
5227
5228 @table @code
5229 @kindex set print array
5230 @item set print array
5231 @itemx set print array on
5232 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
5233 but uses more space. The default is off.
5234
5235 @item set print array off
5236 Return to compressed format for arrays.
5237
5238 @kindex show print array
5239 @item show print array
5240 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
5241 arrays.
5242
5243 @kindex set print elements
5244 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
5245 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
5246 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
5247 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
5248 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
5249 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
5250 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
5251
5252 @kindex show print elements
5253 @item show print elements
5254 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
5255 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
5256
5257 @kindex set print null-stop
5258 @item set print null-stop
5259 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
5260 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
5261 contain only short strings.
5262 The default is off.
5263
5264 @kindex set print pretty
5265 @item set print pretty on
5266 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
5267 per line, like this:
5268
5269 @smallexample
5270 @group
5271 $1 = @{
5272 next = 0x0,
5273 flags = @{
5274 sweet = 1,
5275 sour = 1
5276 @},
5277 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
5278 @}
5279 @end group
5280 @end smallexample
5281
5282 @item set print pretty off
5283 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
5284
5285 @smallexample
5286 @group
5287 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
5288 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
5289 @end group
5290 @end smallexample
5291
5292 @noindent
5293 This is the default format.
5294
5295 @kindex show print pretty
5296 @item show print pretty
5297 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
5298
5299 @kindex set print sevenbit-strings
5300 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
5301 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
5302 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
5303 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
5304 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
5305 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
5306
5307 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
5308 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
5309 international character sets, and is the default.
5310
5311 @kindex show print sevenbit-strings
5312 @item show print sevenbit-strings
5313 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
5314
5315 @kindex set print union
5316 @item set print union on
5317 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures. This
5318 is the default setting.
5319
5320 @item set print union off
5321 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in structures.
5322
5323 @kindex show print union
5324 @item show print union
5325 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
5326 structures.
5327
5328 For example, given the declarations
5329
5330 @smallexample
5331 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
5332 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
5333 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
5334 Bug_forms;
5335
5336 struct thing @{
5337 Species it;
5338 union @{
5339 Tree_forms tree;
5340 Bug_forms bug;
5341 @} form;
5342 @};
5343
5344 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
5345 @end smallexample
5346
5347 @noindent
5348 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
5349
5350 @smallexample
5351 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
5352 @end smallexample
5353
5354 @noindent
5355 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
5356
5357 @smallexample
5358 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
5359 @end smallexample
5360 @end table
5361
5362 @need 1000
5363 @noindent
5364 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
5365
5366 @table @code
5367 @cindex demangling
5368 @kindex set print demangle
5369 @item set print demangle
5370 @itemx set print demangle on
5371 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
5372 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
5373 linkage. The default is on.
5374
5375 @kindex show print demangle
5376 @item show print demangle
5377 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
5378
5379 @kindex set print asm-demangle
5380 @item set print asm-demangle
5381 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
5382 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
5383 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
5384 The default is off.
5385
5386 @kindex show print asm-demangle
5387 @item show print asm-demangle
5388 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
5389 or demangled form.
5390
5391 @kindex set demangle-style
5392 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
5393 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
5394 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
5395 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
5396 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
5397
5398 @table @code
5399 @item auto
5400 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
5401
5402 @item gnu
5403 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
5404 This is the default.
5405
5406 @item hp
5407 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
5408
5409 @item lucid
5410 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
5411
5412 @item arm
5413 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
5414 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
5415 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
5416 require further enhancement to permit that.
5417
5418 @end table
5419 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
5420
5421 @kindex show demangle-style
5422 @item show demangle-style
5423 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
5424
5425 @kindex set print object
5426 @item set print object
5427 @itemx set print object on
5428 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
5429 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
5430 the virtual function table.
5431
5432 @item set print object off
5433 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
5434 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
5435
5436 @kindex show print object
5437 @item show print object
5438 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
5439
5440 @kindex set print static-members
5441 @item set print static-members
5442 @itemx set print static-members on
5443 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
5444
5445 @item set print static-members off
5446 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
5447
5448 @kindex show print static-members
5449 @item show print static-members
5450 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed, or not.
5451
5452 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
5453 @kindex set print vtbl
5454 @item set print vtbl
5455 @itemx set print vtbl on
5456 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
5457 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
5458 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
5459
5460 @item set print vtbl off
5461 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
5462
5463 @kindex show print vtbl
5464 @item show print vtbl
5465 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
5466 @end table
5467
5468 @node Value History
5469 @section Value history
5470
5471 @cindex value history
5472 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
5473 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
5474 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
5475 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
5476 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
5477 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
5478 symbol table.
5479
5480 @cindex @code{$}
5481 @cindex @code{$$}
5482 @cindex history number
5483 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
5484 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
5485 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
5486 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
5487 history number.
5488
5489 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
5490 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
5491 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
5492 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
5493 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
5494 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
5495 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
5496
5497 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
5498 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
5499
5500 @smallexample
5501 p *$
5502 @end smallexample
5503
5504 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
5505 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
5506
5507 @smallexample
5508 p *$.next
5509 @end smallexample
5510
5511 @noindent
5512 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
5513 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
5514
5515 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
5516 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
5517
5518 @smallexample
5519 print x
5520 set x=5
5521 @end smallexample
5522
5523 @noindent
5524 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
5525 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
5526
5527 @table @code
5528 @kindex show values
5529 @item show values
5530 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
5531 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
5532 values} does not change the history.
5533
5534 @item show values @var{n}
5535 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
5536
5537 @item show values +
5538 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
5539 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
5540 @end table
5541
5542 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
5543 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
5544
5545 @node Convenience Vars
5546 @section Convenience variables
5547
5548 @cindex convenience variables
5549 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
5550 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
5551 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
5552 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
5553 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
5554
5555 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
5556 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
5557 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
5558 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
5559 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
5560
5561 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
5562 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
5563 For example:
5564
5565 @smallexample
5566 set $foo = *object_ptr
5567 @end smallexample
5568
5569 @noindent
5570 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
5571 @code{object_ptr}.
5572
5573 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
5574 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
5575 value with another assignment at any time.
5576
5577 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
5578 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
5579 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
5580 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
5581
5582 @table @code
5583 @kindex show convenience
5584 @item show convenience
5585 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
5586 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
5587 @end table
5588
5589 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
5590 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
5591 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
5592
5593 @smallexample
5594 set $i = 0
5595 print bar[$i++]->contents
5596 @end smallexample
5597
5598 @noindent
5599 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
5600
5601 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
5602 values likely to be useful.
5603
5604 @table @code
5605 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
5606 @item $_
5607 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
5608 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
5609 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
5610 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
5611 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
5612 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
5613 to the type of @code{$__}.
5614
5615 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
5616 @item $__
5617 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
5618 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
5619 to match the format in which the data was printed.
5620
5621 @item $_exitcode
5622 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
5623 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
5624 the program being debugged terminates.
5625 @end table
5626
5627 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
5628 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
5629 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
5630
5631 @node Registers
5632 @section Registers
5633
5634 @cindex registers
5635 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
5636 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
5637 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
5638 your machine.
5639
5640 @table @code
5641 @kindex info registers
5642 @item info registers
5643 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
5644 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
5645
5646 @kindex info all-registers
5647 @cindex floating point registers
5648 @item info all-registers
5649 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
5650 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
5651
5652 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
5653 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
5654 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
5655 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
5656 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
5657 @end table
5658
5659 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
5660 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
5661 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
5662 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
5663 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
5664 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
5665 register that contains the processor status. For example,
5666 you could print the program counter in hex with
5667
5668 @smallexample
5669 p/x $pc
5670 @end smallexample
5671
5672 @noindent
5673 or print the instruction to be executed next with
5674
5675 @smallexample
5676 x/i $pc
5677 @end smallexample
5678
5679 @noindent
5680 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
5681 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
5682 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
5683 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
5684 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
5685 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
5686 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
5687
5688 @smallexample
5689 set $sp += 4
5690 @end smallexample
5691
5692 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
5693 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
5694 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
5695 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
5696 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
5697 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
5698 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
5699
5700 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
5701 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
5702 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
5703 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
5704 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
5705 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
5706 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
5707
5708 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
5709 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
5710 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
5711 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
5712 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
5713 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
5714 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
5715 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
5716 prints the data in both formats.
5717
5718 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
5719 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
5720 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
5721 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
5722 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
5723 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
5724
5725 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
5726 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
5727 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
5728 frame makes no difference.
5729
5730 @node Floating Point Hardware
5731 @section Floating point hardware
5732 @cindex floating point
5733
5734 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
5735 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
5736
5737 @table @code
5738 @kindex info float
5739 @item info float
5740 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
5741 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
5742 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
5743 the ARM and x86 machines.
5744 @end table
5745
5746 @node Vector Unit
5747 @section Vector Unit
5748 @cindex vector unit
5749
5750 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
5751 more information about the status of the vector unit.
5752
5753 @table @code
5754 @kindex info vector
5755 @item info vector
5756 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
5757 layout vary depending on the hardware.
5758 @end table
5759
5760 @node Memory Region Attributes
5761 @section Memory region attributes
5762 @cindex memory region attributes
5763
5764 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
5765 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses attributes
5766 to determine whether to allow certain types of memory accesses; whether to
5767 use specific width accesses; and whether to cache target memory.
5768
5769 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
5770 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
5771 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
5772 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
5773 all memory.
5774
5775 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
5776 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
5777
5778 @table @code
5779 @kindex mem
5780 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
5781 Define memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
5782 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a
5783 special case: it is treated as the the target's maximum memory address.
5784 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
5785
5786 @kindex delete mem
5787 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5788 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
5789
5790 @kindex disable mem
5791 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5792 Disable memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
5793 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
5794 It may be enabled again later.
5795
5796 @kindex enable mem
5797 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5798 Enable memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
5799
5800 @kindex info mem
5801 @item info mem
5802 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
5803 for each region.
5804
5805 @table @emph
5806 @item Memory Region Number
5807 @item Enabled or Disabled.
5808 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
5809 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
5810
5811 @item Lo Address
5812 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
5813
5814 @item Hi Address
5815 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
5816
5817 @item Attributes
5818 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
5819 @end table
5820 @end table
5821
5822
5823 @subsection Attributes
5824
5825 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
5826 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
5827 write accesses to a memory region.
5828
5829 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
5830 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
5831 etc. from accessing memory.
5832
5833 @table @code
5834 @item ro
5835 Memory is read only.
5836 @item wo
5837 Memory is write only.
5838 @item rw
5839 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
5840 @end table
5841
5842 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
5843 The acccess size attributes tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
5844 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
5845 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
5846 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
5847
5848 @table @code
5849 @item 8
5850 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
5851 @item 16
5852 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
5853 @item 32
5854 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
5855 @item 64
5856 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
5857 @end table
5858
5859 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
5860 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5861 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
5862 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
5863 @c
5864 @c @table @code
5865 @c @item hwbreak
5866 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
5867 @c @item swbreak (default)
5868 @c @end table
5869
5870 @subsubsection Data Cache
5871 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
5872 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
5873 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
5874 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
5875 registers.
5876
5877 @table @code
5878 @item cache
5879 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
5880 @item nocache
5881 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
5882 @end table
5883
5884 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
5885 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5886 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
5887 @c
5888 @c @table @code
5889 @c @item verify
5890 @c @item noverify (default)
5891 @c @end table
5892
5893 @node Dump/Restore Files
5894 @section Copy between memory and a file
5895 @cindex dump/restore files
5896 @cindex append data to a file
5897 @cindex dump data to a file
5898 @cindex restore data from a file
5899
5900 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
5901 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
5902 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
5903 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
5904 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex, or
5905 Tektronix Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only append to binary
5906 files.
5907
5908 @table @code
5909
5910 @kindex dump
5911 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5912 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
5913 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
5914 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
5915
5916 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
5917 @table @code
5918 @item binary
5919 Raw binary form.
5920 @item ihex
5921 Intel hex format.
5922 @item srec
5923 Motorola S-record format.
5924 @item tekhex
5925 Tektronix Hex format.
5926 @end table
5927
5928 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
5929 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
5930 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
5931 form.
5932
5933 @kindex append
5934 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5935 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
5936 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
5937 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
5938 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
5939
5940 @kindex restore
5941 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
5942 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
5943 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
5944 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
5945 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
5946
5947 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
5948 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
5949 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
5950 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
5951 from that location.
5952
5953 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
5954 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
5955 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
5956 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
5957
5958 @end table
5959
5960 @node Character Sets
5961 @section Character Sets
5962 @cindex character sets
5963 @cindex charset
5964 @cindex translating between character sets
5965 @cindex host character set
5966 @cindex target character set
5967
5968 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
5969 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
5970 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
5971 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
5972 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
5973 @dfn{target character set}.
5974
5975 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
5976 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
5977 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote,Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
5978 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
5979 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
5980 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
5981 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
5982 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
5983 character and string literals in expressions.
5984
5985 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
5986 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
5987 target-charset} command, described below.
5988
5989 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
5990 support:
5991
5992 @table @code
5993 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
5994 @kindex set target-charset
5995 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. We list the
5996 character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, but if you type
5997 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
5998 list the target character sets it supports.
5999 @end table
6000
6001 @table @code
6002 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
6003 @kindex set host-charset
6004 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
6005
6006 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
6007 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
6008 @code{set host-charset} command.
6009
6010 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
6011 set. We list the character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, and
6012 indicate which can be host character sets, but if you type
6013 @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} will
6014 list the host character sets it supports.
6015
6016 @item set charset @var{charset}
6017 @kindex set charset
6018 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
6019 above, if you type @code{set charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
6020 @value{GDBN} will list the name of the character sets that can be used
6021 for both host and target.
6022
6023
6024 @item show charset
6025 @kindex show charset
6026 Show the names of the current host and target charsets.
6027
6028 @itemx show host-charset
6029 @kindex show host-charset
6030 Show the name of the current host charset.
6031
6032 @itemx show target-charset
6033 @kindex show target-charset
6034 Show the name of the current target charset.
6035
6036 @end table
6037
6038 @value{GDBN} currently includes support for the following character
6039 sets:
6040
6041 @table @code
6042
6043 @item ASCII
6044 @cindex ASCII character set
6045 Seven-bit U.S. @sc{ascii}. @value{GDBN} can use this as its host
6046 character set.
6047
6048 @item ISO-8859-1
6049 @cindex ISO 8859-1 character set
6050 @cindex ISO Latin 1 character set
6051 The ISO Latin 1 character set. This extends @sc{ascii} with accented
6052 characters needed for French, German, and Spanish. @value{GDBN} can use
6053 this as its host character set.
6054
6055 @item EBCDIC-US
6056 @itemx IBM1047
6057 @cindex EBCDIC character set
6058 @cindex IBM1047 character set
6059 Variants of the @sc{ebcdic} character set, used on some of IBM's
6060 mainframe operating systems. (@sc{gnu}/Linux on the S/390 uses U.S. @sc{ascii}.)
6061 @value{GDBN} cannot use these as its host character set.
6062
6063 @end table
6064
6065 Note that these are all single-byte character sets. More work inside
6066 GDB is needed to support multi-byte or variable-width character
6067 encodings, like the UTF-8 and UCS-2 encodings of Unicode.
6068
6069 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
6070 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
6071 @file{charset-test.c}:
6072
6073 @smallexample
6074 #include <stdio.h>
6075
6076 char ascii_hello[]
6077 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
6078 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
6079 char ibm1047_hello[]
6080 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
6081 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
6082
6083 main ()
6084 @{
6085 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6086 @}
6087 @end smallexample
6088
6089 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
6090 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
6091 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
6092
6093 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
6094
6095 @smallexample
6096 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
6097 $ gdb -nw charset-test
6098 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
6099 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6100 @dots{}
6101 (gdb)
6102 @end smallexample
6103
6104 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
6105 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
6106 strings:
6107
6108 @smallexample
6109 (gdb) show charset
6110 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
6111 (gdb)
6112 @end smallexample
6113
6114 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
6115 initial character set:
6116 @smallexample
6117 (gdb) set charset ASCII
6118 (gdb) show charset
6119 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
6120 (gdb)
6121 @end smallexample
6122
6123 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
6124 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
6125 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
6126 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
6127 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
6128
6129 @smallexample
6130 (gdb) print ascii_hello
6131 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
6132 (gdb) print ascii_hello[0]
6133 $2 = 72 'H'
6134 (gdb)
6135 @end smallexample
6136
6137 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
6138 literals you use in expressions:
6139
6140 @smallexample
6141 (gdb) print '+'
6142 $3 = 43 '+'
6143 (gdb)
6144 @end smallexample
6145
6146 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
6147 character.
6148
6149 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
6150 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
6151 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
6152
6153 @smallexample
6154 (gdb) print ibm1047_hello
6155 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
6156 (gdb) print ibm1047_hello[0]
6157 $5 = 200 '\310'
6158 (gdb)
6159 @end smallexample
6160
6161 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
6162 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
6163
6164 @smallexample
6165 (gdb) set target-charset
6166 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
6167 (gdb) set target-charset
6168 @end smallexample
6169
6170 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
6171 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
6172 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
6173 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
6174 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
6175
6176 @smallexample
6177 (gdb) set target-charset IBM1047
6178 (gdb) show charset
6179 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
6180 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
6181 (gdb) print ascii_hello
6182 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
6183 (gdb) print ascii_hello[0]
6184 $7 = 72 '\110'
6185 (gdb) print ibm1047_hello
6186 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
6187 (gdb) print ibm1047_hello[0]
6188 $9 = 200 'H'
6189 (gdb)
6190 @end smallexample
6191
6192 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
6193 string literals you use in expressions:
6194
6195 @smallexample
6196 (gdb) print '+'
6197 $10 = 78 '+'
6198 (gdb)
6199 @end smallexample
6200
6201 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
6202 character.
6203
6204
6205 @node Macros
6206 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
6207
6208 Some languages, such as C and C++, provide a way to define and invoke
6209 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
6210 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
6211 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
6212 where it was defined.
6213
6214 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
6215 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
6216 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
6217 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
6218
6219 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
6220 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
6221 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
6222 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
6223 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
6224 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
6225 see @ref{List}.
6226
6227 At the moment, @value{GDBN} does not support the @code{##}
6228 token-splicing operator, the @code{#} stringification operator, or
6229 variable-arity macros.
6230
6231 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
6232 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
6233 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
6234
6235 @table @code
6236
6237 @kindex macro expand
6238 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
6239 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
6240 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
6241 @item macro expand @var{expression}
6242 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
6243 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
6244 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
6245 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
6246 it can be any string of tokens.
6247
6248 @kindex macro expand-once
6249 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
6250 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
6251 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
6252 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
6253 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
6254 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
6255 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
6256 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
6257 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
6258 can be any string of tokens.
6259
6260 @kindex info macro
6261 @cindex macro definition, showing
6262 @cindex definition, showing a macro's
6263 @item info macro @var{macro}
6264 Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
6265 source location where that definition was established.
6266
6267 @kindex macro define
6268 @cindex user-defined macros
6269 @cindex defining macros interactively
6270 @cindex macros, user-defined
6271 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
6272 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
6273 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Introduce a definition for a
6274 preprocessor macro named @var{macro}, invocations of which are replaced
6275 by the tokens given in @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this
6276 command defines an ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the
6277 second form defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments
6278 given in @var{arglist}.
6279
6280 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every expression
6281 evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the @command{macro
6282 undef} command, described below. The definition overrides all
6283 definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged, as
6284 well as any previous user-supplied definition.
6285
6286 @kindex macro undef
6287 @item macro undef @var{macro}
6288 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Remove any user-supplied
6289 definition for the macro named @var{macro}. This command only affects
6290 definitions provided with the @command{macro define} command, described
6291 above; it cannot remove definitions present in the program being
6292 debugged.
6293
6294 @end table
6295
6296 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
6297 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
6298 show our source files:
6299
6300 @smallexample
6301 $ cat sample.c
6302 #include <stdio.h>
6303 #include "sample.h"
6304
6305 #define M 42
6306 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
6307
6308 main ()
6309 @{
6310 #define N 28
6311 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6312 #undef N
6313 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
6314 #define N 1729
6315 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
6316 @}
6317 $ cat sample.h
6318 #define Q <
6319 $
6320 @end smallexample
6321
6322 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
6323 We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
6324 compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
6325 information.
6326
6327 @smallexample
6328 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
6329 $
6330 @end smallexample
6331
6332 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
6333
6334 @smallexample
6335 $ gdb -nw sample
6336 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
6337 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6338 GDB is free software, @dots{}
6339 (gdb)
6340 @end smallexample
6341
6342 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
6343 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
6344 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
6345
6346 @smallexample
6347 (gdb) list main
6348 3
6349 4 #define M 42
6350 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
6351 6
6352 7 main ()
6353 8 @{
6354 9 #define N 28
6355 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6356 11 #undef N
6357 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
6358 (gdb) info macro ADD
6359 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
6360 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
6361 (gdb) info macro Q
6362 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
6363 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
6364 #define Q <
6365 (gdb) macro expand ADD(1)
6366 expands to: (42 + 1)
6367 (gdb) macro expand-once ADD(1)
6368 expands to: once (M + 1)
6369 (gdb)
6370 @end smallexample
6371
6372 In the example above, note that @command{macro expand-once} expands only
6373 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
6374 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
6375 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
6376
6377 Once the program is running, GDB uses the macro definitions in force at
6378 the source line of the current stack frame:
6379
6380 @smallexample
6381 (gdb) break main
6382 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
6383 (gdb) run
6384 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
6385
6386 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
6387 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6388 (gdb)
6389 @end smallexample
6390
6391 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
6392
6393 @smallexample
6394 (gdb) info macro N
6395 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
6396 #define N 28
6397 (gdb) macro expand N Q M
6398 expands to: 28 < 42
6399 (gdb) print N Q M
6400 $1 = 1
6401 (gdb)
6402 @end smallexample
6403
6404 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
6405 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
6406 thereof) in force at each point:
6407
6408 @smallexample
6409 (gdb) next
6410 Hello, world!
6411 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
6412 (gdb) info macro N
6413 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
6414 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
6415 (gdb) next
6416 We're so creative.
6417 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
6418 (gdb) info macro N
6419 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
6420 #define N 1729
6421 (gdb) macro expand N Q M
6422 expands to: 1729 < 42
6423 (gdb) print N Q M
6424 $2 = 0
6425 (gdb)
6426 @end smallexample
6427
6428
6429 @node Tracepoints
6430 @chapter Tracepoints
6431 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
6432 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
6433
6434 @cindex tracepoints
6435 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
6436 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
6437 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
6438 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
6439 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
6440 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
6441 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
6442
6443 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
6444 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
6445 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
6446 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
6447 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
6448 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
6449 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
6450 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
6451 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
6452 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
6453 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
6454
6455 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
6456 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know how
6457 to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the remote
6458 stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN} support
6459 tracepoints as of this writing.
6460
6461 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
6462
6463 @menu
6464 * Set Tracepoints::
6465 * Analyze Collected Data::
6466 * Tracepoint Variables::
6467 @end menu
6468
6469 @node Set Tracepoints
6470 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
6471
6472 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
6473 tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
6474 tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
6475 breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
6476 one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
6477 tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
6478 work on.
6479
6480 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
6481 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
6482 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
6483 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
6484 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
6485 tracepoint was hit.
6486
6487 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
6488 conditions and actions.
6489
6490 @menu
6491 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
6492 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
6493 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
6494 * Tracepoint Actions::
6495 * Listing Tracepoints::
6496 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment::
6497 @end menu
6498
6499 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
6500 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
6501
6502 @table @code
6503 @cindex set tracepoint
6504 @kindex trace
6505 @item trace
6506 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
6507 Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
6508 the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
6509 defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
6510 debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
6511 program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
6512 doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
6513 cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
6514 running.
6515
6516 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
6517
6518 @smallexample
6519 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
6520
6521 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
6522
6523 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
6524
6525 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
6526
6527 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
6528 @end smallexample
6529
6530 @noindent
6531 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
6532
6533 @vindex $tpnum
6534 @cindex last tracepoint number
6535 @cindex recent tracepoint number
6536 @cindex tracepoint number
6537 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
6538 of the most recently set tracepoint.
6539
6540 @kindex delete tracepoint
6541 @cindex tracepoint deletion
6542 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6543 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
6544 default is to delete all tracepoints.
6545
6546 Examples:
6547
6548 @smallexample
6549 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
6550
6551 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
6552 @end smallexample
6553
6554 @noindent
6555 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
6556 @end table
6557
6558 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
6559 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
6560
6561 @table @code
6562 @kindex disable tracepoint
6563 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6564 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
6565 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
6566 the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
6567 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
6568
6569 @kindex enable tracepoint
6570 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6571 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
6572 tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
6573 run.
6574 @end table
6575
6576 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
6577 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
6578
6579 @table @code
6580 @kindex passcount
6581 @cindex tracepoint pass count
6582 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
6583 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
6584 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
6585 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
6586 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
6587 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
6588 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
6589 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
6590 user.
6591
6592 Examples:
6593
6594 @smallexample
6595 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
6596 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
6597
6598 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
6599 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
6600 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
6601 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
6602 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
6603 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
6604 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
6605 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
6606 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
6607 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
6608 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
6609 @end smallexample
6610 @end table
6611
6612 @node Tracepoint Actions
6613 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
6614
6615 @table @code
6616 @kindex actions
6617 @cindex tracepoint actions
6618 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6619 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
6620 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
6621 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
6622 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
6623 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
6624 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
6625 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
6626 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
6627 @code{while-stepping}.
6628
6629 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
6630 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
6631 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
6632
6633 @smallexample
6634 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
6635
6636 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
6637
6638 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
6639 @end smallexample
6640
6641 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
6642 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
6643 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
6644 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
6645 followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
6646 @code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
6647 @code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
6648 @code{end} command.
6649
6650 @smallexample
6651 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
6652 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6653 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
6654 > collect bar,baz
6655 > collect $regs
6656 > while-stepping 12
6657 > collect $fp, $sp
6658 > end
6659 end
6660 @end smallexample
6661
6662 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
6663 @item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
6664 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
6665 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
6666 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
6667 special arguments are supported:
6668
6669 @table @code
6670 @item $regs
6671 collect all registers
6672
6673 @item $args
6674 collect all function arguments
6675
6676 @item $locals
6677 collect all local variables.
6678 @end table
6679
6680 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
6681 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
6682 arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
6683
6684 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
6685 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
6686
6687 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
6688 @item while-stepping @var{n}
6689 Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
6690 new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
6691 followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
6692 its own @code{end} command):
6693
6694 @smallexample
6695 > while-stepping 12
6696 > collect $regs, myglobal
6697 > end
6698 >
6699 @end smallexample
6700
6701 @noindent
6702 You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
6703 @code{stepping}.
6704 @end table
6705
6706 @node Listing Tracepoints
6707 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
6708
6709 @table @code
6710 @kindex info tracepoints
6711 @cindex information about tracepoints
6712 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6713 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
6714 a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
6715 defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
6716 shown:
6717
6718 @itemize @bullet
6719 @item
6720 its number
6721 @item
6722 whether it is enabled or disabled
6723 @item
6724 its address
6725 @item
6726 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
6727 @item
6728 its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
6729 @item
6730 where in the source files is the tracepoint set
6731 @item
6732 its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
6733 @end itemize
6734
6735 @smallexample
6736 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
6737 Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
6738 1 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
6739 2 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
6740 3 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
6741 (@value{GDBP})
6742 @end smallexample
6743
6744 @noindent
6745 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
6746 @end table
6747
6748 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
6749 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
6750
6751 @table @code
6752 @kindex tstart
6753 @cindex start a new trace experiment
6754 @cindex collected data discarded
6755 @item tstart
6756 This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
6757 begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
6758 the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
6759 experiment.
6760
6761 @kindex tstop
6762 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
6763 @item tstop
6764 This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
6765 stops collecting data.
6766
6767 @strong{Note:} a trace experiment and data collection may stop
6768 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
6769 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
6770
6771 @kindex tstatus
6772 @cindex status of trace data collection
6773 @cindex trace experiment, status of
6774 @item tstatus
6775 This command displays the status of the current trace data
6776 collection.
6777 @end table
6778
6779 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
6780
6781 @smallexample
6782 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
6783 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6784 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
6785 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
6786 > while-stepping 11
6787 > collect $regs
6788 > end
6789 > end
6790 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6791 [time passes @dots{}]
6792 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
6793 @end smallexample
6794
6795
6796 @node Analyze Collected Data
6797 @section Using the collected data
6798
6799 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
6800 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
6801 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
6802 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
6803 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
6804 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
6805 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
6806 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
6807 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
6808 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
6809 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
6810 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
6811 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
6812 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
6813 the buffer will fail.
6814
6815 @menu
6816 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
6817 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
6818 * save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
6819 @end menu
6820
6821 @node tfind
6822 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
6823
6824 @kindex tfind
6825 @cindex select trace snapshot
6826 @cindex find trace snapshot
6827 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
6828 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
6829 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
6830 snapshot is selected.
6831
6832 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
6833
6834 @table @code
6835 @item tfind start
6836 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
6837 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
6838
6839 @item tfind none
6840 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
6841
6842 @item tfind end
6843 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
6844
6845 @item tfind
6846 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
6847
6848 @item tfind -
6849 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
6850 retracing earlier steps.
6851
6852 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
6853 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
6854 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
6855 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
6856 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
6857
6858 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
6859 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
6860 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
6861 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
6862 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
6863
6864 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6865 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
6866 addresses.
6867
6868 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6869 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
6870 @var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
6871
6872 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
6873 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
6874 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
6875 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
6876 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
6877 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
6878 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
6879 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
6880 @end table
6881
6882 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
6883 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
6884 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
6885 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
6886 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
6887 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
6888 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
6889 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
6890 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
6891 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
6892 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
6893 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
6894 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
6895 tracepoint as the current one.
6896
6897 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
6898 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
6899 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
6900 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
6901 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
6902
6903 @smallexample
6904 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6905 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6906 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
6907 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
6908 > tfind
6909 > end
6910
6911 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
6912 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
6913 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
6914 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
6915 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
6916 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
6917 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
6918 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
6919 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
6920 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
6921 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
6922 @end smallexample
6923
6924 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
6925 the buffer:
6926
6927 @smallexample
6928 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6929 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6930 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
6931 > tfind line
6932 > end
6933
6934 Frame 0, X = 1
6935 Frame 7, X = 2
6936 Frame 13, X = 255
6937 @end smallexample
6938
6939 @node tdump
6940 @subsection @code{tdump}
6941 @kindex tdump
6942 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
6943 @cindex tracepoint data, display
6944
6945 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
6946 the current trace snapshot.
6947
6948 @smallexample
6949 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
6950 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6951 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
6952 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
6953 > end
6954
6955 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6956
6957 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
6958 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
6959 at gdb_test.c:444
6960 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
6961
6962 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
6963 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
6964 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
6965 d1 0x18 24
6966 d2 0x80 128
6967 d3 0x33 51
6968 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
6969 d5 0x22 34
6970 d6 0xe0 224
6971 d7 0x380035 3670069
6972 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
6973 a1 0x3000668 50333288
6974 a2 0x100 256
6975 a3 0x322000 3284992
6976 a4 0x3000698 50333336
6977 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
6978 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
6979 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
6980 ps 0x0 0
6981 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
6982 fpcontrol 0x0 0
6983 fpstatus 0x0 0
6984 fpiaddr 0x0 0
6985 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
6986 p1 = (void *) 0x11
6987 p2 = (void *) 0x22
6988 p3 = (void *) 0x33
6989 p4 = (void *) 0x44
6990 p5 = (void *) 0x55
6991 p6 = (void *) 0x66
6992 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
6993
6994 (@value{GDBP})
6995 @end smallexample
6996
6997 @node save-tracepoints
6998 @subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
6999 @kindex save-tracepoints
7000 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
7001
7002 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
7003 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
7004 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
7005 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
7006 Files}).
7007
7008 @node Tracepoint Variables
7009 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
7010 @cindex tracepoint variables
7011 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
7012
7013 @table @code
7014 @vindex $trace_frame
7015 @item (int) $trace_frame
7016 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
7017 snapshot is selected.
7018
7019 @vindex $tracepoint
7020 @item (int) $tracepoint
7021 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
7022
7023 @vindex $trace_line
7024 @item (int) $trace_line
7025 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
7026
7027 @vindex $trace_file
7028 @item (char []) $trace_file
7029 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
7030
7031 @vindex $trace_func
7032 @item (char []) $trace_func
7033 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
7034 @end table
7035
7036 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
7037 use @code{output} instead.
7038
7039 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
7040 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
7041 data.
7042
7043 @smallexample
7044 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
7045
7046 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
7047 > output $trace_file
7048 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
7049 > tfind
7050 > end
7051 @end smallexample
7052
7053 @node Overlays
7054 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
7055 @cindex overlays
7056
7057 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
7058 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
7059 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
7060 use overlays.
7061
7062 @menu
7063 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
7064 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
7065 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
7066 mapped by asking the inferior.
7067 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
7068 @end menu
7069
7070 @node How Overlays Work
7071 @section How Overlays Work
7072 @cindex mapped overlays
7073 @cindex unmapped overlays
7074 @cindex load address, overlay's
7075 @cindex mapped address
7076 @cindex overlay area
7077
7078 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
7079 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
7080 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
7081 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
7082 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
7083
7084 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
7085 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
7086 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
7087 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
7088 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
7089 largest overlay as well.
7090
7091 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
7092 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
7093 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
7094 there.
7095
7096 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
7097 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
7098 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
7099
7100 @smallexample
7101 @group
7102 Data Instruction Larger
7103 Address Space Address Space Address Space
7104 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
7105 | | | | | |
7106 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
7107 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
7108 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
7109 | and heap | | | | | |
7110 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
7111 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
7112 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
7113 | | | | | |
7114 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
7115 address | | | | | |
7116 | overlay | <-' | | |
7117 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
7118 | | <---. | | load address
7119 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
7120 | | | |
7121 +-----------+ | |
7122 +-----------+
7123 | |
7124 +-----------+
7125
7126 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
7127 @end group
7128 @end smallexample
7129
7130 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
7131 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
7132 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
7133 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
7134 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
7135 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
7136 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
7137 program and the overlay area.
7138
7139 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
7140 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
7141 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
7142 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
7143 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
7144 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
7145 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
7146
7147 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
7148 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
7149 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
7150
7151 @itemize @bullet
7152
7153 @item
7154 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
7155 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
7156 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
7157 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
7158
7159 @item
7160 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
7161 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
7162 your program's performance.
7163
7164 @item
7165 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
7166 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
7167 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
7168 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
7169 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
7170 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
7171 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
7172
7173 @item
7174 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
7175 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
7176 instruction and data spaces.
7177
7178 @end itemize
7179
7180 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
7181 improved in many ways:
7182
7183 @itemize @bullet
7184
7185 @item
7186 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
7187 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
7188 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
7189 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
7190 area in the usual way.
7191
7192 @item
7193 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
7194 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
7195
7196 @item
7197 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
7198 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
7199 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
7200 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
7201 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
7202 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
7203 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
7204
7205 @end itemize
7206
7207
7208 @node Overlay Commands
7209 @section Overlay Commands
7210
7211 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
7212 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
7213 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
7214 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
7215 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
7216 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
7217
7218 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
7219 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
7220
7221 @table @code
7222 @item overlay off
7223 @kindex overlay off
7224 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
7225 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
7226 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
7227 overlay support is disabled.
7228
7229 @item overlay manual
7230 @kindex overlay manual
7231 @cindex manual overlay debugging
7232 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
7233 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
7234 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
7235 commands described below.
7236
7237 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
7238 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
7239 @kindex overlay map-overlay
7240 @cindex map an overlay
7241 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
7242 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
7243 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
7244 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
7245 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
7246 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
7247
7248 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
7249 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
7250 @kindex overlay unmap-overlay
7251 @cindex unmap an overlay
7252 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
7253 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
7254 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
7255 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
7256
7257 @item overlay auto
7258 @kindex overlay auto
7259 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
7260 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
7261 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
7262 Overlay Debugging}.
7263
7264 @item overlay load-target
7265 @itemx overlay load
7266 @kindex overlay load-target
7267 @cindex reloading the overlay table
7268 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
7269 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
7270 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
7271 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
7272 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
7273
7274 @item overlay list-overlays
7275 @itemx overlay list
7276 @cindex listing mapped overlays
7277 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
7278 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
7279
7280 @end table
7281
7282 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
7283 of the function the address falls in:
7284
7285 @smallexample
7286 (gdb) print main
7287 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
7288 @end smallexample
7289 @noindent
7290 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
7291 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
7292 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
7293 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
7294
7295 @smallexample
7296 (gdb) overlay list
7297 No sections are mapped.
7298 (gdb) print foo
7299 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
7300 @end smallexample
7301 @noindent
7302 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
7303 name normally:
7304
7305 @smallexample
7306 (gdb) overlay list
7307 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
7308 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
7309 (gdb) print foo
7310 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
7311 @end smallexample
7312
7313 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
7314 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
7315 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
7316 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
7317 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
7318
7319 @itemize @bullet
7320 @item
7321 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
7322 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
7323 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
7324 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
7325 @item
7326 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
7327 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
7328 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
7329 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
7330 breakpoints properly.
7331 @end itemize
7332
7333
7334 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
7335 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
7336 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
7337
7338 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
7339 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
7340 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
7341 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
7342 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
7343 current state of the overlays.
7344
7345 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
7346 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
7347
7348 @table @asis
7349
7350 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
7351 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
7352
7353 @smallexample
7354 struct
7355 @{
7356 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
7357 unsigned long vma;
7358
7359 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
7360 unsigned long size;
7361
7362 /* The overlay's load address. */
7363 unsigned long lma;
7364
7365 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
7366 zero otherwise. */
7367 unsigned long mapped;
7368 @}
7369 @end smallexample
7370
7371 @item @code{_novlys}:
7372 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
7373 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
7374
7375 @end table
7376
7377 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
7378 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
7379 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
7380 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
7381 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
7382 currently mapped.
7383
7384 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
7385 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
7386 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
7387 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
7388 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
7389 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
7390 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
7391 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
7392 are not being executed.
7393
7394 @node Overlay Sample Program
7395 @section Overlay Sample Program
7396 @cindex overlay example program
7397
7398 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
7399 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
7400 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
7401 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
7402 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
7403 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
7404 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
7405
7406 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
7407 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
7408 suite. The program consists of the following files from
7409 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
7410
7411 @table @file
7412 @item overlays.c
7413 The main program file.
7414 @item ovlymgr.c
7415 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
7416 @item foo.c
7417 @itemx bar.c
7418 @itemx baz.c
7419 @itemx grbx.c
7420 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
7421 @item d10v.ld
7422 @itemx m32r.ld
7423 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
7424 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
7425 @end table
7426
7427 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
7428 cross-compiler like this:
7429
7430 @smallexample
7431 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
7432 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
7433 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
7434 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
7435 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
7436 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
7437 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
7438 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
7439 @end smallexample
7440
7441 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
7442 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
7443 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
7444
7445
7446 @node Languages
7447 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
7448 @cindex languages
7449
7450 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
7451 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
7452 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
7453 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
7454 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
7455 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
7456
7457 @cindex working language
7458 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
7459 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
7460 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
7461 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
7462 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
7463 language}.
7464
7465 @menu
7466 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
7467 * Show:: Displaying the language
7468 * Checks:: Type and range checks
7469 * Support:: Supported languages
7470 * Unsupported languages:: Unsupported languages
7471 @end menu
7472
7473 @node Setting
7474 @section Switching between source languages
7475
7476 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
7477 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
7478 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
7479 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
7480 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
7481 are printed, etc.
7482
7483 In addition to the working language, every source file that
7484 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
7485 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
7486 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
7487 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
7488 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
7489 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
7490 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
7491 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
7492 Displaying the language}.
7493
7494 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
7495 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
7496 another language. In that case, make the
7497 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
7498 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
7499 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
7500
7501 @menu
7502 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
7503 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
7504 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
7505 @end menu
7506
7507 @node Filenames
7508 @subsection List of filename extensions and languages
7509
7510 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
7511 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
7512
7513 @table @file
7514
7515 @item .c
7516 C source file
7517
7518 @item .C
7519 @itemx .cc
7520 @itemx .cp
7521 @itemx .cpp
7522 @itemx .cxx
7523 @itemx .c++
7524 C@t{++} source file
7525
7526 @item .m
7527 Objective-C source file
7528
7529 @item .f
7530 @itemx .F
7531 Fortran source file
7532
7533 @item .mod
7534 Modula-2 source file
7535
7536 @item .s
7537 @itemx .S
7538 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
7539 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
7540 @end table
7541
7542 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
7543 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
7544
7545 @node Manually
7546 @subsection Setting the working language
7547
7548 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
7549 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
7550 your program.
7551
7552 @kindex set language
7553 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
7554 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
7555 a language, such as
7556 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
7557 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
7558
7559 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
7560 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
7561 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
7562 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
7563 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
7564 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
7565 command such as:
7566
7567 @smallexample
7568 print a = b + c
7569 @end smallexample
7570
7571 @noindent
7572 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
7573 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
7574 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
7575 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
7576
7577 @node Automatically
7578 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
7579
7580 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
7581 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
7582 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
7583 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
7584 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
7585 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
7586 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
7587 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
7588 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
7589
7590 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
7591 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
7592 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
7593 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
7594 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
7595
7596 @node Show
7597 @section Displaying the language
7598
7599 The following commands help you find out which language is the
7600 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
7601
7602 @kindex show language
7603 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
7604 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
7605 @table @code
7606 @item show language
7607 Display the current working language. This is the
7608 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
7609 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
7610
7611 @item info frame
7612 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
7613 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
7614 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
7615 information listed here.
7616
7617 @item info source
7618 Display the source language of this source file.
7619 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
7620 information listed here.
7621 @end table
7622
7623 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
7624 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
7625 with a language explicitly:
7626
7627 @kindex set extension-language
7628 @kindex info extensions
7629 @table @code
7630 @item set extension-language @var{.ext} @var{language}
7631 Set source files with extension @var{.ext} to be assumed to be in
7632 the source language @var{language}.
7633
7634 @item info extensions
7635 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
7636 @end table
7637
7638 @node Checks
7639 @section Type and range checking
7640
7641 @quotation
7642 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
7643 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
7644 section documents the intended facilities.
7645 @end quotation
7646 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
7647
7648 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
7649 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
7650 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
7651 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
7652 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
7653 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
7654 errors when your program is running.
7655
7656 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
7657 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program, it
7658 can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via
7659 the @code{print} command, for example. As with the working language,
7660 @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check automatically based on
7661 your program's source language. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages},
7662 for the default settings of supported languages.
7663
7664 @menu
7665 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
7666 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
7667 @end menu
7668
7669 @cindex type checking
7670 @cindex checks, type
7671 @node Type Checking
7672 @subsection An overview of type checking
7673
7674 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
7675 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
7676 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
7677 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
7678
7679 @smallexample
7680 1 + 2 @result{} 3
7681 @exdent but
7682 @error{} 1 + 2.3
7683 @end smallexample
7684
7685 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
7686 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
7687
7688 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
7689 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
7690 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
7691 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
7692 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
7693 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
7694 also issues a warning.
7695
7696 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
7697 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
7698 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
7699 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
7700 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
7701 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
7702
7703 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
7704 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
7705 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
7706 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
7707 operators. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for further
7708 details on specific languages.
7709
7710 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
7711
7712 @kindex set check@r{, type}
7713 @kindex set check type
7714 @kindex show check type
7715 @table @code
7716 @item set check type auto
7717 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
7718 @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
7719 each language.
7720
7721 @item set check type on
7722 @itemx set check type off
7723 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
7724 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
7725 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
7726 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
7727 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
7728
7729 @item set check type warn
7730 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
7731 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
7732 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
7733 numbers and structures.
7734
7735 @item show type
7736 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
7737 is setting it automatically.
7738 @end table
7739
7740 @cindex range checking
7741 @cindex checks, range
7742 @node Range Checking
7743 @subsection An overview of range checking
7744
7745 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
7746 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
7747 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
7748 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
7749 not exceed the bounds of the array.
7750
7751 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
7752 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
7753 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
7754 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
7755
7756 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
7757 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
7758 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
7759 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
7760 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
7761 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
7762
7763 @smallexample
7764 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
7765 @end smallexample
7766
7767 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
7768 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Support, ,
7769 Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
7770
7771 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
7772
7773 @kindex set check@r{, range}
7774 @kindex set check range
7775 @kindex show check range
7776 @table @code
7777 @item set check range auto
7778 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
7779 @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
7780 each language.
7781
7782 @item set check range on
7783 @itemx set check range off
7784 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
7785 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
7786 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
7787 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
7788
7789 @item set check range warn
7790 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
7791 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
7792 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
7793 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
7794 systems).
7795
7796 @item show range
7797 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
7798 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
7799 @end table
7800
7801 @node Support
7802 @section Supported languages
7803
7804 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, Java, assembly, and Modula-2.
7805 @c This is false ...
7806 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
7807 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
7808 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
7809 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
7810 language.
7811
7812 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
7813 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
7814 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
7815 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
7816 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
7817 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
7818 language reference or tutorial.
7819
7820 @menu
7821 * C:: C and C@t{++}
7822 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
7823 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
7824 @end menu
7825
7826 @node C
7827 @subsection C and C@t{++}
7828
7829 @cindex C and C@t{++}
7830 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
7831
7832 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
7833 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
7834 together.
7835
7836 @cindex C@t{++}
7837 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
7838 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
7839 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
7840 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
7841 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
7842 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
7843 compiler (@code{aCC}).
7844
7845 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
7846 format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
7847 format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
7848 command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
7849 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
7850 CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}.
7851
7852 @menu
7853 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
7854 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
7855 * C plus plus expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
7856 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
7857 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
7858 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
7859 * Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
7860 @end menu
7861
7862 @node C Operators
7863 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} operators
7864
7865 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
7866
7867 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
7868 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
7869 often defined on groups of types.
7870
7871 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
7872
7873 @itemize @bullet
7874
7875 @item
7876 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
7877 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
7878
7879 @item
7880 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
7881 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
7882
7883 @item
7884 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
7885
7886 @item
7887 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
7888
7889 @end itemize
7890
7891 @noindent
7892 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
7893 in order of increasing precedence:
7894
7895 @table @code
7896 @item ,
7897 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
7898 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
7899 expression being the last expression evaluated.
7900
7901 @item =
7902 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
7903 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
7904
7905 @item @var{op}=
7906 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
7907 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
7908 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
7909 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
7910 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
7911
7912 @item ?:
7913 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
7914 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
7915 integral type.
7916
7917 @item ||
7918 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7919
7920 @item &&
7921 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
7922
7923 @item |
7924 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7925
7926 @item ^
7927 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7928
7929 @item &
7930 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
7931
7932 @item ==@r{, }!=
7933 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
7934 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
7935
7936 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
7937 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
7938 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
7939 and non-zero for true.
7940
7941 @item <<@r{, }>>
7942 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
7943
7944 @item @@
7945 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
7946
7947 @item +@r{, }-
7948 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
7949 pointer types.
7950
7951 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
7952 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
7953 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
7954 integral types.
7955
7956 @item ++@r{, }--
7957 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
7958 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
7959 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
7960 operation takes place.
7961
7962 @item *
7963 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
7964 @code{++}.
7965
7966 @item &
7967 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
7968
7969 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
7970 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
7971 (or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
7972 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
7973 stored.
7974
7975 @item -
7976 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
7977 precedence as @code{++}.
7978
7979 @item !
7980 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
7981 @code{++}.
7982
7983 @item ~
7984 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
7985 @code{++}.
7986
7987
7988 @item .@r{, }->
7989 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
7990 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
7991 pointer based on the stored type information.
7992 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
7993
7994 @item .*@r{, }->*
7995 Dereferences of pointers to members.
7996
7997 @item []
7998 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
7999 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
8000
8001 @item ()
8002 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
8003
8004 @item ::
8005 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
8006 and @code{class} types.
8007
8008 @item ::
8009 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
8010 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
8011 above.
8012 @end table
8013
8014 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
8015 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
8016 predefined meaning.
8017
8018 @menu
8019 * C Constants::
8020 @end menu
8021
8022 @node C Constants
8023 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} constants
8024
8025 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
8026
8027 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
8028 following ways:
8029
8030 @itemize @bullet
8031 @item
8032 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
8033 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
8034 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
8035 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
8036 @code{long} value.
8037
8038 @item
8039 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
8040 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
8041 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
8042 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
8043 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
8044 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
8045 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
8046 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
8047 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
8048 constant.
8049
8050 @item
8051 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
8052 integral equivalents.
8053
8054 @item
8055 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
8056 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
8057 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
8058 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
8059 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
8060 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
8061 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
8062 @samp{\n} for newline.
8063
8064 @item
8065 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
8066 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
8067 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
8068 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
8069 characters.
8070
8071 @item
8072 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
8073 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
8074
8075 @item
8076 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
8077 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
8078 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
8079 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
8080 @end itemize
8081
8082 @menu
8083 * C plus plus expressions::
8084 * C Defaults::
8085 * C Checks::
8086
8087 * Debugging C::
8088 @end menu
8089
8090 @node C plus plus expressions
8091 @subsubsection C@t{++} expressions
8092
8093 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
8094 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
8095
8096 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
8097 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
8098 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
8099 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
8100 @quotation
8101 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
8102 proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
8103 works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
8104 @value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
8105 @option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
8106 stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
8107 stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
8108 specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
8109 are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
8110 C@t{++} code.
8111 @end quotation
8112
8113 @enumerate
8114
8115 @cindex member functions
8116 @item
8117 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
8118
8119 @smallexample
8120 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
8121 @end smallexample
8122
8123 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
8124 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
8125 @item
8126 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
8127 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
8128 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
8129 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
8130
8131 @cindex call overloaded functions
8132 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
8133 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
8134 @item
8135 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
8136 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
8137 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
8138 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
8139 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
8140 default arguments.
8141
8142 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
8143 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
8144 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
8145 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
8146 number of function arguments.
8147
8148 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
8149 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
8150 ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
8151
8152 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
8153 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
8154 @smallexample
8155 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
8156 @end smallexample
8157
8158 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
8159 see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
8160
8161 @cindex reference declarations
8162 @item
8163 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
8164 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
8165 dereferenced.
8166
8167 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
8168 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
8169 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
8170 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
8171 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
8172
8173 @item
8174 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
8175 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
8176 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
8177 necessary, for example in an expression like
8178 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
8179 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
8180 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
8181 @end enumerate
8182
8183 In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
8184 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
8185 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
8186 invoking user-defined operators.
8187
8188 @node C Defaults
8189 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} defaults
8190
8191 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
8192
8193 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
8194 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
8195 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
8196 selects the working language.
8197
8198 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
8199 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
8200 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
8201 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
8202 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
8203 for further details.
8204
8205 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
8206 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
8207 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
8208
8209 @node C Checks
8210 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} type and range checks
8211
8212 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
8213
8214 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
8215 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
8216 considers two variables type equivalent if:
8217
8218 @itemize @bullet
8219 @item
8220 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
8221 enumerated tag.
8222
8223 @item
8224 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
8225 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
8226
8227 @ignore
8228 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
8229 @c FIXME--beers?
8230 @item
8231 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
8232 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
8233 compilers.)
8234 @end ignore
8235 @end itemize
8236
8237 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
8238 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
8239 that is not itself an array.
8240
8241 @node Debugging C
8242 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
8243
8244 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
8245 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
8246 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
8247 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
8248
8249 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
8250 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
8251 ,Expressions}.
8252
8253 @menu
8254 * Debugging C plus plus::
8255 @end menu
8256
8257 @node Debugging C plus plus
8258 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
8259
8260 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
8261
8262 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
8263 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
8264
8265 @table @code
8266 @cindex break in overloaded functions
8267 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
8268 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
8269 @value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
8270 you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
8271
8272 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
8273 @item rbreak @var{regex}
8274 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
8275 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
8276 classes.
8277 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
8278
8279 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
8280 @item catch throw
8281 @itemx catch catch
8282 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
8283 Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
8284
8285 @cindex inheritance
8286 @item ptype @var{typename}
8287 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
8288 @var{typename}.
8289 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
8290
8291 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
8292 @item set print demangle
8293 @itemx show print demangle
8294 @itemx set print asm-demangle
8295 @itemx show print asm-demangle
8296 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
8297 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
8298 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
8299
8300 @item set print object
8301 @itemx show print object
8302 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
8303 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
8304
8305 @item set print vtbl
8306 @itemx show print vtbl
8307 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
8308 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
8309 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
8310 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
8311
8312 @kindex set overload-resolution
8313 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
8314 @item set overload-resolution on
8315 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
8316 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
8317 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
8318 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C@t{++}
8319 expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
8320 message.
8321
8322 @item set overload-resolution off
8323 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
8324 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
8325 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
8326 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
8327 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
8328 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
8329 argument types.
8330
8331 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
8332 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
8333 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
8334 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
8335 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
8336 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
8337 @xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
8338 @end table
8339
8340 @node Objective-C
8341 @subsection Objective-C
8342
8343 @cindex Objective-C
8344 This section provides information about some commands and command
8345 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code.
8346
8347 @menu
8348 * Method Names in Commands::
8349 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
8350 @end menu
8351
8352 @node Method Names in Commands, The Print Command with Objective-C, Objective-C, Objective-C
8353 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
8354
8355 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
8356 names as line specifications:
8357
8358 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
8359 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
8360 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
8361 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
8362 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
8363 @itemize
8364 @item @code{clear}
8365 @item @code{break}
8366 @item @code{info line}
8367 @item @code{jump}
8368 @item @code{list}
8369 @end itemize
8370
8371 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
8372
8373 @smallexample
8374 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
8375 @end smallexample
8376
8377 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a plus
8378 sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The
8379 class name @var{Class} and method name @var{methoName} are enclosed in
8380 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C source
8381 code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create} instance method of
8382 class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being debugged, enter:
8383
8384 @smallexample
8385 break -[Fruit create]
8386 @end smallexample
8387
8388 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
8389 enter:
8390
8391 @smallexample
8392 list +[NSText initialize]
8393 @end smallexample
8394
8395 In the current version of GDB, the plus or minus sign is required. In
8396 future versions of GDB, the plus or minus sign will be optional, but you
8397 can use it to narrow the search. It is also possible to specify just a
8398 method name:
8399
8400 @smallexample
8401 break create
8402 @end smallexample
8403
8404 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
8405 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
8406 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
8407 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
8408 none apply.
8409
8410 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
8411 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
8412
8413 @smallexample
8414 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
8415 @end smallexample
8416
8417 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
8418 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
8419
8420 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
8421
8422 @smallexample
8423 print -[object hash]
8424 @end smallexample
8425
8426 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
8427 will tell gdb to send the -hash message to object and print the
8428 result. Also an additional command has been added, @code{print-object}
8429 or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print the description of an
8430 object. However, this command may only work with certain Objective-C
8431 libraries that have a particular hook function, called
8432 @code{_NSPrintForDebugger} defined.
8433
8434 @node Modula-2, , Objective-C, Support
8435 @subsection Modula-2
8436
8437 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
8438
8439 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
8440 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
8441 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
8442 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
8443 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
8444 table.
8445
8446 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
8447 @menu
8448 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
8449 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
8450 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
8451 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
8452 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
8453 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
8454 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
8455 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
8456 @end menu
8457
8458 @node M2 Operators
8459 @subsubsection Operators
8460 @cindex Modula-2 operators
8461
8462 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
8463 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
8464 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
8465 following definitions hold:
8466
8467 @itemize @bullet
8468
8469 @item
8470 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
8471 their subranges.
8472
8473 @item
8474 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
8475
8476 @item
8477 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
8478
8479 @item
8480 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
8481 @var{type}}.
8482
8483 @item
8484 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
8485
8486 @item
8487 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
8488
8489 @item
8490 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
8491 @end itemize
8492
8493 @noindent
8494 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
8495 increasing precedence:
8496
8497 @table @code
8498 @item ,
8499 Function argument or array index separator.
8500
8501 @item :=
8502 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
8503 @var{value}.
8504
8505 @item <@r{, }>
8506 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
8507 types.
8508
8509 @item <=@r{, }>=
8510 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
8511 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
8512 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
8513
8514 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
8515 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
8516 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
8517 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
8518 comment character.
8519
8520 @item IN
8521 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
8522 Same precedence as @code{<}.
8523
8524 @item OR
8525 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
8526
8527 @item AND@r{, }&
8528 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
8529
8530 @item @@
8531 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
8532
8533 @item +@r{, }-
8534 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
8535 and difference on set types.
8536
8537 @item *
8538 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
8539 on set types.
8540
8541 @item /
8542 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
8543 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
8544
8545 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
8546 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
8547 precedence as @code{*}.
8548
8549 @item -
8550 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
8551
8552 @item ^
8553 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
8554
8555 @item NOT
8556 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
8557 @code{^}.
8558
8559 @item .
8560 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
8561 precedence as @code{^}.
8562
8563 @item []
8564 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
8565
8566 @item ()
8567 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
8568 as @code{^}.
8569
8570 @item ::@r{, }.
8571 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
8572 @end table
8573
8574 @quotation
8575 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
8576 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
8577 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
8578 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
8579 @end quotation
8580
8581
8582 @node Built-In Func/Proc
8583 @subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
8584 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
8585
8586 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
8587 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
8588
8589 @table @var
8590
8591 @item a
8592 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
8593
8594 @item c
8595 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
8596
8597 @item i
8598 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
8599
8600 @item m
8601 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
8602 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
8603 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
8604
8605 @item n
8606 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
8607
8608 @item r
8609 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
8610
8611 @item t
8612 represents a type.
8613
8614 @item v
8615 represents a variable.
8616
8617 @item x
8618 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
8619 explanation of the function for details.
8620 @end table
8621
8622 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
8623
8624 @table @code
8625 @item ABS(@var{n})
8626 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
8627
8628 @item CAP(@var{c})
8629 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
8630 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
8631
8632 @item CHR(@var{i})
8633 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
8634
8635 @item DEC(@var{v})
8636 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
8637
8638 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
8639 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
8640 new value.
8641
8642 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
8643 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
8644 set.
8645
8646 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
8647 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
8648
8649 @item HIGH(@var{a})
8650 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
8651
8652 @item INC(@var{v})
8653 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
8654
8655 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
8656 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
8657 new value.
8658
8659 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
8660 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
8661 there. Returns the new set.
8662
8663 @item MAX(@var{t})
8664 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
8665
8666 @item MIN(@var{t})
8667 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
8668
8669 @item ODD(@var{i})
8670 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
8671
8672 @item ORD(@var{x})
8673 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
8674 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
8675 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
8676 integral, character and enumerated types.
8677
8678 @item SIZE(@var{x})
8679 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
8680
8681 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
8682 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
8683
8684 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
8685 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
8686 @end table
8687
8688 @quotation
8689 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
8690 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
8691 an error.
8692 @end quotation
8693
8694 @cindex Modula-2 constants
8695 @node M2 Constants
8696 @subsubsection Constants
8697
8698 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
8699 ways:
8700
8701 @itemize @bullet
8702
8703 @item
8704 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
8705 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
8706 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
8707 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
8708
8709 @item
8710 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
8711 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
8712 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
8713 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
8714 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
8715 digits.
8716
8717 @item
8718 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
8719 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
8720 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
8721 followed by a @samp{C}.
8722
8723 @item
8724 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
8725 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
8726 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
8727 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
8728 sequences.
8729
8730 @item
8731 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
8732
8733 @item
8734 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
8735 @code{FALSE}.
8736
8737 @item
8738 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
8739
8740 @item
8741 Set constants are not yet supported.
8742 @end itemize
8743
8744 @node M2 Defaults
8745 @subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
8746 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
8747
8748 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
8749 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
8750 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
8751 selected the working language.
8752
8753 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
8754 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
8755 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
8756 the language automatically}, for further details.
8757
8758 @node Deviations
8759 @subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
8760 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
8761
8762 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
8763 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
8764
8765 @itemize @bullet
8766 @item
8767 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
8768 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
8769 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
8770 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
8771 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
8772 returned a pointer.)
8773
8774 @item
8775 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
8776 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
8777 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
8778 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
8779
8780 @item
8781 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
8782 argument.
8783
8784 @item
8785 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
8786 @end itemize
8787
8788 @node M2 Checks
8789 @subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
8790 @cindex Modula-2 checks
8791
8792 @quotation
8793 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
8794 range checking.
8795 @end quotation
8796 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
8797
8798 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
8799
8800 @itemize @bullet
8801 @item
8802 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
8803 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
8804
8805 @item
8806 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
8807 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
8808 @end itemize
8809
8810 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
8811 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
8812
8813 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
8814 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
8815
8816 @node M2 Scope
8817 @subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
8818 @cindex scope
8819 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
8820 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
8821 @ifinfo
8822 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
8823 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
8824 @end ifinfo
8825 @iftex
8826 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
8827 @end iftex
8828
8829 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
8830 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
8831 similar syntax:
8832
8833 @smallexample
8834
8835 @var{module} . @var{id}
8836 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
8837 @end smallexample
8838
8839 @noindent
8840 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
8841 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
8842 identifier within your program, except another module.
8843
8844 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
8845 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
8846 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
8847 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
8848
8849 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
8850 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
8851 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
8852 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
8853 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
8854 @var{module}.
8855
8856 @node GDB/M2
8857 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
8858
8859 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
8860 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
8861 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
8862 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
8863 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
8864 analogue in Modula-2.
8865
8866 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
8867 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
8868 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
8869 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
8870 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
8871 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
8872
8873 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
8874 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
8875 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
8876
8877 @node Unsupported languages
8878 @section Unsupported languages
8879
8880 @cindex unsupported languages
8881 @cindex minimal language
8882 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
8883 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
8884 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
8885 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
8886 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
8887 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
8888
8889 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
8890 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
8891 language.
8892
8893 @node Symbols
8894 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
8895
8896 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
8897 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
8898 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
8899 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
8900 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
8901 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
8902 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
8903
8904 @cindex symbol names
8905 @cindex names of symbols
8906 @cindex quoting names
8907 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
8908 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
8909 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
8910 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
8911 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
8912 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
8913 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
8914 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
8915
8916 @smallexample
8917 p 'foo.c'::x
8918 @end smallexample
8919
8920 @noindent
8921 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
8922
8923 @table @code
8924 @kindex info address
8925 @cindex address of a symbol
8926 @item info address @var{symbol}
8927 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
8928 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
8929 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
8930 is always stored.
8931
8932 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
8933 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
8934 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
8935
8936 @kindex info symbol
8937 @cindex symbol from address
8938 @item info symbol @var{addr}
8939 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
8940 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
8941 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
8942
8943 @smallexample
8944 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
8945 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
8946 @end smallexample
8947
8948 @noindent
8949 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
8950 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
8951
8952 @kindex whatis
8953 @item whatis @var{expr}
8954 Print the data type of expression @var{expr}. @var{expr} is not
8955 actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
8956 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
8957 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
8958
8959 @item whatis
8960 Print the data type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
8961
8962 @kindex ptype
8963 @item ptype @var{typename}
8964 Print a description of data type @var{typename}. @var{typename} may be
8965 the name of a type, or for C code it may have the form @samp{class
8966 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
8967 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
8968
8969 @item ptype @var{expr}
8970 @itemx ptype
8971 Print a description of the type of expression @var{expr}. @code{ptype}
8972 differs from @code{whatis} by printing a detailed description, instead
8973 of just the name of the type.
8974
8975 For example, for this variable declaration:
8976
8977 @smallexample
8978 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
8979 @end smallexample
8980
8981 @noindent
8982 the two commands give this output:
8983
8984 @smallexample
8985 @group
8986 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
8987 type = struct complex
8988 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
8989 type = struct complex @{
8990 double real;
8991 double imag;
8992 @}
8993 @end group
8994 @end smallexample
8995
8996 @noindent
8997 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
8998 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
8999
9000 @kindex info types
9001 @item info types @var{regexp}
9002 @itemx info types
9003 Print a brief description of all types whose names match @var{regexp}
9004 (or all types in your program, if you supply no argument). Each
9005 complete typename is matched as though it were a complete line; thus,
9006 @samp{i type value} gives information on all types in your program whose
9007 names include the string @code{value}, but @samp{i type ^value$} gives
9008 information only on types whose complete name is @code{value}.
9009
9010 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
9011 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
9012 lists all source files where a type is defined.
9013
9014 @kindex info scope
9015 @cindex local variables
9016 @item info scope @var{addr}
9017 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
9018 accepts a location---a function name, a source line, or an address
9019 preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local to the
9020 scope defined by that location. For example:
9021
9022 @smallexample
9023 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
9024 Scope for command_line_handler:
9025 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
9026 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
9027 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
9028 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
9029 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
9030 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
9031 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
9032 @end smallexample
9033
9034 @noindent
9035 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
9036 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
9037 collect}.
9038
9039 @kindex info source
9040 @item info source
9041 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
9042 the function containing the current point of execution:
9043 @itemize @bullet
9044 @item
9045 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
9046 @item
9047 the directory it was compiled in,
9048 @item
9049 its length, in lines,
9050 @item
9051 which programming language it is written in,
9052 @item
9053 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
9054 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
9055 @item
9056 whether the debugging information includes information about
9057 preprocessor macros.
9058 @end itemize
9059
9060
9061 @kindex info sources
9062 @item info sources
9063 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
9064 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
9065 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
9066
9067 @kindex info functions
9068 @item info functions
9069 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
9070
9071 @item info functions @var{regexp}
9072 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
9073 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
9074 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
9075 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
9076 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
9077 that conflict with the regular expression language (eg.
9078 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
9079
9080 @kindex info variables
9081 @item info variables
9082 Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
9083 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
9084
9085 @item info variables @var{regexp}
9086 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
9087 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
9088 @var{regexp}.
9089
9090 @kindex info classes
9091 @item info classes
9092 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
9093 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
9094 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
9095 expression.
9096
9097 @kindex info selectors
9098 @item info selectors
9099 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
9100 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
9101 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
9102 expression.
9103
9104 @ignore
9105 This was never implemented.
9106 @kindex info methods
9107 @item info methods
9108 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
9109 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
9110 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
9111 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
9112 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
9113 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
9114 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
9115 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
9116 @end ignore
9117
9118 @cindex reloading symbols
9119 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
9120 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
9121 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
9122 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
9123 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
9124
9125 @table @code
9126 @kindex set symbol-reloading
9127 @item set symbol-reloading on
9128 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
9129 object file with a particular name is seen again.
9130
9131 @item set symbol-reloading off
9132 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
9133 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
9134 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
9135 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
9136 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
9137 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
9138 name.
9139
9140 @kindex show symbol-reloading
9141 @item show symbol-reloading
9142 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
9143 @end table
9144
9145 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
9146 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
9147 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
9148 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
9149 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
9150 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
9151 another source file. The default is on.
9152
9153 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
9154 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
9155
9156 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
9157 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
9158 is printed as follows:
9159 @smallexample
9160 @{<no data fields>@}
9161 @end smallexample
9162
9163 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
9164 @item show opaque-type-resolution
9165 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
9166
9167 @kindex maint print symbols
9168 @cindex symbol dump
9169 @kindex maint print psymbols
9170 @cindex partial symbol dump
9171 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
9172 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
9173 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
9174 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
9175 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
9176 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
9177 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
9178 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
9179 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
9180 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
9181 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
9182 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
9183 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
9184 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
9185 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
9186 @xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
9187 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
9188
9189 @kindex maint info symtabs
9190 @kindex maint info psymtabs
9191 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
9192 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
9193 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
9194 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
9195 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
9196 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
9197
9198 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
9199 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
9200 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
9201 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
9202 structure in more detail. For example:
9203
9204 @smallexample
9205 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
9206 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
9207 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
9208 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
9209 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
9210 readin no
9211 fullname (null)
9212 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
9213 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
9214 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
9215 dependencies (none)
9216 @}
9217 @}
9218 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
9219 (@value{GDBP})
9220 @end smallexample
9221 @noindent
9222 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
9223 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
9224 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
9225 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
9226 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
9227
9228 @smallexample
9229 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
9230 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
9231 line 1574.
9232 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
9233 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
9234 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
9235 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
9236 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
9237 dirname (null)
9238 fullname (null)
9239 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
9240 debugformat DWARF 2
9241 @}
9242 @}
9243 (@value{GDBP})
9244 @end smallexample
9245 @end table
9246
9247
9248 @node Altering
9249 @chapter Altering Execution
9250
9251 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
9252 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
9253 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
9254 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
9255 program.
9256
9257 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
9258 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
9259 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
9260
9261 @menu
9262 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
9263 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
9264 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
9265 * Returning:: Returning from a function
9266 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
9267 * Patching:: Patching your program
9268 @end menu
9269
9270 @node Assignment
9271 @section Assignment to variables
9272
9273 @cindex assignment
9274 @cindex setting variables
9275 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
9276 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
9277
9278 @smallexample
9279 print x=4
9280 @end smallexample
9281
9282 @noindent
9283 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
9284 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
9285 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
9286 information on operators in supported languages.
9287
9288 @kindex set variable
9289 @cindex variables, setting
9290 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
9291 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
9292 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
9293 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
9294 ,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
9295
9296 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
9297 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
9298 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
9299 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
9300 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
9301 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
9302 command @code{set width}:
9303
9304 @smallexample
9305 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
9306 type = double
9307 (@value{GDBP}) p width
9308 $4 = 13
9309 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
9310 Invalid syntax in expression.
9311 @end smallexample
9312
9313 @noindent
9314 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
9315 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
9316
9317 @smallexample
9318 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
9319 @end smallexample
9320
9321 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
9322 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
9323 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
9324 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
9325 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
9326 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
9327
9328 @smallexample
9329 @group
9330 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
9331 type = double
9332 (@value{GDBP}) p g
9333 $1 = 1
9334 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
9335 (@value{GDBP}) p g
9336 $2 = 1
9337 (@value{GDBP}) r
9338 The program being debugged has been started already.
9339 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
9340 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
9341 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
9342 Invalid bfd target.
9343 (@value{GDBP}) show g
9344 The current BFD target is "=4".
9345 @end group
9346 @end smallexample
9347
9348 @noindent
9349 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
9350 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
9351 @code{g}, use
9352
9353 @smallexample
9354 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
9355 @end smallexample
9356
9357 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
9358 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
9359 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
9360 same length or shorter.
9361 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
9362 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
9363
9364 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
9365 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
9366 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
9367 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
9368 and representation in memory), and
9369
9370 @smallexample
9371 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
9372 @end smallexample
9373
9374 @noindent
9375 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
9376
9377 @node Jumping
9378 @section Continuing at a different address
9379
9380 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
9381 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
9382 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
9383
9384 @table @code
9385 @kindex jump
9386 @item jump @var{linespec}
9387 Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
9388 immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
9389 source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
9390 @var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
9391 in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
9392 breakpoints}.
9393
9394 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
9395 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
9396 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
9397 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
9398 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
9399 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
9400 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
9401 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
9402 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
9403
9404 @item jump *@var{address}
9405 Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
9406 @end table
9407
9408 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
9409 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
9410 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
9411 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
9412 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
9413 example,
9414
9415 @smallexample
9416 set $pc = 0x485
9417 @end smallexample
9418
9419 @noindent
9420 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
9421 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
9422 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
9423
9424 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
9425 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
9426 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
9427 detail.
9428
9429 @c @group
9430 @node Signaling
9431 @section Giving your program a signal
9432
9433 @table @code
9434 @kindex signal
9435 @item signal @var{signal}
9436 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
9437 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
9438 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
9439 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
9440
9441 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
9442 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
9443 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
9444 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
9445 signal.
9446
9447 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
9448 after executing the command.
9449 @end table
9450 @c @end group
9451
9452 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
9453 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
9454 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
9455 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
9456 passes the signal directly to your program.
9457
9458
9459 @node Returning
9460 @section Returning from a function
9461
9462 @table @code
9463 @cindex returning from a function
9464 @kindex return
9465 @item return
9466 @itemx return @var{expression}
9467 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
9468 command. If you give an
9469 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
9470 value.
9471 @end table
9472
9473 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
9474 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
9475 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
9476 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
9477
9478 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
9479 frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
9480 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
9481 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
9482 of functions.
9483
9484 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
9485 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
9486 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
9487 and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
9488 selected stack frame returns naturally.
9489
9490 @node Calling
9491 @section Calling program functions
9492
9493 @cindex calling functions
9494 @kindex call
9495 @table @code
9496 @item call @var{expr}
9497 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
9498 returned values.
9499 @end table
9500
9501 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
9502 execute a function from your program, but without cluttering the output
9503 with @code{void} returned values. If the result is not void, it
9504 is printed and saved in the value history.
9505
9506 @node Patching
9507 @section Patching programs
9508
9509 @cindex patching binaries
9510 @cindex writing into executables
9511 @cindex writing into corefiles
9512
9513 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
9514 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
9515 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
9516 patching your program's binary.
9517
9518 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
9519 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
9520 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
9521 repairs.
9522
9523 @table @code
9524 @kindex set write
9525 @item set write on
9526 @itemx set write off
9527 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
9528 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
9529 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
9530
9531 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
9532 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
9533 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
9534
9535 @item show write
9536 @kindex show write
9537 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
9538 as well as reading.
9539 @end table
9540
9541 @node GDB Files
9542 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
9543
9544 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
9545 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
9546 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
9547 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
9548
9549 @menu
9550 * Files:: Commands to specify files
9551 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
9552 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
9553 @end menu
9554
9555 @node Files
9556 @section Commands to specify files
9557
9558 @cindex symbol table
9559 @cindex core dump file
9560
9561 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
9562 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
9563 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
9564 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
9565
9566 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
9567 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to specify
9568 a file you want to use. In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands
9569 to specify new files are useful.
9570
9571 @table @code
9572 @cindex executable file
9573 @kindex file
9574 @item file @var{filename}
9575 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
9576 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
9577 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
9578 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
9579 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
9580 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
9581 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
9582 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
9583
9584 On systems with memory-mapped files, an auxiliary file named
9585 @file{@var{filename}.syms} may hold symbol table information for
9586 @var{filename}. If so, @value{GDBN} maps in the symbol table from
9587 @file{@var{filename}.syms}, starting up more quickly. See the
9588 descriptions of the file options @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow}
9589 (available on the command line, and with the commands @code{file},
9590 @code{symbol-file}, or @code{add-symbol-file}, described below),
9591 for more information.
9592
9593 @item file
9594 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
9595 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
9596
9597 @kindex exec-file
9598 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9599 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
9600 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
9601 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
9602 discard information on the executable file.
9603
9604 @kindex symbol-file
9605 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9606 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
9607 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
9608 table and program to run from the same file.
9609
9610 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
9611 program's symbol table.
9612
9613 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents
9614 of its convenience variables, the value history, and all breakpoints and
9615 auto-display expressions. This is because they may contain pointers to
9616 the internal data recording symbols and data types, which are part of
9617 the old symbol table data being discarded inside @value{GDBN}.
9618
9619 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
9620 executing it once.
9621
9622 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
9623 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
9624 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
9625 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
9626 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
9627 using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
9628 optimized code.
9629
9630 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
9631 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
9632 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
9633 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
9634 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
9635
9636 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
9637 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
9638 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
9639 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
9640 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
9641 warnings and messages}.)
9642
9643 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
9644 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
9645 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
9646 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
9647 in stabs format.
9648
9649 @kindex readnow
9650 @cindex reading symbols immediately
9651 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
9652 @kindex mapped
9653 @cindex memory-mapped symbol file
9654 @cindex saving symbol table
9655 @item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9656 @itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9657 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
9658 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
9659 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
9660 entire symbol table available.
9661
9662 If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the
9663 @code{mmap} system call, you can use another option, @samp{-mapped}, to
9664 cause @value{GDBN} to write the symbols for your program into a reusable
9665 file. Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions map in symbol information
9666 from this auxiliary symbol file (if the program has not changed), rather
9667 than spending time reading the symbol table from the executable
9668 program. Using the @samp{-mapped} option has the same effect as
9669 starting @value{GDBN} with the @samp{-mapped} command-line option.
9670
9671 You can use both options together, to make sure the auxiliary symbol
9672 file has all the symbol information for your program.
9673
9674 The auxiliary symbol file for a program called @var{myprog} is called
9675 @samp{@var{myprog}.syms}. Once this file exists (so long as it is newer
9676 than the corresponding executable), @value{GDBN} always attempts to use
9677 it when you debug @var{myprog}; no special options or commands are
9678 needed.
9679
9680 The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where you run
9681 @value{GDBN}. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN}
9682 symbol table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
9683
9684 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
9685 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
9686 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
9687 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
9688 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
9689 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
9690 @c files.
9691
9692 @kindex core
9693 @kindex core-file
9694 @item core-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9695 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
9696 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
9697 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
9698 executable file itself for other parts.
9699
9700 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
9701 to be used.
9702
9703 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
9704 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
9705 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
9706 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
9707 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
9708
9709 @kindex add-symbol-file
9710 @cindex dynamic linking
9711 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
9712 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9713 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
9714 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
9715 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
9716 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
9717 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
9718 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
9719 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
9720 of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
9721 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
9722 @var{address} as an expression.
9723
9724 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
9725 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
9726 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
9727 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
9728 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
9729
9730 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
9731 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
9732 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
9733 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
9734 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
9735 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
9736 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
9737 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
9738 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
9739
9740 @itemize @bullet
9741 @item
9742 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
9743 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
9744 @item
9745 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
9746 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
9747 @item
9748 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
9749 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
9750 @end itemize
9751
9752 @noindent
9753 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
9754 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
9755 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
9756 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
9757 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C++ constructor table
9758 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
9759 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
9760 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
9761 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
9762 way.
9763
9764 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
9765
9766 You can use the @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow} options just as with
9767 the @code{symbol-file} command, to change how @value{GDBN} manages the symbol
9768 table information for @var{filename}.
9769
9770 @kindex add-shared-symbol-file
9771 @item add-shared-symbol-file
9772 The @code{add-shared-symbol-file} command can be used only under Harris' CXUX
9773 operating system for the Motorola 88k. @value{GDBN} automatically looks for
9774 shared libraries, however if @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can run
9775 @code{add-shared-symbol-file}. It takes no arguments.
9776
9777 @kindex section
9778 @item section
9779 The @code{section} command changes the base address of section SECTION of
9780 the exec file to ADDR. This can be used if the exec file does not contain
9781 section addresses, (such as in the a.out format), or when the addresses
9782 specified in the file itself are wrong. Each section must be changed
9783 separately. The @code{info files} command, described below, lists all
9784 the sections and their addresses.
9785
9786 @kindex info files
9787 @kindex info target
9788 @item info files
9789 @itemx info target
9790 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
9791 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
9792 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
9793 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
9794 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
9795 current ones.
9796
9797 @kindex maint info sections
9798 @item maint info sections
9799 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
9800 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
9801 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
9802 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
9803 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
9804 may be arbitrarily combined):
9805
9806 @table @code
9807 @item ALLOBJ
9808 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
9809 @item @var{sections}
9810 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
9811 @item @var{section-flags}
9812 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
9813 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
9814 @table @code
9815 @item ALLOC
9816 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
9817 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
9818 @item LOAD
9819 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
9820 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
9821 @item RELOC
9822 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
9823 @item READONLY
9824 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
9825 @item CODE
9826 Section contains executable code only.
9827 @item DATA
9828 Section contains data only (no executable code).
9829 @item ROM
9830 Section will reside in ROM.
9831 @item CONSTRUCTOR
9832 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
9833 @item HAS_CONTENTS
9834 Section is not empty.
9835 @item NEVER_LOAD
9836 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
9837 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
9838 A notification to the linker that the section contains
9839 COFF shared library information.
9840 @item IS_COMMON
9841 Section contains common symbols.
9842 @end table
9843 @end table
9844 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
9845 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
9846 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
9847 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
9848 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
9849 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
9850 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
9851 enhancement to debugging performance.
9852
9853 The default is off.
9854
9855 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
9856 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
9857 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
9858 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
9859 @end table
9860
9861 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
9862 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
9863 name and remembers it that way.
9864
9865 @cindex shared libraries
9866 @value{GDBN} supports HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix 5, and IBM RS/6000 shared
9867 libraries.
9868
9869 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
9870 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
9871 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
9872 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
9873 debugging a core file).
9874
9875 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
9876 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
9877
9878 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
9879 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
9880 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
9881
9882 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
9883 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
9884 particularly large or there are many of them.
9885
9886 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
9887 commands:
9888
9889 @table @code
9890 @kindex set auto-solib-add
9891 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
9892 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
9893 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
9894 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
9895 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
9896 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
9897 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
9898
9899 @kindex show auto-solib-add
9900 @item show auto-solib-add
9901 Display the current autoloading mode.
9902 @end table
9903
9904 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
9905 command:
9906
9907 @table @code
9908 @kindex info sharedlibrary
9909 @kindex info share
9910 @item info share
9911 @itemx info sharedlibrary
9912 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
9913
9914 @kindex sharedlibrary
9915 @kindex share
9916 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
9917 @itemx share @var{regex}
9918 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
9919 Unix regular expression.
9920 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
9921 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
9922 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
9923 loaded.
9924 @end table
9925
9926 On some systems, such as HP-UX systems, @value{GDBN} supports
9927 autoloading shared library symbols until a limiting threshold size is
9928 reached. This provides the benefit of allowing autoloading to remain on
9929 by default, but avoids autoloading excessively large shared libraries,
9930 up to a threshold that is initially set, but which you can modify if you
9931 wish.
9932
9933 Beyond that threshold, symbols from shared libraries must be explicitly
9934 loaded. To load these symbols, use the command @code{sharedlibrary
9935 @var{filename}}. The base address of the shared library is determined
9936 automatically by @value{GDBN} and need not be specified.
9937
9938 To display or set the threshold, use the commands:
9939
9940 @table @code
9941 @kindex set auto-solib-limit
9942 @item set auto-solib-limit @var{threshold}
9943 Set the autoloading size threshold, in an integral number of megabytes.
9944 If @var{threshold} is nonzero and shared library autoloading is enabled,
9945 symbols from all shared object libraries will be loaded until the total
9946 size of the loaded shared library symbols exceeds this threshold.
9947 Otherwise, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
9948 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default threshold is 100 (i.e.@: 100
9949 Mb).
9950
9951 @kindex show auto-solib-limit
9952 @item show auto-solib-limit
9953 Display the current autoloading size threshold, in megabytes.
9954 @end table
9955
9956 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
9957 configurations. A copy of the target's libraries need to be present on the
9958 host system; they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
9959 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
9960 not.
9961
9962 You need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target libraries are, so that it can
9963 load the correct copies---otherwise, it may try to load the host's libraries.
9964 @value{GDBN} has two variables to specify the search directories for target
9965 libraries.
9966
9967 @table @code
9968 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
9969 @item set solib-absolute-prefix @var{path}
9970 If this variable is set, @var{path} will be used as a prefix for any
9971 absolute shared library paths; many runtime loaders store the absolute
9972 paths to the shared library in the target program's memory. If you use
9973 @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} to find shared libraries, they need to be laid
9974 out in the same way that they are on the target, with e.g.@: a
9975 @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under @var{path}.
9976
9977 You can set the default value of @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} by using the
9978 configure-time @samp{--with-sysroot} option.
9979
9980 @kindex show solib-absolute-prefix
9981 @item show solib-absolute-prefix
9982 Display the current shared library prefix.
9983
9984 @kindex set solib-search-path
9985 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
9986 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of directories
9987 to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path} is used after
9988 @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} fails to locate the library, or if the path to
9989 the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to use
9990 @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}, be sure to
9991 set @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} to a nonexistant directory to prevent
9992 @value{GDBN} from finding your host's libraries.
9993
9994 @kindex show solib-search-path
9995 @item show solib-search-path
9996 Display the current shared library search path.
9997 @end table
9998
9999
10000 @node Separate Debug Files
10001 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
10002 @cindex separate debugging information files
10003 @cindex debugging information in separate files
10004 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
10005 @cindex debugging information directory, global
10006 @cindex global debugging information directory
10007
10008 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
10009 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
10010 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
10011 Since debugging information can be very large --- sometimes larger
10012 than the executable code itself --- some systems distribute debugging
10013 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
10014 install only when they need to debug a problem.
10015
10016 If an executable's debugging information has been extracted to a
10017 separate file, the executable should contain a @dfn{debug link} giving
10018 the name of the debugging information file (with no directory
10019 components), and a checksum of its contents. (The exact form of a
10020 debug link is described below.) If the full name of the directory
10021 containing the executable is @var{execdir}, and the executable has a
10022 debug link that specifies the name @var{debugfile}, then @value{GDBN}
10023 will automatically search for the debugging information file in three
10024 places:
10025
10026 @itemize @bullet
10027 @item
10028 the directory containing the executable file (that is, it will look
10029 for a file named @file{@var{execdir}/@var{debugfile}},
10030 @item
10031 a subdirectory of that directory named @file{.debug} (that is, the
10032 file @file{@var{execdir}/.debug/@var{debugfile}}, and
10033 @item
10034 a subdirectory of the global debug file directory that includes the
10035 executable's full path, and the name from the link (that is, the file
10036 @file{@var{globaldebugdir}/@var{execdir}/@var{debugfile}}, where
10037 @var{globaldebugdir} is the global debug file directory, and
10038 @var{execdir} has been turned into a relative path).
10039 @end itemize
10040 @noindent
10041 @value{GDBN} checks under each of these names for a debugging
10042 information file whose checksum matches that given in the link, and
10043 reads the debugging information from the first one it finds.
10044
10045 So, for example, if you ask @value{GDBN} to debug @file{/usr/bin/ls},
10046 which has a link containing the name @file{ls.debug}, and the global
10047 debug directory is @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look
10048 for debug information in @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug},
10049 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}, and
10050 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
10051
10052 You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
10053 name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
10054
10055 @table @code
10056
10057 @kindex set debug-file-directory
10058 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directory}
10059 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
10060 information files to @var{directory}.
10061
10062 @kindex show debug-file-directory
10063 @item show debug-file-directory
10064 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
10065 information files.
10066
10067 @end table
10068
10069 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
10070 @cindex debug links
10071 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
10072 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
10073
10074 @itemize
10075 @item
10076 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
10077 a zero byte,
10078 @item
10079 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
10080 boundary within the section, and
10081 @item
10082 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
10083 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
10084 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
10085 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
10086 @end itemize
10087
10088 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
10089 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
10090 described above.
10091
10092 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
10093 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
10094 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
10095 should have the same names, addresses and sizes as the original file,
10096 but they need not contain any data --- much like a @code{.bss} section
10097 in an ordinary executable.
10098
10099 As of December 2002, there is no standard GNU utility to produce
10100 separated executable / debugging information file pairs. Ulrich
10101 Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53,
10102 contains a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command
10103 @kbd{strip foo -f foo.debug} removes the debugging information from
10104 the executable file @file{foo}, places it in the file
10105 @file{foo.debug}, and leaves behind a debug link in @file{foo}.
10106
10107 Since there are many different ways to compute CRC's (different
10108 polynomials, reversals, byte ordering, etc.), the simplest way to
10109 describe the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections is to give the
10110 complete code for a function that computes it:
10111
10112 @kindex @code{gnu_debuglink_crc32}
10113 @smallexample
10114 unsigned long
10115 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
10116 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
10117 @{
10118 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
10119 @{
10120 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
10121 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
10122 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
10123 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
10124 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
10125 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
10126 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
10127 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
10128 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
10129 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
10130 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
10131 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
10132 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
10133 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
10134 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
10135 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
10136 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
10137 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
10138 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
10139 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
10140 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
10141 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
10142 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
10143 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
10144 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
10145 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
10146 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
10147 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
10148 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
10149 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
10150 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
10151 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
10152 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
10153 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
10154 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
10155 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
10156 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
10157 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
10158 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
10159 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
10160 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
10161 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
10162 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
10163 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
10164 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
10165 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
10166 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
10167 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
10168 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
10169 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
10170 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
10171 0x2d02ef8d
10172 @};
10173 unsigned char *end;
10174
10175 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
10176 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
10177 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
10178 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
10179 @}
10180 @end smallexample
10181
10182
10183 @node Symbol Errors
10184 @section Errors reading symbol files
10185
10186 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
10187 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
10188 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
10189 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
10190 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
10191 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
10192 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
10193 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
10194 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
10195 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
10196 messages}).
10197
10198 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
10199
10200 @table @code
10201 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
10202
10203 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
10204 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
10205 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
10206 in its outer scope blocks.
10207
10208 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
10209 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
10210 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
10211 function.
10212
10213 @item block at @var{address} out of order
10214
10215 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
10216 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
10217 do so.
10218
10219 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
10220 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
10221 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
10222 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
10223 messages}.)
10224
10225 @item bad block start address patched
10226
10227 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
10228 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
10229 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
10230
10231 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
10232 starting on the previous source line.
10233
10234 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
10235
10236 @cindex foo
10237 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
10238 larger than the size of the string table.
10239
10240 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
10241 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
10242 with this name.
10243
10244 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
10245
10246 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
10247 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
10248 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
10249
10250 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
10251 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
10252 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
10253 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
10254 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
10255 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
10256
10257 @item stub type has NULL name
10258
10259 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
10260
10261 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
10262 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
10263 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
10264 it.
10265
10266 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
10267
10268 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
10269
10270 @end table
10271
10272 @node Targets
10273 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
10274
10275 @cindex debugging target
10276 @kindex target
10277
10278 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
10279
10280 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
10281 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
10282 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
10283 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
10284 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
10285 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
10286 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
10287 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
10288
10289 @menu
10290 * Active Targets:: Active targets
10291 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
10292 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
10293 * Remote:: Remote debugging
10294 * KOD:: Kernel Object Display
10295
10296 @end menu
10297
10298 @node Active Targets
10299 @section Active targets
10300
10301 @cindex stacking targets
10302 @cindex active targets
10303 @cindex multiple targets
10304
10305 There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
10306 executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
10307 active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
10308 start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
10309 a core file.
10310
10311 For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
10312 @code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
10313 well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
10314 @value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
10315 first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
10316 requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
10317 are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
10318 read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
10319 executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
10320
10321 When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
10322 target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
10323 commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
10324 an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
10325 process target is active.
10326
10327 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
10328 core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
10329 files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
10330 the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
10331 process}).
10332
10333 @node Target Commands
10334 @section Commands for managing targets
10335
10336 @table @code
10337 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
10338 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
10339 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
10340 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
10341 protocol of the target machine.
10342
10343 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
10344 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
10345 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
10346
10347 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
10348 after executing the command.
10349
10350 @kindex help target
10351 @item help target
10352 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
10353 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
10354 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
10355
10356 @item help target @var{name}
10357 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
10358 select it.
10359
10360 @kindex set gnutarget
10361 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
10362 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
10363 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
10364 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
10365 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
10366 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
10367
10368 @quotation
10369 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
10370 you must know the actual BFD name.
10371 @end quotation
10372
10373 @noindent
10374 @xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
10375
10376 @kindex show gnutarget
10377 @item show gnutarget
10378 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
10379 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
10380 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
10381 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
10382 @end table
10383
10384 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
10385 configuration):
10386
10387 @table @code
10388 @kindex target exec
10389 @item target exec @var{program}
10390 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
10391 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
10392
10393 @kindex target core
10394 @item target core @var{filename}
10395 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
10396 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
10397
10398 @kindex target remote
10399 @item target remote @var{dev}
10400 Remote serial target in GDB-specific protocol. The argument @var{dev}
10401 specifies what serial device to use for the connection (e.g.
10402 @file{/dev/ttya}). @xref{Remote, ,Remote debugging}. @code{target remote}
10403 supports the @code{load} command. This is only useful if you have
10404 some other way of getting the stub to the target system, and you can put
10405 it somewhere in memory where it won't get clobbered by the download.
10406
10407 @kindex target sim
10408 @item target sim
10409 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
10410 In general,
10411 @smallexample
10412 target sim
10413 load
10414 run
10415 @end smallexample
10416 @noindent
10417 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
10418 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
10419 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
10420 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
10421 Processors}.
10422
10423 @end table
10424
10425 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
10426
10427 @table @code
10428
10429 @kindex target nrom
10430 @item target nrom @var{dev}
10431 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
10432
10433 @end table
10434
10435 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
10436 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
10437
10438 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code
10439 once you've successfully established a connection.
10440
10441 @table @code
10442
10443 @kindex load @var{filename}
10444 @item load @var{filename}
10445 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
10446 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
10447 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
10448 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
10449 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
10450 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
10451
10452 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
10453 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
10454 target is @dots{}}''
10455
10456 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
10457 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
10458 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
10459 specifies a fixed address.
10460 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
10461
10462 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
10463 @end table
10464
10465 @node Byte Order
10466 @section Choosing target byte order
10467
10468 @cindex choosing target byte order
10469 @cindex target byte order
10470
10471 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Hitachi SH,
10472 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
10473 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
10474 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
10475 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
10476 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
10477
10478 @table @code
10479 @kindex set endian big
10480 @item set endian big
10481 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
10482
10483 @kindex set endian little
10484 @item set endian little
10485 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
10486
10487 @kindex set endian auto
10488 @item set endian auto
10489 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
10490 executable.
10491
10492 @item show endian
10493 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
10494
10495 @end table
10496
10497 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
10498 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
10499 target system.
10500
10501 @node Remote
10502 @section Remote debugging
10503 @cindex remote debugging
10504
10505 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
10506 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
10507 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
10508 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
10509 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
10510
10511 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
10512 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
10513 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
10514 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
10515 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
10516 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
10517
10518 Other remote targets may be available in your
10519 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
10520
10521 @node KOD
10522 @section Kernel Object Display
10523
10524 @cindex kernel object display
10525 @cindex kernel object
10526 @cindex KOD
10527
10528 Some targets support kernel object display. Using this facility,
10529 @value{GDBN} communicates specially with the underlying operating system
10530 and can display information about operating system-level objects such as
10531 mutexes and other synchronization objects. Exactly which objects can be
10532 displayed is determined on a per-OS basis.
10533
10534 Use the @code{set os} command to set the operating system. This tells
10535 @value{GDBN} which kernel object display module to initialize:
10536
10537 @smallexample
10538 (@value{GDBP}) set os cisco
10539 @end smallexample
10540
10541 If @code{set os} succeeds, @value{GDBN} will display some information
10542 about the operating system, and will create a new @code{info} command
10543 which can be used to query the target. The @code{info} command is named
10544 after the operating system:
10545
10546 @smallexample
10547 (@value{GDBP}) info cisco
10548 List of Cisco Kernel Objects
10549 Object Description
10550 any Any and all objects
10551 @end smallexample
10552
10553 Further subcommands can be used to query about particular objects known
10554 by the kernel.
10555
10556 There is currently no way to determine whether a given operating system
10557 is supported other than to try it.
10558
10559
10560 @node Remote Debugging
10561 @chapter Debugging remote programs
10562
10563 @menu
10564 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
10565 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
10566 * NetWare:: Using the gdbserve.nlm program
10567 * Remote configuration:: Remote configuration
10568 * remote stub:: Implementing a remote stub
10569 @end menu
10570
10571 @node Connecting
10572 @section Connecting to a remote target
10573
10574 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, you will need an unstripped copy of
10575 your program, since @value{GDBN} needs symobl and debugging information.
10576 Start up @value{GDBN} as usual, using the name of the local copy of your
10577 program as the first argument.
10578
10579 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
10580 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
10581 @w{@samp{--baud}} option, or use the @code{set remotebaud} command
10582 before the @code{target} command.
10583
10584 After that, use @code{target remote} to establish communications with
10585 the target machine. Its argument specifies how to communicate---either
10586 via a devicename attached to a direct serial line, or a TCP or UDP port
10587 (possibly to a terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the
10588 target). For example, to use a serial line connected to the device
10589 named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
10590
10591 @smallexample
10592 target remote /dev/ttyb
10593 @end smallexample
10594
10595 @cindex TCP port, @code{target remote}
10596 To use a TCP connection, use an argument of the form
10597 @code{@var{host}:@var{port}} or @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}.
10598 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a
10599 terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
10600
10601 @smallexample
10602 target remote manyfarms:2828
10603 @end smallexample
10604
10605 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as
10606 your debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator of your target running on
10607 the same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect
10608 to port 1234 on your local machine:
10609
10610 @smallexample
10611 target remote :1234
10612 @end smallexample
10613 @noindent
10614
10615 Note that the colon is still required here.
10616
10617 @cindex UDP port, @code{target remote}
10618 To use a UDP connection, use an argument of the form
10619 @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}. For example, to connect to UDP port 2828
10620 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
10621
10622 @smallexample
10623 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
10624 @end smallexample
10625
10626 When using a UDP connection for remote debugging, you should keep in mind
10627 that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. UDP can silently drop packets on
10628 busy or unreliable networks, which will cause havoc with your debugging
10629 session.
10630
10631 Now you can use all the usual commands to examine and change data and to
10632 step and continue the remote program.
10633
10634 @cindex interrupting remote programs
10635 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
10636 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
10637 interrupt character (often @key{C-C}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
10638 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
10639 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
10640 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
10641
10642 @smallexample
10643 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
10644 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
10645 @end smallexample
10646
10647 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
10648 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
10649 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
10650 goes back to waiting.
10651
10652 @table @code
10653 @kindex detach (remote)
10654 @item detach
10655 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
10656 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
10657 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
10658 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
10659 command, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to another target.
10660
10661 @kindex disconnect
10662 @item disconnect
10663 The @code{disconnect} command behaves like @code{detach}, except that
10664 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
10665 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
10666 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
10667 another target.
10668 @end table
10669
10670 @node Server
10671 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} program
10672
10673 @kindex gdbserver
10674 @cindex remote connection without stubs
10675 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
10676 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10677 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
10678
10679 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
10680 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
10681 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
10682 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
10683 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
10684 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
10685 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
10686 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
10687 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
10688 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
10689 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
10690 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
10691 choice for debugging.
10692
10693 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
10694 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
10695 protocol.
10696
10697 @table @emph
10698 @item On the target machine,
10699 you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10700 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
10701 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
10702 system does all the symbol handling.
10703
10704 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
10705 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
10706 syntax is:
10707
10708 @smallexample
10709 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10710 @end smallexample
10711
10712 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
10713 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
10714 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
10715 @file{/dev/com1}:
10716
10717 @smallexample
10718 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
10719 @end smallexample
10720
10721 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
10722 with it.
10723
10724 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
10725
10726 @smallexample
10727 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
10728 @end smallexample
10729
10730 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
10731 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
10732 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
10733 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
10734 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
10735 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
10736 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
10737 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
10738 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
10739 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
10740 @code{target remote} command.
10741
10742 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
10743 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
10744
10745 @smallexample
10746 target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach @var{pid}
10747 @end smallexample
10748
10749 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
10750 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
10751
10752 @pindex pidof
10753 @cindex attach to a program by name
10754 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
10755 @code{pidof} utility:
10756
10757 @smallexample
10758 target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach `pidof @var{PROGRAM}`
10759 @end smallexample
10760
10761 In case more than one copy of @var{PROGRAM} is running, or @var{PROGRAM}
10762 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
10763 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
10764
10765 @item On the host machine,
10766 connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a remote target}).
10767 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
10768 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
10769 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
10770 @samp{Connection refused}. You don't need to use the @code{load}
10771 command in @value{GDBN} when using gdbserver, since the program is
10772 already on the target.
10773
10774 @end table
10775
10776 @node NetWare
10777 @section Using the @code{gdbserve.nlm} program
10778
10779 @kindex gdbserve.nlm
10780 @code{gdbserve.nlm} is a control program for NetWare systems, which
10781 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10782 @code{target remote}.
10783
10784 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserve.nlm} communicate via a serial line,
10785 using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol.
10786
10787 @table @emph
10788 @item On the target machine,
10789 you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10790 @code{gdbserve.nlm} does not need your program's symbol table, so you
10791 can strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the
10792 host system does all the symbol handling.
10793
10794 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with
10795 @value{GDBN}; the name of your program; and the arguments for your
10796 program. The syntax is:
10797
10798 @smallexample
10799 load gdbserve [ BOARD=@var{board} ] [ PORT=@var{port} ]
10800 [ BAUD=@var{baud} ] @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10801 @end smallexample
10802
10803 @var{board} and @var{port} specify the serial line; @var{baud} specifies
10804 the baud rate used by the connection. @var{port} and @var{node} default
10805 to 0, @var{baud} defaults to 9600@dmn{bps}.
10806
10807 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument @samp{foo.txt}and
10808 communicate with @value{GDBN} over serial port number 2 or board 1
10809 using a 19200@dmn{bps} connection:
10810
10811 @smallexample
10812 load gdbserve BOARD=1 PORT=2 BAUD=19200 emacs foo.txt
10813 @end smallexample
10814
10815 @item
10816 On the @value{GDBN} host machine, connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,
10817 Connecting to a remote target}).
10818
10819 @end table
10820
10821 @node Remote configuration
10822 @section Remote configuration
10823
10824 The following configuration options are available when debugging remote
10825 programs:
10826
10827 @table @code
10828 @kindex set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit
10829 @kindex set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit
10830 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
10831 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
10832 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
10833 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
10834 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
10835 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
10836 @end table
10837
10838 @node remote stub
10839 @section Implementing a remote stub
10840
10841 @cindex debugging stub, example
10842 @cindex remote stub, example
10843 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
10844 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
10845 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
10846 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
10847 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
10848 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
10849 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
10850 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
10851
10852 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
10853 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
10854 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
10855 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
10856 program, you need:
10857
10858 @enumerate
10859 @item
10860 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
10861 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
10862 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
10863
10864 @item
10865 A C subroutine library to support your program's
10866 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
10867
10868 @item
10869 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
10870 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
10871 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
10872 documentation.
10873 @end enumerate
10874
10875 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
10876 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
10877 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
10878
10879 @table @emph
10880 @item On the host,
10881 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
10882 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
10883 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
10884
10885 @item On the target,
10886 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
10887 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
10888 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
10889
10890 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
10891 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
10892 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
10893 @end table
10894
10895 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
10896 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
10897 @sc{sparc} boards.
10898
10899 @cindex remote serial stub list
10900 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
10901
10902 @table @code
10903
10904 @item i386-stub.c
10905 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
10906 @cindex Intel
10907 @cindex i386
10908 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
10909
10910 @item m68k-stub.c
10911 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
10912 @cindex Motorola 680x0
10913 @cindex m680x0
10914 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
10915
10916 @item sh-stub.c
10917 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
10918 @cindex Hitachi
10919 @cindex SH
10920 For Hitachi SH architectures.
10921
10922 @item sparc-stub.c
10923 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
10924 @cindex Sparc
10925 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
10926
10927 @item sparcl-stub.c
10928 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
10929 @cindex Fujitsu
10930 @cindex SparcLite
10931 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
10932
10933 @end table
10934
10935 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
10936 recently added stubs.
10937
10938 @menu
10939 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
10940 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
10941 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
10942 @end menu
10943
10944 @node Stub Contents
10945 @subsection What the stub can do for you
10946
10947 @cindex remote serial stub
10948 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
10949 subroutines:
10950
10951 @table @code
10952 @item set_debug_traps
10953 @kindex set_debug_traps
10954 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
10955 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
10956 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
10957 beginning of your program.
10958
10959 @item handle_exception
10960 @kindex handle_exception
10961 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
10962 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
10963 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
10964 run when a trap is triggered.
10965
10966 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
10967 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
10968 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
10969 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
10970 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
10971 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
10972 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
10973 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
10974 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
10975 machine.
10976
10977 @item breakpoint
10978 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
10979 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
10980 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
10981 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
10982 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
10983 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
10984 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
10985 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
10986 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
10987 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
10988 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
10989
10990 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
10991 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
10992 start of your debugging session.
10993 @end table
10994
10995 @node Bootstrapping
10996 @subsection What you must do for the stub
10997
10998 @cindex remote stub, support routines
10999 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
11000 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
11001 debugging target machine.
11002
11003 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
11004 serial port.
11005
11006 @table @code
11007 @item int getDebugChar()
11008 @kindex getDebugChar
11009 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
11010 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
11011 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
11012
11013 @item void putDebugChar(int)
11014 @kindex putDebugChar
11015 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
11016 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
11017 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
11018 @end table
11019
11020 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
11021 @cindex interrupting remote targets
11022 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
11023 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
11024 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
11025 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
11026 remote system to stop.
11027
11028 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
11029 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
11030 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
11031 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
11032
11033 Other routines you need to supply are:
11034
11035 @table @code
11036 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
11037 @kindex exceptionHandler
11038 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
11039 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
11040 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
11041 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
11042 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
11043 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
11044 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
11045 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
11046 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
11047 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
11048 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
11049 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
11050 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
11051
11052 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
11053 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
11054 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
11055 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
11056 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
11057
11058 @item void flush_i_cache()
11059 @kindex flush_i_cache
11060 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
11061 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
11062 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
11063
11064 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
11065 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
11066 @end table
11067
11068 @noindent
11069 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
11070
11071 @table @code
11072 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
11073 @kindex memset
11074 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
11075 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
11076 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
11077 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
11078 @end table
11079
11080 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
11081 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
11082 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
11083 subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
11084
11085
11086 @node Debug Session
11087 @subsection Putting it all together
11088
11089 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
11090 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
11091 steps.
11092
11093 @enumerate
11094 @item
11095 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
11096 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
11097 @display
11098 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
11099 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
11100 @end display
11101
11102 @item
11103 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
11104
11105 @smallexample
11106 set_debug_traps();
11107 breakpoint();
11108 @end smallexample
11109
11110 @item
11111 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
11112 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
11113
11114 @smallexample
11115 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
11116 @end smallexample
11117
11118 @noindent
11119 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
11120 function in your program, that function is called when
11121 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
11122 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
11123 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
11124
11125 @item
11126 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
11127 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
11128
11129 @item
11130 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
11131 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
11132
11133 @item
11134 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
11135 @c document that. FIXME.
11136 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
11137 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
11138
11139 @item
11140 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
11141 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a remote target}).
11142
11143 @end enumerate
11144
11145 @node Configurations
11146 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
11147
11148 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
11149 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
11150 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
11151
11152 There are three major categories of configurations: native
11153 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
11154 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
11155 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
11156 are quite different from each other.
11157
11158 @menu
11159 * Native::
11160 * Embedded OS::
11161 * Embedded Processors::
11162 * Architectures::
11163 @end menu
11164
11165 @node Native
11166 @section Native
11167
11168 This section describes details specific to particular native
11169 configurations.
11170
11171 @menu
11172 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
11173 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
11174 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
11175 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
11176 @end menu
11177
11178 @node HP-UX
11179 @subsection HP-UX
11180
11181 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
11182 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
11183 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
11184
11185 @node SVR4 Process Information
11186 @subsection SVR4 process information
11187
11188 @kindex /proc
11189 @cindex process image
11190
11191 Many versions of SVR4 provide a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
11192 used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
11193 subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with
11194 this facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report on
11195 several kinds of information about the process running your program.
11196 @code{info proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the
11197 @code{procfs} code. This includes OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, Irix,
11198 and Unixware, but not HP-UX or @sc{gnu}/Linux, for example.
11199
11200 @table @code
11201 @kindex info proc
11202 @item info proc
11203 Summarize available information about the process.
11204
11205 @kindex info proc mappings
11206 @item info proc mappings
11207 Report on the address ranges accessible in the program, with information
11208 on whether your program may read, write, or execute each range.
11209 @ignore
11210 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
11211 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
11212 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
11213 @kindex info proc times
11214 @item info proc times
11215 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
11216 its children.
11217
11218 @kindex info proc id
11219 @item info proc id
11220 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
11221 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
11222
11223 @kindex info proc status
11224 @item info proc status
11225 General information on the state of the process. If the process is
11226 stopped, this report includes the reason for stopping, and any signal
11227 received.
11228
11229 @item info proc all
11230 Show all the above information about the process.
11231 @end ignore
11232 @end table
11233
11234 @node DJGPP Native
11235 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
11236 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
11237 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
11238 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
11239
11240 @sc{djgpp} is the port of @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
11241 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
11242 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
11243 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
11244
11245 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
11246 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
11247 subsection describes those commands.
11248
11249 @table @code
11250 @kindex info dos
11251 @item info dos
11252 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
11253 information about the target system and important OS structures.
11254
11255 @kindex sysinfo
11256 @cindex MS-DOS system info
11257 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
11258 @item info dos sysinfo
11259 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
11260 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
11261 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
11262
11263 @cindex GDT
11264 @cindex LDT
11265 @cindex IDT
11266 @cindex segment descriptor tables
11267 @cindex descriptor tables display
11268 @item info dos gdt
11269 @itemx info dos ldt
11270 @itemx info dos idt
11271 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
11272 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
11273 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
11274 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
11275 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
11276 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
11277 rights.
11278
11279 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
11280 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
11281 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
11282 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
11283 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
11284
11285 @cindex garbled pointers
11286 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
11287 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
11288 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
11289 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
11290 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
11291 debugged program's data segment:
11292
11293 @smallexample
11294 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
11295 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
11296 @end smallexample
11297
11298 @noindent
11299 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
11300 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
11301
11302 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
11303 @item info dos pde
11304 @itemx info dos pte
11305 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
11306 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
11307 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
11308 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
11309 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
11310 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
11311 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
11312 that is currently in use.
11313
11314 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
11315 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
11316 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
11317 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
11318 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
11319 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
11320 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
11321
11322 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
11323 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
11324 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
11325 controller.
11326
11327 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
11328
11329 @cindex physical address from linear address
11330 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
11331 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
11332 address. The argument linear address @var{addr} should already have the
11333 appropriate segment's base address added to it, because this command
11334 accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any} segment. For
11335 example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for the page where
11336 the variable @code{i} is stored:
11337
11338 @smallexample
11339 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
11340 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
11341 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
11342 @end smallexample
11343
11344 @noindent
11345 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
11346 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and prints all the
11347 attributes of that page.
11348
11349 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
11350 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
11351 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
11352 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
11353 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
11354 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
11355
11356 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
11357 transfer buffer:
11358
11359 @smallexample
11360 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
11361 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
11362 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
11363 @end smallexample
11364
11365 @noindent
11366 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
11367 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output of
11368 this command clearly shows that addresses in conventional memory are
11369 mapped 1:1, i.e.@: the physical and linear addresses are identical.
11370
11371 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
11372 @end table
11373
11374 @node Cygwin Native
11375 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE executables
11376 @cindex MS Windows debugging
11377 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
11378 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
11379
11380 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
11381 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information. There are various
11382 additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in this subsection. The
11383 subsubsection @pxref{Non-debug DLL symbols} describes working with DLLs
11384 that have no debugging symbols.
11385
11386
11387 @table @code
11388 @kindex info w32
11389 @item info w32
11390 This is a prefix of MS Windows specific commands which print
11391 information about the target system and important OS structures.
11392
11393 @item info w32 selector
11394 This command displays information returned by
11395 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
11396 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
11397 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
11398 Without argument, this command displays information
11399 about the the six segment registers.
11400
11401 @kindex info dll
11402 @item info dll
11403 This is a Cygwin specific alias of info shared.
11404
11405 @kindex dll-symbols
11406 @item dll-symbols
11407 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
11408 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
11409
11410 @kindex set new-console
11411 @item set new-console @var{mode}
11412 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
11413 be started in a new console on next start.
11414 If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
11415 be started in the same console as the debugger.
11416
11417 @kindex show new-console
11418 @item show new-console
11419 Displays whether a new console is used
11420 when the debuggee is started.
11421
11422 @kindex set new-group
11423 @item set new-group @var{mode}
11424 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
11425 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
11426 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
11427 Ctrl-C.
11428
11429 @kindex show new-group
11430 @item show new-group
11431 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
11432
11433 @kindex set debugevents
11434 @item set debugevents
11435 This boolean value adds debug output concerning events seen by the debugger.
11436
11437 @kindex set debugexec
11438 @item set debugexec
11439 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
11440 seen by the debugger.
11441
11442 @kindex set debugexceptions
11443 @item set debugexceptions
11444 This boolean value adds debug ouptut concerning exception events
11445 seen by the debugger.
11446
11447 @kindex set debugmemory
11448 @item set debugmemory
11449 This boolean value adds debug ouptut concerning memory events
11450 seen by the debugger.
11451
11452 @kindex set shell
11453 @item set shell
11454 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
11455 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
11456
11457 @kindex show shell
11458 @item show shell
11459 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
11460
11461 @end table
11462
11463 @menu
11464 * Non-debug DLL symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
11465 @end menu
11466
11467 @node Non-debug DLL symbols
11468 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
11469 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
11470 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
11471
11472 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
11473 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
11474 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
11475 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
11476 information contained in the DLL's export table. This subsubsection
11477 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
11478 ``minimal symbols''.
11479
11480 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
11481 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
11482 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
11483 program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
11484 @value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
11485 see the shared library information in @pxref{Files} or the
11486 @code{dll-symbols} command in @pxref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
11487 explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
11488 cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
11489 which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
11490
11491 @subsubsection DLL name prefixes
11492
11493 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
11494 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
11495 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
11496 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
11497 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
11498 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
11499 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
11500 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
11501 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
11502
11503 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
11504 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
11505 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
11506 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
11507 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols} (see
11508 @pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
11509
11510 @smallexample
11511 (gdb) info function CreateFileA
11512 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
11513
11514 Non-debugging symbols:
11515 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
11516 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
11517 @end smallexample
11518
11519 @smallexample
11520 (gdb) info function !
11521 All functions matching regular expression "!":
11522
11523 Non-debugging symbols:
11524 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
11525 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
11526 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
11527 [etc...]
11528 @end smallexample
11529
11530 @subsubsection Working with minimal symbols
11531
11532 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
11533 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
11534 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
11535 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
11536 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
11537 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
11538 a function within a DLL without a running program.
11539
11540 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
11541 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
11542 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
11543 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
11544 problem:
11545
11546 @smallexample
11547 (gdb) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
11548 $1 = 268572168
11549 @end smallexample
11550
11551 @smallexample
11552 (gdb) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
11553 0x10021610: "\230y\""
11554 @end smallexample
11555
11556 And two possible solutions:
11557
11558 @smallexample
11559 (gdb) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
11560 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
11561 @end smallexample
11562
11563 @smallexample
11564 (gdb) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
11565 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
11566 (gdb) x/x 0x10021608
11567 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
11568 (gdb) x/s 0x0022fd98
11569 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
11570 @end smallexample
11571
11572 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
11573 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
11574 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
11575 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
11576 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
11577
11578 @smallexample
11579 (gdb) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
11580 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
11581 @end smallexample
11582
11583 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
11584 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
11585 safe.
11586
11587 @node Embedded OS
11588 @section Embedded Operating Systems
11589
11590 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
11591 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
11592 architectures.
11593
11594 @menu
11595 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
11596 @end menu
11597
11598 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
11599 various real-time operating systems.
11600
11601 @node VxWorks
11602 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
11603
11604 @cindex VxWorks
11605
11606 @table @code
11607
11608 @kindex target vxworks
11609 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
11610 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
11611 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
11612
11613 @end table
11614
11615 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
11616 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
11617
11618 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
11619 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
11620 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
11621 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
11622 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
11623 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
11624 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
11625
11626 @table @code
11627 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
11628 @kindex vxworks-timeout
11629 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
11630 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
11631 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
11632 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
11633 of a thin network line.
11634 @end table
11635
11636 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
11637 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
11638 procedures.
11639
11640 @kindex INCLUDE_RDB
11641 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
11642 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
11643 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
11644 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
11645 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
11646 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
11647 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
11648 manual.
11649 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
11650
11651 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
11652 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
11653 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
11654 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
11655
11656 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
11657
11658 @smallexample
11659 (vxgdb)
11660 @end smallexample
11661
11662 @menu
11663 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
11664 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
11665 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
11666 @end menu
11667
11668 @node VxWorks Connection
11669 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
11670
11671 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
11672 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
11673
11674 @smallexample
11675 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
11676 @end smallexample
11677
11678 @need 750
11679 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
11680
11681 @smallexample
11682 Attaching remote machine across net...
11683 Connected to tt.
11684 @end smallexample
11685
11686 @need 1000
11687 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
11688 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
11689 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
11690 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
11691 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
11692
11693 @smallexample
11694 prog.o: No such file or directory.
11695 @end smallexample
11696
11697 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
11698 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
11699 command again.
11700
11701 @node VxWorks Download
11702 @subsubsection VxWorks download
11703
11704 @cindex download to VxWorks
11705 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
11706 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
11707 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
11708 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
11709 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
11710 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
11711 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
11712 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
11713 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
11714 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
11715 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
11716 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
11717 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
11718 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
11719 program, type this on VxWorks:
11720
11721 @smallexample
11722 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
11723 @end smallexample
11724
11725 @noindent
11726 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
11727
11728 @smallexample
11729 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
11730 (vxgdb) load prog.o
11731 @end smallexample
11732
11733 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
11734
11735 @smallexample
11736 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
11737 @end smallexample
11738
11739 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
11740 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
11741 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
11742 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
11743 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
11744 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
11745 table.)
11746
11747 @node VxWorks Attach
11748 @subsubsection Running tasks
11749
11750 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
11751 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
11752 follows:
11753
11754 @smallexample
11755 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
11756 @end smallexample
11757
11758 @noindent
11759 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
11760 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
11761 the time of attachment.
11762
11763 @node Embedded Processors
11764 @section Embedded Processors
11765
11766 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
11767 configurations.
11768
11769
11770 @menu
11771 * ARM:: ARM
11772 * H8/300:: Hitachi H8/300
11773 * H8/500:: Hitachi H8/500
11774 * M32R/D:: Mitsubishi M32R/D
11775 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
11776 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
11777 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
11778 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
11779 * PowerPC: PowerPC
11780 * SH:: Hitachi SH
11781 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
11782 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
11783 * ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
11784 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
11785 @end menu
11786
11787 @node ARM
11788 @subsection ARM
11789
11790 @table @code
11791
11792 @kindex target rdi
11793 @item target rdi @var{dev}
11794 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
11795 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
11796 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
11797
11798 @kindex target rdp
11799 @item target rdp @var{dev}
11800 ARM Demon monitor.
11801
11802 @end table
11803
11804 @node H8/300
11805 @subsection Hitachi H8/300
11806
11807 @table @code
11808
11809 @kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
11810 @item target hms @var{dev}
11811 A Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
11812 Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
11813 line and the communications speed used.
11814
11815 @kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
11816 @item target e7000 @var{dev}
11817 E7000 emulator for Hitachi H8 and SH.
11818
11819 @kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
11820 @kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
11821 @item target sh3 @var{dev}
11822 @itemx target sh3e @var{dev}
11823 Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
11824
11825 @end table
11826
11827 @cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
11828 @cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
11829 @cindex download to Hitachi SH
11830 @cindex Hitachi SH download
11831 When you select remote debugging to a Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500
11832 board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Hitachi
11833 board and also opens it as the current executable target for
11834 @value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
11835
11836 @value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
11837 Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
11838
11839 @enumerate
11840 @item
11841 that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
11842 for Hitachi microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
11843 emulator for the Hitachi SH and the Hitachi 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
11844 the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Hitachi SH,
11845 H8/300, or H8/500.)
11846
11847 @item
11848 what serial device connects your host to your Hitachi board (the first
11849 serial device available on your host is the default).
11850
11851 @item
11852 what speed to use over the serial device.
11853 @end enumerate
11854
11855 @menu
11856 * Hitachi Boards:: Connecting to Hitachi boards.
11857 * Hitachi ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
11858 * Hitachi Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros.
11859 @end menu
11860
11861 @node Hitachi Boards
11862 @subsubsection Connecting to Hitachi boards
11863
11864 @c only for Unix hosts
11865 @kindex device
11866 @cindex serial device, Hitachi micros
11867 Use the special @code{@value{GDBN}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
11868 need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
11869 first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
11870 hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
11871
11872 @kindex speed
11873 @cindex serial line speed, Hitachi micros
11874 @code{@value{GDBN}} has another special command to set the communications
11875 speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
11876 hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
11877 the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
11878 @w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
11879
11880 The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
11881 use a Unix host to debug your Hitachi microprocessor programs. If you
11882 use a DOS host,
11883 @value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
11884 called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
11885 through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
11886 to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
11887
11888 The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
11889 program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
11890 sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
11891 the Hitachi SH and the H8/500.
11892
11893 First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
11894 board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
11895 port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
11896 When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
11897 debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
11898 for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
11899 @code{COM2}.
11900
11901 @smallexample
11902 C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
11903 C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
11904
11905 Resident portion of MODE loaded
11906
11907 COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
11908
11909 @end smallexample
11910
11911 @quotation
11912 @emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
11913 @code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
11914 disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
11915 your development board.
11916 @end quotation
11917
11918 @kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
11919 Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
11920 connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBP}} with
11921 the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBN}} prompts
11922 you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
11923 commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
11924 cross-debugging to the Hitachi board, and the @code{load} command to
11925 download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
11926 the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
11927 (If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
11928 executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
11929 @code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
11930 itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
11931
11932 @smallexample
11933 (eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
11934 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
11935 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
11936 the conditions.
11937 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
11938 for details.
11939 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
11940 (@value{GDBP}) target hms
11941 Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
11942 (@value{GDBP}) load t.x
11943 .text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
11944 .data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
11945 .stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
11946 @end smallexample
11947
11948 At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
11949 you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
11950 sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
11951 @code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
11952 resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
11953 @code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
11954
11955 Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
11956 available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
11957 you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
11958
11959 Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
11960 @itemize @bullet
11961 @item
11962 to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{ctl-C} on the DOS host---it has
11963 no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
11964
11965 @item
11966 to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
11967 normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
11968 to detect program completion.
11969 @end itemize
11970
11971 In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
11972 development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
11973
11974 @node Hitachi ICE
11975 @subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
11976
11977 @kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi ICE}
11978 You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
11979 Hitachi SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
11980 e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
11981
11982 @table @code
11983 @item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
11984 Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
11985 @var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
11986 @samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
11987 (for example, @samp{9600}).
11988
11989 @item target e7000 @var{hostname}
11990 If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
11991 specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
11992 @end table
11993
11994 @node Hitachi Special
11995 @subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros
11996
11997 Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
11998
11999 @table @code
12000
12001 @kindex set machine
12002 @kindex show machine
12003 @item set machine h8300
12004 @itemx set machine h8300h
12005 Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
12006 architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
12007 to check which variant is currently in effect.
12008
12009 @end table
12010
12011 @node H8/500
12012 @subsection H8/500
12013
12014 @table @code
12015
12016 @kindex set memory @var{mod}
12017 @cindex memory models, H8/500
12018 @item set memory @var{mod}
12019 @itemx show memory
12020 Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
12021 @samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
12022 memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
12023 @code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
12024
12025 @end table
12026
12027 @node M32R/D
12028 @subsection Mitsubishi M32R/D
12029
12030 @table @code
12031
12032 @kindex target m32r
12033 @item target m32r @var{dev}
12034 Mitsubishi M32R/D ROM monitor.
12035
12036 @end table
12037
12038 @node M68K
12039 @subsection M68k
12040
12041 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
12042 target command for the following ROM monitors.
12043
12044 @table @code
12045
12046 @kindex target abug
12047 @item target abug @var{dev}
12048 ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
12049
12050 @kindex target cpu32bug
12051 @item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
12052 CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
12053
12054 @kindex target dbug
12055 @item target dbug @var{dev}
12056 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
12057
12058 @kindex target est
12059 @item target est @var{dev}
12060 EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
12061
12062 @kindex target rom68k
12063 @item target rom68k @var{dev}
12064 ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
12065
12066 @end table
12067
12068 @table @code
12069
12070 @kindex target rombug
12071 @item target rombug @var{dev}
12072 ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
12073
12074 @end table
12075
12076 @node MIPS Embedded
12077 @subsection MIPS Embedded
12078
12079 @cindex MIPS boards
12080 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
12081 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
12082 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
12083
12084 @need 1000
12085 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
12086
12087 @table @code
12088 @item target mips @var{port}
12089 @kindex target mips @var{port}
12090 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
12091 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
12092 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
12093 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
12094 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
12095 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
12096
12097 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
12098 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
12099 debugger:
12100
12101 @smallexample
12102 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
12103 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
12104 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
12105 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
12106 (@value{GDBP}) run
12107 @end smallexample
12108
12109 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
12110 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
12111 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
12112 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
12113 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
12114
12115 @item target pmon @var{port}
12116 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
12117 PMON ROM monitor.
12118
12119 @item target ddb @var{port}
12120 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
12121 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
12122
12123 @item target lsi @var{port}
12124 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
12125 LSI variant of PMON.
12126
12127 @kindex target r3900
12128 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
12129 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
12130
12131 @kindex target array
12132 @item target array @var{dev}
12133 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
12134
12135 @end table
12136
12137
12138 @noindent
12139 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
12140
12141 @table @code
12142 @item set processor @var{args}
12143 @itemx show processor
12144 @kindex set processor @var{args}
12145 @kindex show processor
12146 Use the @code{set processor} command to set the type of MIPS
12147 processor when you want to access processor-type-specific registers.
12148 For example, @code{set processor @var{r3041}} tells @value{GDBN}
12149 to use the CPU registers appropriate for the 3041 chip.
12150 Use the @code{show processor} command to see what MIPS processor @value{GDBN}
12151 is using. Use the @code{info reg} command to see what registers
12152 @value{GDBN} is using.
12153
12154 @item set mipsfpu double
12155 @itemx set mipsfpu single
12156 @itemx set mipsfpu none
12157 @itemx show mipsfpu
12158 @kindex set mipsfpu
12159 @kindex show mipsfpu
12160 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
12161 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
12162 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
12163 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
12164 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
12165 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
12166 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
12167 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
12168 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
12169 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
12170 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
12171 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
12172 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
12173
12174 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
12175 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
12176 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
12177
12178 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
12179 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
12180
12181 @item set remotedebug @var{n}
12182 @itemx show remotedebug
12183 @kindex set remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
12184 @kindex show remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
12185 @cindex @code{remotedebug}, MIPS protocol
12186 @cindex MIPS @code{remotedebug} protocol
12187 @c FIXME! For this to be useful, you must know something about the MIPS
12188 @c FIXME...protocol. Where is it described?
12189 You can see some debugging information about communications with the board
12190 by setting the @code{remotedebug} variable. If you set it to @code{1} using
12191 @samp{set remotedebug 1}, every packet is displayed. If you set it
12192 to @code{2}, every character is displayed. You can check the current value
12193 at any time with the command @samp{show remotedebug}.
12194
12195 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
12196 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
12197 @itemx show timeout
12198 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
12199 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
12200 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
12201 @kindex set timeout
12202 @kindex show timeout
12203 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
12204 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
12205 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
12206 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
12207 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
12208 waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
12209 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
12210 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
12211 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
12212 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
12213
12214 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
12215 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
12216 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
12217 to run before stopping.
12218 @end table
12219
12220 @node OpenRISC 1000
12221 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
12222 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
12223
12224 @cindex or1k boards
12225 See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
12226 about platform and commands.
12227
12228 @table @code
12229
12230 @kindex target jtag
12231 @item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
12232
12233 Connects to remote JTAG server.
12234 JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
12235 connected via parallel port to the board.
12236
12237 Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
12238
12239 @kindex or1ksim
12240 @item or1ksim @var{command}
12241 If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
12242 Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
12243
12244 @kindex info or1k spr
12245 @item info or1k spr
12246 Displays spr groups.
12247
12248 @item info or1k spr @var{group}
12249 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
12250 Displays register names in selected group.
12251
12252 @item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
12253 @itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
12254 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
12255 @itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
12256 Shows information about specified spr register.
12257
12258 @kindex spr
12259 @item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
12260 @itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
12261 @itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
12262 @itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
12263 Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
12264 @end table
12265
12266 Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
12267 It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
12268 program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
12269 triggers can be set using:
12270 @table @code
12271 @item $LEA/$LDATA
12272 Load effective address/data
12273 @item $SEA/$SDATA
12274 Store effective address/data
12275 @item $AEA/$ADATA
12276 Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
12277 @item $FETCH
12278 Fetch data
12279 @end table
12280
12281 When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
12282 @code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
12283
12284 @code{htrace} commands:
12285 @cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
12286 @table @code
12287 @kindex hwatch
12288 @item hwatch @var{conditional}
12289 Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effecive Address(es)
12290 or Data. For example:
12291
12292 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
12293
12294 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
12295
12296 @kindex htrace info
12297 @item htrace info
12298 Display information about current HW trace configuration.
12299
12300 @kindex htrace trigger
12301 @item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
12302 Set starting criteria for HW trace.
12303
12304 @kindex htrace qualifier
12305 @item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
12306 Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
12307
12308 @kindex htrace stop
12309 @item htrace stop @var{conditional}
12310 Set HW trace stopping criteria.
12311
12312 @kindex htrace record
12313 @item htrace record [@var{data}]*
12314 Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
12315 triggered.
12316
12317 @kindex htrace enable
12318 @item htrace enable
12319 @kindex htrace disable
12320 @itemx htrace disable
12321 Enables/disables the HW trace.
12322
12323 @kindex htrace rewind
12324 @item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
12325 Clears currently recorded trace data.
12326
12327 If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
12328 will be written there.
12329
12330 @kindex htrace print
12331 @item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
12332 Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
12333
12334 @kindex htrace mode continuous
12335 @item htrace mode continuous
12336 Set continuous trace mode.
12337
12338 @kindex htrace mode suspend
12339 @item htrace mode suspend
12340 Set suspend trace mode.
12341
12342 @end table
12343
12344 @node PowerPC
12345 @subsection PowerPC
12346
12347 @table @code
12348
12349 @kindex target dink32
12350 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
12351 DINK32 ROM monitor.
12352
12353 @kindex target ppcbug
12354 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
12355 @kindex target ppcbug1
12356 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
12357 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
12358
12359 @kindex target sds
12360 @item target sds @var{dev}
12361 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
12362
12363 @end table
12364
12365 @node PA
12366 @subsection HP PA Embedded
12367
12368 @table @code
12369
12370 @kindex target op50n
12371 @item target op50n @var{dev}
12372 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
12373
12374 @kindex target w89k
12375 @item target w89k @var{dev}
12376 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
12377
12378 @end table
12379
12380 @node SH
12381 @subsection Hitachi SH
12382
12383 @table @code
12384
12385 @kindex target hms@r{, with Hitachi SH}
12386 @item target hms @var{dev}
12387 A Hitachi SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
12388 commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
12389 the communications speed used.
12390
12391 @kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi SH}
12392 @item target e7000 @var{dev}
12393 E7000 emulator for Hitachi SH.
12394
12395 @kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
12396 @kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
12397 @item target sh3 @var{dev}
12398 @item target sh3e @var{dev}
12399 Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
12400
12401 @end table
12402
12403 @node Sparclet
12404 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
12405
12406 @cindex Sparclet
12407
12408 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
12409 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
12410 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
12411 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
12412 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
12413
12414 @table @code
12415 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
12416 @kindex remotetimeout
12417 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
12418 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
12419 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
12420 @end table
12421
12422 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
12423 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
12424 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
12425 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
12426 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
12427
12428 @smallexample
12429 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
12430 @end smallexample
12431
12432 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
12433
12434 @smallexample
12435 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
12436 @end smallexample
12437
12438 @cindex running, on Sparclet
12439 Once you have set
12440 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
12441 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
12442 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
12443
12444 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
12445
12446 @smallexample
12447 (gdbslet)
12448 @end smallexample
12449
12450 @menu
12451 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
12452 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
12453 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
12454 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
12455 @end menu
12456
12457 @node Sparclet File
12458 @subsubsection Setting file to debug
12459
12460 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
12461
12462 @smallexample
12463 (gdbslet) file prog
12464 @end smallexample
12465
12466 @need 1000
12467 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
12468 @value{GDBN} locates
12469 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
12470 path.
12471 If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
12472 files will be searched as well.
12473 @value{GDBN} locates
12474 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
12475 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
12476 If it fails
12477 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
12478
12479 @smallexample
12480 prog: No such file or directory.
12481 @end smallexample
12482
12483 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
12484 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
12485 @code{target} command again.
12486
12487 @node Sparclet Connection
12488 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
12489
12490 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
12491 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
12492
12493 @smallexample
12494 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
12495 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
12496 main () at ../prog.c:3
12497 @end smallexample
12498
12499 @need 750
12500 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
12501
12502 @smallexample
12503 Connected to ttya.
12504 @end smallexample
12505
12506 @node Sparclet Download
12507 @subsubsection Sparclet download
12508
12509 @cindex download to Sparclet
12510 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
12511 you can use the @value{GDBN}
12512 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
12513 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
12514 command.
12515 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
12516 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
12517 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
12518 of each of the file's sections.
12519 For instance, if the program
12520 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
12521 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
12522
12523 @smallexample
12524 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
12525 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
12526 @end smallexample
12527
12528 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
12529 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
12530 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
12531
12532 @node Sparclet Execution
12533 @subsubsection Running and debugging
12534
12535 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
12536 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
12537 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
12538 manual for the list of commands.
12539
12540 @smallexample
12541 (gdbslet) b main
12542 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
12543 (gdbslet) run
12544 Starting program: prog
12545 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
12546 3 char *symarg = 0;
12547 (gdbslet) step
12548 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
12549 (gdbslet)
12550 @end smallexample
12551
12552 @node Sparclite
12553 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
12554
12555 @table @code
12556
12557 @kindex target sparclite
12558 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
12559 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
12560 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
12561 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
12562 remote protocol.
12563
12564 @end table
12565
12566 @node ST2000
12567 @subsection Tandem ST2000
12568
12569 @value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
12570 STDBUG protocol.
12571
12572 To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
12573 manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
12574
12575 @smallexample
12576 target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
12577 @end smallexample
12578
12579 @noindent
12580 to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
12581 the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
12582 ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
12583 connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
12584 concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
12585
12586 The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
12587 this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
12588 would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
12589 (such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
12590 available on your host computer.
12591 @c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
12592 @c basically hearsay.
12593
12594 @cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
12595 These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
12596 environment:
12597
12598 @table @code
12599 @item st2000 @var{command}
12600 @kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
12601 @cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
12602 @cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
12603 Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
12604 manual for available commands.
12605
12606 @item connect
12607 @cindex connect (to STDBUG)
12608 Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
12609 you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
12610 sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
12611 @kbd{@key{RET}~.} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
12612 @kbd{@key{RET}~@key{C-d}} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
12613 @end table
12614
12615 @node Z8000
12616 @subsection Zilog Z8000
12617
12618 @cindex Z8000
12619 @cindex simulator, Z8000
12620 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
12621
12622 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
12623 a Z8000 simulator.
12624
12625 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
12626 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
12627 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
12628 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
12629
12630 @table @code
12631 @item target sim @var{args}
12632 @kindex sim
12633 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
12634 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
12635 options, specify them via @var{args}.
12636 @end table
12637
12638 @noindent
12639 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
12640 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
12641 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
12642 to run your program, and so on.
12643
12644 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
12645 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
12646 additional items of information as specially named registers:
12647
12648 @table @code
12649
12650 @item cycles
12651 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
12652
12653 @item insts
12654 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
12655
12656 @item time
12657 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
12658
12659 @end table
12660
12661 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
12662 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
12663 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
12664 simulated clock ticks.
12665
12666 @node Architectures
12667 @section Architectures
12668
12669 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
12670 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
12671
12672 @menu
12673 * A29K::
12674 * Alpha::
12675 * MIPS::
12676 @end menu
12677
12678 @node A29K
12679 @subsection A29K
12680
12681 @table @code
12682
12683 @kindex set rstack_high_address
12684 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
12685 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
12686 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
12687 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
12688 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
12689 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
12690 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
12691 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
12692 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
12693 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
12694 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
12695 hexadecimal.
12696
12697 @kindex show rstack_high_address
12698 @item show rstack_high_address
12699 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
12700 processors.
12701
12702 @end table
12703
12704 @node Alpha
12705 @subsection Alpha
12706
12707 See the following section.
12708
12709 @node MIPS
12710 @subsection MIPS
12711
12712 @cindex stack on Alpha
12713 @cindex stack on MIPS
12714 @cindex Alpha stack
12715 @cindex MIPS stack
12716 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
12717 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
12718 find the beginning of a function.
12719
12720 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
12721 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
12722 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
12723 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
12724 commands:
12725
12726 @table @code
12727 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
12728 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
12729 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
12730 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
12731 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
12732 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
12733 and therefore the longer it takes to run.
12734
12735 @item show heuristic-fence-post
12736 Display the current limit.
12737 @end table
12738
12739 @noindent
12740 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
12741 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
12742
12743
12744 @node Controlling GDB
12745 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
12746
12747 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
12748 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
12749 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
12750 described here.
12751
12752 @menu
12753 * Prompt:: Prompt
12754 * Editing:: Command editing
12755 * History:: Command history
12756 * Screen Size:: Screen size
12757 * Numbers:: Numbers
12758 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
12759 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
12760 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
12761 @end menu
12762
12763 @node Prompt
12764 @section Prompt
12765
12766 @cindex prompt
12767
12768 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
12769 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
12770 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
12771 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
12772 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
12773 which one you are talking to.
12774
12775 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
12776 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
12777 or a prompt that does not.
12778
12779 @table @code
12780 @kindex set prompt
12781 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
12782 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
12783
12784 @kindex show prompt
12785 @item show prompt
12786 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
12787 @end table
12788
12789 @node Editing
12790 @section Command editing
12791 @cindex readline
12792 @cindex command line editing
12793
12794 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{readline} interface. This
12795 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
12796 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
12797 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
12798 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
12799 debugging sessions.
12800
12801 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
12802 command @code{set}.
12803
12804 @table @code
12805 @kindex set editing
12806 @cindex editing
12807 @item set editing
12808 @itemx set editing on
12809 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
12810
12811 @item set editing off
12812 Disable command line editing.
12813
12814 @kindex show editing
12815 @item show editing
12816 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
12817 @end table
12818
12819 @node History
12820 @section Command history
12821
12822 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
12823 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
12824 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
12825 history facility.
12826
12827 @table @code
12828 @cindex history substitution
12829 @cindex history file
12830 @kindex set history filename
12831 @kindex GDBHISTFILE
12832 @item set history filename @var{fname}
12833 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
12834 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
12835 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
12836 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
12837 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
12838 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
12839 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
12840 is not set.
12841
12842 @cindex history save
12843 @kindex set history save
12844 @item set history save
12845 @itemx set history save on
12846 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
12847 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
12848
12849 @item set history save off
12850 Stop recording command history in a file.
12851
12852 @cindex history size
12853 @kindex set history size
12854 @item set history size @var{size}
12855 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
12856 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
12857 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
12858 @end table
12859
12860 @cindex history expansion
12861 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
12862 @ifset have-readline-appendices
12863 @xref{Event Designators}.
12864 @end ifset
12865
12866 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
12867 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
12868 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
12869 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
12870 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
12871 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
12872 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
12873
12874 The commands to control history expansion are:
12875
12876 @table @code
12877 @kindex set history expansion
12878 @item set history expansion on
12879 @itemx set history expansion
12880 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
12881
12882 @item set history expansion off
12883 Disable history expansion.
12884
12885 The readline code comes with more complete documentation of
12886 editing and history expansion features. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs
12887 or @code{vi} may wish to read it.
12888 @ifset have-readline-appendices
12889 @xref{Command Line Editing}.
12890 @end ifset
12891
12892 @c @group
12893 @kindex show history
12894 @item show history
12895 @itemx show history filename
12896 @itemx show history save
12897 @itemx show history size
12898 @itemx show history expansion
12899 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
12900 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
12901 @c @end group
12902 @end table
12903
12904 @table @code
12905 @kindex shows
12906 @item show commands
12907 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
12908
12909 @item show commands @var{n}
12910 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
12911
12912 @item show commands +
12913 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
12914 @end table
12915
12916 @node Screen Size
12917 @section Screen size
12918 @cindex size of screen
12919 @cindex pauses in output
12920
12921 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
12922 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
12923 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
12924 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
12925 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
12926 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
12927 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
12928 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
12929
12930 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
12931 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
12932 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
12933 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
12934 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
12935 width} commands:
12936
12937 @table @code
12938 @kindex set height
12939 @kindex set width
12940 @kindex show width
12941 @kindex show height
12942 @item set height @var{lpp}
12943 @itemx show height
12944 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
12945 @itemx show width
12946 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
12947 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
12948 commands display the current settings.
12949
12950 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
12951 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
12952 file or to an editor buffer.
12953
12954 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
12955 from wrapping its output.
12956 @end table
12957
12958 @node Numbers
12959 @section Numbers
12960 @cindex number representation
12961 @cindex entering numbers
12962
12963 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
12964 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
12965 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
12966 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that begin with none of these are, by
12967 default, entered in base 10; likewise, the default display for
12968 numbers---when no particular format is specified---is base 10. You can
12969 change the default base for both input and output with the @code{set
12970 radix} command.
12971
12972 @table @code
12973 @kindex set input-radix
12974 @item set input-radix @var{base}
12975 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
12976 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12977 specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix; for
12978 example, any of
12979
12980 @smallexample
12981 set radix 012
12982 set radix 10.
12983 set radix 0xa
12984 @end smallexample
12985
12986 @noindent
12987 sets the base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set radix 10}
12988 leaves the radix unchanged no matter what it was.
12989
12990 @kindex set output-radix
12991 @item set output-radix @var{base}
12992 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
12993 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12994 specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix.
12995
12996 @kindex show input-radix
12997 @item show input-radix
12998 Display the current default base for numeric input.
12999
13000 @kindex show output-radix
13001 @item show output-radix
13002 Display the current default base for numeric display.
13003 @end table
13004
13005 @node ABI
13006 @section Configuring the current ABI
13007
13008 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
13009 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
13010 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
13011 current ABI.
13012
13013 @cindex OS ABI
13014 @kindex set osabi
13015 @kindex show osabi
13016
13017 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
13018 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
13019 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
13020 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
13021 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
13022 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
13023 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
13024 platform provides.
13025
13026 @table @code
13027 @item show osabi
13028 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
13029
13030 @item set osabi
13031 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
13032
13033 @item set osabi @var{abi}
13034 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
13035 @end table
13036
13037 @cindex float promotion
13038 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
13039
13040 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
13041 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
13042 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
13043 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
13044 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
13045 @code{double} and then passed.
13046
13047 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
13048 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
13049 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
13050
13051 @table @code
13052 @item set coerce-float-to-double
13053 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
13054 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
13055 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
13056
13057 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
13058 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
13059 functions.
13060 @end table
13061
13062 @kindex set cp-abi
13063 @kindex show cp-abi
13064 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
13065 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
13066 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
13067 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
13068 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
13069 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
13070 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
13071 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
13072 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
13073 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
13074 ``auto''.
13075
13076 @table @code
13077 @item show cp-abi
13078 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
13079
13080 @item set cp-abi
13081 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
13082
13083 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
13084 @itemx set cp-abi auto
13085 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
13086 @end table
13087
13088 @node Messages/Warnings
13089 @section Optional warnings and messages
13090
13091 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
13092 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
13093 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
13094 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
13095
13096 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
13097 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
13098 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
13099
13100 @table @code
13101 @kindex set verbose
13102 @item set verbose on
13103 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
13104
13105 @item set verbose off
13106 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
13107
13108 @kindex show verbose
13109 @item show verbose
13110 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
13111 @end table
13112
13113 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
13114 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
13115 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
13116 symbol files}).
13117
13118 @table @code
13119
13120 @kindex set complaints
13121 @item set complaints @var{limit}
13122 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
13123 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
13124 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
13125 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
13126
13127 @kindex show complaints
13128 @item show complaints
13129 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
13130
13131 @end table
13132
13133 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
13134 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
13135 you try to run a program which is already running:
13136
13137 @smallexample
13138 (@value{GDBP}) run
13139 The program being debugged has been started already.
13140 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
13141 @end smallexample
13142
13143 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
13144 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
13145
13146 @table @code
13147
13148 @kindex set confirm
13149 @cindex flinching
13150 @cindex confirmation
13151 @cindex stupid questions
13152 @item set confirm off
13153 Disables confirmation requests.
13154
13155 @item set confirm on
13156 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
13157
13158 @kindex show confirm
13159 @item show confirm
13160 Displays state of confirmation requests.
13161
13162 @end table
13163
13164 @node Debugging Output
13165 @section Optional messages about internal happenings
13166 @table @code
13167 @kindex set debug arch
13168 @item set debug arch
13169 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
13170 @kindex show debug arch
13171 @item show debug arch
13172 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
13173 @kindex set debug event
13174 @item set debug event
13175 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
13176 default is off.
13177 @kindex show debug event
13178 @item show debug event
13179 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
13180 info.
13181 @kindex set debug expression
13182 @item set debug expression
13183 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} expression debugging info. The
13184 default is off.
13185 @kindex show debug expression
13186 @item show debug expression
13187 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} expression
13188 debugging info.
13189 @kindex set debug frame
13190 @item set debug frame
13191 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
13192 default is off.
13193 @kindex show debug frame
13194 @item show debug frame
13195 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
13196 info.
13197 @kindex set debug overload
13198 @item set debug overload
13199 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
13200 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
13201 is off.
13202 @kindex show debug overload
13203 @item show debug overload
13204 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
13205 debugging info.
13206 @kindex set debug remote
13207 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
13208 @cindex serial connections, debugging
13209 @item set debug remote
13210 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
13211 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
13212 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
13213 @kindex show debug remote
13214 @item show debug remote
13215 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
13216 @kindex set debug serial
13217 @item set debug serial
13218 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
13219 default is off.
13220 @kindex show debug serial
13221 @item show debug serial
13222 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
13223 info.
13224 @kindex set debug target
13225 @item set debug target
13226 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
13227 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
13228 default is off.
13229 @kindex show debug target
13230 @item show debug target
13231 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
13232 info.
13233 @kindex set debug varobj
13234 @item set debug varobj
13235 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
13236 info. The default is off.
13237 @kindex show debug varobj
13238 @item show debug varobj
13239 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
13240 debugging info.
13241 @end table
13242
13243 @node Sequences
13244 @chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
13245
13246 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
13247 command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
13248 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
13249 files.
13250
13251 @menu
13252 * Define:: User-defined commands
13253 * Hooks:: User-defined command hooks
13254 * Command Files:: Command files
13255 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
13256 @end menu
13257
13258 @node Define
13259 @section User-defined commands
13260
13261 @cindex user-defined command
13262 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
13263 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
13264 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
13265 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
13266 via @var{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
13267
13268 @smallexample
13269 define adder
13270 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
13271 @end smallexample
13272
13273 @noindent
13274 To execute the command use:
13275
13276 @smallexample
13277 adder 1 2 3
13278 @end smallexample
13279
13280 @noindent
13281 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
13282 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
13283 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
13284 functions calls.
13285
13286 @table @code
13287
13288 @kindex define
13289 @item define @var{commandname}
13290 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
13291 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
13292
13293 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
13294 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
13295 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
13296
13297 @kindex if
13298 @kindex else
13299 @item if
13300 Takes a single argument, which is an expression to evaluate.
13301 It is followed by a series of commands that are executed
13302 only if the expression is true (nonzero).
13303 There can then optionally be a line @code{else}, followed
13304 by a series of commands that are only executed if the expression
13305 was false. The end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
13306
13307 @kindex while
13308 @item while
13309 The syntax is similar to @code{if}: the command takes a single argument,
13310 which is an expression to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to
13311 execute, one per line, terminated by an @code{end}.
13312 The commands are executed repeatedly as long as the expression
13313 evaluates to true.
13314
13315 @kindex document
13316 @item document @var{commandname}
13317 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
13318 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
13319 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
13320 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
13321 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
13322 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
13323
13324 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
13325 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
13326 does not change the documentation.
13327
13328 @kindex help user-defined
13329 @item help user-defined
13330 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
13331 (if any) for each.
13332
13333 @kindex show user
13334 @item show user
13335 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
13336 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
13337 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
13338 definitions for all user-defined commands.
13339
13340 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
13341 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
13342 @item show max-user-call-depth
13343 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
13344 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
13345 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before GDB suspects an
13346 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
13347
13348 @end table
13349
13350 When user-defined commands are executed, the
13351 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
13352 stops execution of the user-defined command.
13353
13354 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
13355 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
13356 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
13357 messages when used in a user-defined command.
13358
13359 @node Hooks
13360 @section User-defined command hooks
13361 @cindex command hooks
13362 @cindex hooks, for commands
13363 @cindex hooks, pre-command
13364
13365 @kindex hook
13366 @kindex hook-
13367 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
13368 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
13369 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
13370 before that command.
13371
13372 @cindex hooks, post-command
13373 @kindex hookpost
13374 @kindex hookpost-
13375 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
13376 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
13377 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
13378 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
13379 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
13380
13381 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
13382 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinte recursion.
13383
13384 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
13385 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
13386
13387 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
13388 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
13389 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
13390 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
13391 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
13392
13393 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
13394 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
13395 you could define:
13396
13397 @smallexample
13398 define hook-stop
13399 handle SIGALRM nopass
13400 end
13401
13402 define hook-run
13403 handle SIGALRM pass
13404 end
13405
13406 define hook-continue
13407 handle SIGLARM pass
13408 end
13409 @end smallexample
13410
13411 As a further example, to hook at the begining and end of the @code{echo}
13412 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
13413 you could define:
13414
13415 @smallexample
13416 define hook-echo
13417 echo <<<---
13418 end
13419
13420 define hookpost-echo
13421 echo --->>>\n
13422 end
13423
13424 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
13425 <<<---Hello World--->>>
13426 (@value{GDBP})
13427
13428 @end smallexample
13429
13430 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
13431 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
13432 name, e.g. @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
13433 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
13434 @c or not?
13435 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
13436 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
13437 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
13438
13439 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
13440 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
13441
13442 @node Command Files
13443 @section Command files
13444
13445 @cindex command files
13446 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a file of lines that are @value{GDBN}
13447 commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may also be included.
13448 An empty line in a command file does nothing; it does not mean to repeat
13449 the last command, as it would from the terminal.
13450
13451 @cindex init file
13452 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
13453 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
13454 When you start @value{GDBN}, it automatically executes commands from its
13455 @dfn{init files}, normally called @file{.gdbinit}@footnote{The DJGPP
13456 port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini} instead, due to the
13457 limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems.}.
13458 During startup, @value{GDBN} does the following:
13459
13460 @enumerate
13461 @item
13462 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
13463 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
13464 @code{HOME} environment variable.}.
13465
13466 @item
13467 Processes command line options and operands.
13468
13469 @item
13470 Reads the init file (if any) in the current working directory.
13471
13472 @item
13473 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option.
13474 @end enumerate
13475
13476 The init file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
13477 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
13478 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
13479 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}).
13480
13481 @cindex init file name
13482 On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
13483 different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
13484 form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
13485 different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
13486 environments with special init file names:
13487
13488 @cindex @file{.vxgdbinit}
13489 @itemize @bullet
13490 @item
13491 VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @file{.vxgdbinit}
13492
13493 @cindex @file{.os68gdbinit}
13494 @item
13495 OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @file{.os68gdbinit}
13496
13497 @cindex @file{.esgdbinit}
13498 @item
13499 ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @file{.esgdbinit}
13500 @end itemize
13501
13502 You can also request the execution of a command file with the
13503 @code{source} command:
13504
13505 @table @code
13506 @kindex source
13507 @item source @var{filename}
13508 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
13509 @end table
13510
13511 The lines in a command file are executed sequentially. They are not
13512 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
13513 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
13514
13515 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
13516 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
13517 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
13518 when called from command files.
13519
13520 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
13521 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
13522 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
13523 not terminate execution of the command file --- execution continues with
13524 the next command.
13525
13526 @smallexample
13527 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
13528 @end smallexample
13529
13530 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
13531 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
13532 would be directed to @file{log}.
13533
13534 @node Output
13535 @section Commands for controlled output
13536
13537 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
13538 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
13539 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
13540 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
13541 want.
13542
13543 @table @code
13544 @kindex echo
13545 @item echo @var{text}
13546 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
13547 @c because it is not in ANSI.
13548 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
13549 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
13550 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
13551 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
13552 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
13553 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
13554 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
13555 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
13556 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
13557
13558 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
13559 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
13560
13561 @smallexample
13562 echo This is some text\n\
13563 which is continued\n\
13564 onto several lines.\n
13565 @end smallexample
13566
13567 produces the same output as
13568
13569 @smallexample
13570 echo This is some text\n
13571 echo which is continued\n
13572 echo onto several lines.\n
13573 @end smallexample
13574
13575 @kindex output
13576 @item output @var{expression}
13577 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
13578 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
13579 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
13580 on expressions.
13581
13582 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
13583 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
13584 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
13585 formats}, for more information.
13586
13587 @kindex printf
13588 @item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
13589 Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
13590 @var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
13591 either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
13592 @var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
13593 subroutine
13594 @c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
13595 @c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
13596 @c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
13597 @c supported.
13598
13599 @smallexample
13600 printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
13601 @end smallexample
13602
13603 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
13604
13605 @smallexample
13606 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
13607 @end smallexample
13608
13609 The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
13610 string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
13611 letter.
13612 @end table
13613
13614 @node Interpreters
13615 @chapter Command Interpreters
13616 @cindex command interpreters
13617
13618 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
13619 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
13620 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
13621
13622 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
13623 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
13624 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
13625 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
13626
13627 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
13628 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
13629 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
13630 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
13631
13632 @table @code
13633 @item console
13634 @cindex console interpreter
13635 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
13636 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
13637 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
13638
13639 @item mi
13640 @cindex mi interpreter
13641 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
13642 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
13643 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
13644 Interface}.
13645
13646 @item mi2
13647 @cindex mi2 interpreter
13648 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
13649
13650 @item mi1
13651 @cindex mi1 interpreter
13652 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
13653
13654 @end table
13655
13656 @cindex invoke another interpreter
13657 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
13658 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
13659 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
13660 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
13661 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
13662 the IDE inoperable!
13663
13664 @kindex interpreter-exec
13665 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
13666 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
13667 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
13668 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
13669
13670 @smallexample
13671 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
13672 @end smallexample
13673
13674 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
13675 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
13676
13677 @node TUI
13678 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
13679 @cindex TUI
13680
13681 @menu
13682 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
13683 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
13684 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
13685 * TUI Commands:: TUI specific commands
13686 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
13687 @end menu
13688
13689 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface, TUI in short,
13690 is a terminal interface which uses the @code{curses} library
13691 to show the source file, the assembly output, the program registers
13692 and @value{GDBN} commands in separate text windows.
13693 The TUI is available only when @value{GDBN} is configured
13694 with the @code{--enable-tui} configure option (@pxref{Configure Options}).
13695
13696 @node TUI Overview
13697 @section TUI overview
13698
13699 The TUI has two display modes that can be switched while
13700 @value{GDBN} runs:
13701
13702 @itemize @bullet
13703 @item
13704 A curses (or TUI) mode in which it displays several text
13705 windows on the terminal.
13706
13707 @item
13708 A standard mode which corresponds to the @value{GDBN} configured without
13709 the TUI.
13710 @end itemize
13711
13712 In the TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text window
13713 on the terminal:
13714
13715 @table @emph
13716 @item command
13717 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
13718 prompt and the @value{GDBN} outputs. The @value{GDBN} input is still
13719 managed using readline but through the TUI. The @emph{command}
13720 window is always visible.
13721
13722 @item source
13723 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
13724 line as well as active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
13725
13726 @item assembly
13727 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
13728
13729 @item register
13730 This window shows the processor registers. It detects when
13731 a register is changed and when this is the case, registers that have
13732 changed are highlighted.
13733
13734 @end table
13735
13736 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
13737 by highlighting the current line and marking them with the @samp{>} marker.
13738 Breakpoints are also indicated with two markers. A first one
13739 indicates the breakpoint type:
13740
13741 @table @code
13742 @item B
13743 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
13744
13745 @item b
13746 Breakpoint which was never hit.
13747
13748 @item H
13749 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
13750
13751 @item h
13752 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
13753
13754 @end table
13755
13756 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
13757
13758 @table @code
13759 @item +
13760 Breakpoint is enabled.
13761
13762 @item -
13763 Breakpoint is disabled.
13764
13765 @end table
13766
13767 The source, assembly and register windows are attached to the thread
13768 and the frame position. They are updated when the current thread
13769 changes, when the frame changes or when the program counter changes.
13770 These three windows are arranged by the TUI according to several
13771 layouts. The layout defines which of these three windows are visible.
13772 The following layouts are available:
13773
13774 @itemize @bullet
13775 @item
13776 source
13777
13778 @item
13779 assembly
13780
13781 @item
13782 source and assembly
13783
13784 @item
13785 source and registers
13786
13787 @item
13788 assembly and registers
13789
13790 @end itemize
13791
13792 On top of the command window a status line gives various information
13793 concerning the current process begin debugged. The status line is
13794 updated when the information it shows changes. The following fields
13795 are displayed:
13796
13797 @table @emph
13798 @item target
13799 Indicates the current gdb target
13800 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
13801
13802 @item process
13803 Gives information about the current process or thread number.
13804 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
13805
13806 @item function
13807 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
13808 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
13809 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter
13810 the string @code{??} is displayed.
13811
13812 @item line
13813 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
13814 When the current line number is not known the string @code{??} is displayed.
13815
13816 @item pc
13817 Indicates the current program counter address.
13818
13819 @end table
13820
13821 @node TUI Keys
13822 @section TUI Key Bindings
13823 @cindex TUI key bindings
13824
13825 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
13826 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
13827 They allow to leave or enter in the TUI mode or they operate
13828 directly on the TUI layout and windows. The TUI also provides
13829 a @emph{SingleKey} keymap which binds several keys directly to
13830 @value{GDBN} commands. The following key bindings
13831 are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
13832
13833 @table @kbd
13834 @kindex C-x C-a
13835 @item C-x C-a
13836 @kindex C-x a
13837 @itemx C-x a
13838 @kindex C-x A
13839 @itemx C-x A
13840 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When the TUI mode is left,
13841 the curses window management is left and @value{GDBN} operates using
13842 its standard mode writing on the terminal directly. When the TUI
13843 mode is entered, the control is given back to the curses windows.
13844 The screen is then refreshed.
13845
13846 @kindex C-x 1
13847 @item C-x 1
13848 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
13849 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
13850 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
13851
13852 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
13853
13854 @kindex C-x 2
13855 @item C-x 2
13856 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
13857 layout shows already two windows, a next layout with two windows is used.
13858 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
13859 previous layout and the new one.
13860
13861 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
13862
13863 @kindex C-x o
13864 @item C-x o
13865 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
13866 (like scrolling and arrow keys) to the active window. This command
13867 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
13868
13869 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
13870
13871 @kindex C-x s
13872 @item C-x s
13873 Use the TUI @emph{SingleKey} keymap that binds single key to gdb commands
13874 (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
13875
13876 @end table
13877
13878 The following key bindings are handled only by the TUI mode:
13879
13880 @table @key
13881 @kindex PgUp
13882 @item PgUp
13883 Scroll the active window one page up.
13884
13885 @kindex PgDn
13886 @item PgDn
13887 Scroll the active window one page down.
13888
13889 @kindex Up
13890 @item Up
13891 Scroll the active window one line up.
13892
13893 @kindex Down
13894 @item Down
13895 Scroll the active window one line down.
13896
13897 @kindex Left
13898 @item Left
13899 Scroll the active window one column left.
13900
13901 @kindex Right
13902 @item Right
13903 Scroll the active window one column right.
13904
13905 @kindex C-L
13906 @item C-L
13907 Refresh the screen.
13908
13909 @end table
13910
13911 In the TUI mode, the arrow keys are used by the active window
13912 for scrolling. This means they are available for readline when the
13913 active window is the command window. When the command window
13914 does not have the focus, it is necessary to use other readline
13915 key bindings such as @key{C-p}, @key{C-n}, @key{C-b} and @key{C-f}.
13916
13917 @node TUI Single Key Mode
13918 @section TUI Single Key Mode
13919 @cindex TUI single key mode
13920
13921 The TUI provides a @emph{SingleKey} mode in which it installs a particular
13922 key binding in the readline keymaps to connect single keys to
13923 some gdb commands.
13924
13925 @table @kbd
13926 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13927 @item c
13928 continue
13929
13930 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13931 @item d
13932 down
13933
13934 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13935 @item f
13936 finish
13937
13938 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13939 @item n
13940 next
13941
13942 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13943 @item q
13944 exit the @emph{SingleKey} mode.
13945
13946 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13947 @item r
13948 run
13949
13950 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13951 @item s
13952 step
13953
13954 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13955 @item u
13956 up
13957
13958 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13959 @item v
13960 info locals
13961
13962 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13963 @item w
13964 where
13965
13966 @end table
13967
13968 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
13969 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
13970 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
13971 with the TUI @emph{SingleKey} mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
13972 @emph{SingleKey} mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
13973 this mode is by hitting @key{q} or @samp{@key{C-x} @key{s}}.
13974
13975
13976 @node TUI Commands
13977 @section TUI specific commands
13978 @cindex TUI commands
13979
13980 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
13981 These commands are always available, that is they do not depend on
13982 the current terminal mode in which @value{GDBN} runs. When @value{GDBN}
13983 is in the standard mode, using these commands will automatically switch
13984 in the TUI mode.
13985
13986 @table @code
13987 @item info win
13988 @kindex info win
13989 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
13990
13991 @item layout next
13992 @kindex layout next
13993 Display the next layout.
13994
13995 @item layout prev
13996 @kindex layout prev
13997 Display the previous layout.
13998
13999 @item layout src
14000 @kindex layout src
14001 Display the source window only.
14002
14003 @item layout asm
14004 @kindex layout asm
14005 Display the assembly window only.
14006
14007 @item layout split
14008 @kindex layout split
14009 Display the source and assembly window.
14010
14011 @item layout regs
14012 @kindex layout regs
14013 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
14014
14015 @item focus next | prev | src | asm | regs | split
14016 @kindex focus
14017 Set the focus to the named window.
14018 This command allows to change the active window so that scrolling keys
14019 can be affected to another window.
14020
14021 @item refresh
14022 @kindex refresh
14023 Refresh the screen. This is similar to using @key{C-L} key.
14024
14025 @item update
14026 @kindex update
14027 Update the source window and the current execution point.
14028
14029 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
14030 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
14031 @kindex winheight
14032 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
14033 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
14034 decrease it.
14035
14036 @end table
14037
14038 @node TUI Configuration
14039 @section TUI configuration variables
14040 @cindex TUI configuration variables
14041
14042 The TUI has several configuration variables that control the
14043 appearance of windows on the terminal.
14044
14045 @table @code
14046 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
14047 @kindex set tui border-kind
14048 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
14049 The possible values are the following:
14050 @table @code
14051 @item space
14052 Use a space character to draw the border.
14053
14054 @item ascii
14055 Use ascii characters + - and | to draw the border.
14056
14057 @item acs
14058 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
14059 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
14060
14061 @end table
14062
14063 @item set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
14064 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
14065 Select the attributes to display the border of the active window.
14066 The possible values are @code{normal}, @code{standout}, @code{reverse},
14067 @code{half}, @code{half-standout}, @code{bold} and @code{bold-standout}.
14068
14069 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
14070 @kindex set tui border-mode
14071 Select the attributes to display the border of other windows.
14072 The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
14073 @table @code
14074 @item normal
14075 Use normal attributes to display the border.
14076
14077 @item standout
14078 Use standout mode.
14079
14080 @item reverse
14081 Use reverse video mode.
14082
14083 @item half
14084 Use half bright mode.
14085
14086 @item half-standout
14087 Use half bright and standout mode.
14088
14089 @item bold
14090 Use extra bright or bold mode.
14091
14092 @item bold-standout
14093 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
14094
14095 @end table
14096
14097 @end table
14098
14099 @node Emacs
14100 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
14101
14102 @cindex Emacs
14103 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
14104 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
14105 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
14106 @value{GDBN}.
14107
14108 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
14109 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
14110 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
14111 created Emacs buffer.
14112 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
14113
14114 Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
14115 things:
14116
14117 @itemize @bullet
14118 @item
14119 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
14120 @end itemize
14121
14122 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
14123 and output done by the program you are debugging.
14124
14125 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
14126 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
14127 in this way.
14128
14129 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
14130 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
14131 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
14132 stop.
14133
14134 @itemize @bullet
14135 @item
14136 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
14137 @end itemize
14138
14139 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
14140 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
14141 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
14142 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
14143 and the source.
14144
14145 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
14146 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
14147
14148 @quotation
14149 @emph{Warning:} If the directory where your program resides is not your
14150 current directory, it can be easy to confuse Emacs about the location of
14151 the source files, in which case the auxiliary display buffer does not
14152 appear to show your source. @value{GDBN} can find programs by searching your
14153 environment's @code{PATH} variable, so the @value{GDBN} input and output
14154 session proceeds normally; but Emacs does not get enough information
14155 back from @value{GDBN} to locate the source files in this situation. To
14156 avoid this problem, either start @value{GDBN} mode from the directory where
14157 your program resides, or specify an absolute file name when prompted for the
14158 @kbd{M-x gdb} argument.
14159
14160 A similar confusion can result if you use the @value{GDBN} @code{file} command to
14161 switch to debugging a program in some other location, from an existing
14162 @value{GDBN} buffer in Emacs.
14163 @end quotation
14164
14165 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If
14166 you need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you keep
14167 several configurations around, with different names) you can set the
14168 Emacs variable @code{gdb-command-name}; for example,
14169
14170 @smallexample
14171 (setq gdb-command-name "mygdb")
14172 @end smallexample
14173
14174 @noindent
14175 (preceded by @kbd{M-:} or @kbd{ESC :}, or typed in the @code{*scratch*} buffer, or
14176 in your @file{.emacs} file) makes Emacs call the program named
14177 ``@code{mygdb}'' instead.
14178
14179 In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
14180 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
14181
14182 @table @kbd
14183 @item C-h m
14184 Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
14185
14186 @item M-s
14187 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
14188 update the display window to show the current file and location.
14189
14190 @item M-n
14191 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
14192 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
14193 to show the current file and location.
14194
14195 @item M-i
14196 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
14197 display window accordingly.
14198
14199 @item M-x gdb-nexti
14200 Execute to next instruction, using the @value{GDBN} @code{nexti} command; update
14201 display window accordingly.
14202
14203 @item C-c C-f
14204 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
14205 @code{finish} command.
14206
14207 @item M-c
14208 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
14209 command.
14210
14211 @emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-p}.
14212
14213 @item M-u
14214 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
14215 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
14216 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
14217
14218 @emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-u}.
14219
14220 @item M-d
14221 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
14222 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
14223
14224 @emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-d}.
14225
14226 @item C-x &
14227 Read the number where the cursor is positioned, and insert it at the end
14228 of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer. For example, if you wish to disassemble code
14229 around an address that was displayed earlier, type @kbd{disassemble};
14230 then move the cursor to the address display, and pick up the
14231 argument for @code{disassemble} by typing @kbd{C-x &}.
14232
14233 You can customize this further by defining elements of the list
14234 @code{gdb-print-command}; once it is defined, you can format or
14235 otherwise process numbers picked up by @kbd{C-x &} before they are
14236 inserted. A numeric argument to @kbd{C-x &} indicates that you
14237 wish special formatting, and also acts as an index to pick an element of the
14238 list. If the list element is a string, the number to be inserted is
14239 formatted using the Emacs function @code{format}; otherwise the number
14240 is passed as an argument to the corresponding list element.
14241 @end table
14242
14243 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x SPC} (@code{gdb-break})
14244 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
14245
14246 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
14247 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
14248 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
14249 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
14250 frame.
14251
14252 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
14253 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
14254 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
14255 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
14256 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
14257 to correspond properly with the code.
14258
14259 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
14260 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
14261 @ignore
14262 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
14263 @kindex Epoch
14264 @kindex inspect
14265
14266 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
14267 called the @code{epoch}
14268 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
14269 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
14270 each value is printed in its own window.
14271 @end ignore
14272
14273
14274 @node GDB/MI
14275 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
14276
14277 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
14278
14279 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
14280 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to @value{GDBN}. It is
14281 specifically intended to support the development of systems which use
14282 the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
14283
14284 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
14285 in the form of a reference manual.
14286
14287 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
14288 features described below are incomplete and subject to change.
14289
14290 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
14291
14292 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
14293 This chapter uses the following notation:
14294
14295 @itemize @bullet
14296 @item
14297 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
14298
14299 @item
14300 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
14301 it may or may not be given.
14302
14303 @item
14304 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
14305 may repeat zero or more times.
14306
14307 @item
14308 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
14309 may repeat one or more times.
14310
14311 @item
14312 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
14313 @end itemize
14314
14315 @ignore
14316 @heading Dependencies
14317 @end ignore
14318
14319 @heading Acknowledgments
14320
14321 In alphabetic order: Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, Stan Shebs and
14322 Elena Zannoni.
14323
14324 @menu
14325 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
14326 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
14327 * GDB/MI Output Records::
14328 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
14329 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Table Commands::
14330 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
14331 * GDB/MI Program Control::
14332 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
14333 @ignore
14334 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
14335 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
14336 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
14337 @end ignore
14338 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
14339 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
14340 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
14341 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
14342 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
14343 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
14344 @end menu
14345
14346 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
14347 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
14348 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
14349
14350 @menu
14351 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
14352 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
14353 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
14354 @end menu
14355
14356 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
14357 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
14358
14359 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
14360 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
14361 @table @code
14362 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
14363 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
14364
14365 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
14366 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
14367 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
14368
14369 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
14370 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
14371 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
14372
14373 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
14374 "any sequence of digits"
14375
14376 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
14377 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
14378
14379 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
14380 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
14381
14382 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
14383 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
14384
14385 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
14386 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
14387 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
14388
14389 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
14390 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
14391
14392 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
14393 @code{CR | CR-LF}
14394 @end table
14395
14396 @noindent
14397 Notes:
14398
14399 @itemize @bullet
14400 @item
14401 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
14402 output is described below.
14403
14404 @item
14405 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
14406 finishes.
14407
14408 @item
14409 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
14410 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
14411 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
14412 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
14413 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
14414 @end itemize
14415
14416 Pragmatics:
14417
14418 @itemize @bullet
14419 @item
14420 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
14421
14422 @item
14423 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
14424 @end itemize
14425
14426 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
14427 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
14428
14429 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
14430 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
14431 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
14432 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
14433 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
14434 terminated by @samp{(@value{GDBP})}.
14435
14436 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
14437 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
14438 @var{token}.
14439
14440 @table @code
14441 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
14442 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
14443
14444 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
14445 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
14446
14447 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
14448 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
14449
14450 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
14451 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
14452
14453 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
14454 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output}}
14455
14456 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
14457 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output}}
14458
14459 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
14460 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output}}
14461
14462 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
14463 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
14464
14465 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
14466 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
14467
14468 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
14469 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
14470 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
14471
14472 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
14473 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
14474
14475 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
14476 @code{ @var{string} }
14477
14478 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
14479 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
14480
14481 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
14482 @code{@var{c-string}}
14483
14484 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
14485 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
14486
14487 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
14488 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
14489 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
14490
14491 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
14492 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
14493
14494 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
14495 @code{"~" @var{c-string}}
14496
14497 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
14498 @code{"@@" @var{c-string}}
14499
14500 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
14501 @code{"&" @var{c-string}}
14502
14503 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
14504 @code{CR | CR-LF}
14505
14506 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
14507 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
14508 @end table
14509
14510 @noindent
14511 Notes:
14512
14513 @itemize @bullet
14514 @item
14515 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
14516
14517 @item
14518 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. If an execution
14519 command is interrupted by the @samp{-exec-interrupt} command, the
14520 @var{token} associated with the @samp{*stopped} message is the one of the
14521 original execution command, not the one of the interrupt command.
14522
14523 @item
14524 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
14525 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
14526 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
14527 prefixed by @samp{+}.
14528
14529 @item
14530 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
14531 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
14532 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
14533 @samp{*}.
14534
14535 @item
14536 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
14537 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
14538 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
14539 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
14540
14541 @item
14542 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
14543 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
14544 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
14545 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
14546
14547 @item
14548 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
14549 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
14550 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
14551
14552 @item
14553 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
14554 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
14555 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
14556 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
14557
14558 @item
14559 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
14560 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
14561 @var{values}.
14562
14563
14564 @end itemize
14565
14566 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
14567 details about the various output records.
14568
14569 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
14570 @subsection Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
14571 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
14572
14573 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
14574 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
14575 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
14576 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
14577
14578 @subsubheading Target Stop
14579 @c Ummm... There is no "-stop" command. This assumes async, no?
14580 Here's an example of stopping the inferior process:
14581
14582 @smallexample
14583 -> -stop
14584 <- (@value{GDBP})
14585 @end smallexample
14586
14587 @noindent
14588 and later:
14589
14590 @smallexample
14591 <- *stop,reason="stop",address="0x123",source="a.c:123"
14592 <- (@value{GDBP})
14593 @end smallexample
14594
14595 @subsubheading Simple CLI Command
14596
14597 Here's an example of a simple CLI command being passed through
14598 @sc{gdb/mi} and on to the CLI.
14599
14600 @smallexample
14601 -> print 1+2
14602 <- &"print 1+2\n"
14603 <- ~"$1 = 3\n"
14604 <- ^done
14605 <- (@value{GDBP})
14606 @end smallexample
14607
14608 @subsubheading Command With Side Effects
14609
14610 @smallexample
14611 -> -symbol-file xyz.exe
14612 <- *breakpoint,nr="3",address="0x123",source="a.c:123"
14613 <- (@value{GDBP})
14614 @end smallexample
14615
14616 @subsubheading A Bad Command
14617
14618 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
14619
14620 @smallexample
14621 -> -rubbish
14622 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
14623 <- (@value{GDBP})
14624 @end smallexample
14625
14626 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
14627 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
14628 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
14629
14630 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
14631 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
14632 To help users familiar with @value{GDBN}'s existing CLI interface, @sc{gdb/mi}
14633 accepts existing CLI commands. As specified by the syntax, such
14634 commands can be directly entered into the @sc{gdb/mi} interface and @value{GDBN} will
14635 respond.
14636
14637 This mechanism is provided as an aid to developers of @sc{gdb/mi}
14638 clients and not as a reliable interface into the CLI. Since the command
14639 is being interpreteted in an environment that assumes @sc{gdb/mi}
14640 behaviour, the exact output of such commands is likely to end up being
14641 an un-supported hybrid of @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI output.
14642
14643 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
14644 @node GDB/MI Output Records
14645 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
14646
14647 @menu
14648 * GDB/MI Result Records::
14649 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
14650 * GDB/MI Out-of-band Records::
14651 @end menu
14652
14653 @node GDB/MI Result Records
14654 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
14655
14656 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
14657 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
14658 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
14659 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
14660
14661 @table @code
14662 @findex ^done
14663 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
14664 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
14665 values.
14666
14667 @item "^running"
14668 @findex ^running
14669 @c Is this one correct? Should it be an out-of-band notification?
14670 The asynchronous operation was successfully started. The target is
14671 running.
14672
14673 @item "^error" "," @var{c-string}
14674 @findex ^error
14675 The operation failed. The @code{@var{c-string}} contains the corresponding
14676 error message.
14677 @end table
14678
14679 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
14680 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
14681
14682 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
14683 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
14684 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
14685 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
14686 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
14687
14688 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
14689 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
14690 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
14691 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
14692 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
14693
14694 @table @code
14695 @item "~" @var{string-output}
14696 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
14697 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
14698
14699 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
14700 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
14701 target.
14702
14703 @item "&" @var{string-output}
14704 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
14705 internals.
14706 @end table
14707
14708 @node GDB/MI Out-of-band Records
14709 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Out-of-band Records
14710
14711 @cindex out-of-band records in @sc{gdb/mi}
14712 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, out-of-band records
14713 @dfn{Out-of-band} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
14714 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
14715 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
14716 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
14717
14718 The following is a preliminary list of possible out-of-band records.
14719
14720 @table @code
14721 @item "*" "stop"
14722 @end table
14723
14724
14725 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
14726 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
14727 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
14728
14729 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
14730 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
14731
14732 Note the the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
14733 readability. They don't appear in the real output.
14734 Also note that the commands with a non-available example (N.A.@:) are
14735 not yet implemented.
14736
14737 @subheading Motivation
14738
14739 The motivation for this collection of commands.
14740
14741 @subheading Introduction
14742
14743 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
14744
14745 @subheading Commands
14746
14747 For each command in the block, the following is described:
14748
14749 @subsubheading Synopsis
14750
14751 @smallexample
14752 -command @var{args}@dots{}
14753 @end smallexample
14754
14755 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
14756
14757 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command.
14758
14759 @subsubheading Result
14760
14761 @subsubheading Out-of-band
14762
14763 @subsubheading Notes
14764
14765 @subsubheading Example
14766
14767
14768 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
14769 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Table Commands
14770 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint table commands
14771
14772 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
14773 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
14774 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
14775 breakpoints.
14776
14777 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
14778 @findex -break-after
14779
14780 @subsubheading Synopsis
14781
14782 @smallexample
14783 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
14784 @end smallexample
14785
14786 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
14787 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
14788 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
14789 @samp{-break-list} command below.
14790
14791 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
14792
14793 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
14794
14795 @subsubheading Example
14796
14797 @smallexample
14798 (@value{GDBP})
14799 -break-insert main
14800 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x000100d0",file="hello.c",line="5"@}
14801 (@value{GDBP})
14802 -break-after 1 3
14803 ~
14804 ^done
14805 (@value{GDBP})
14806 -break-list
14807 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
14808 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
14809 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
14810 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
14811 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
14812 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
14813 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
14814 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
14815 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0",
14816 ignore="3"@}]@}
14817 (@value{GDBP})
14818 @end smallexample
14819
14820 @ignore
14821 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
14822 @findex -break-catch
14823
14824 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
14825 @findex -break-commands
14826 @end ignore
14827
14828
14829 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
14830 @findex -break-condition
14831
14832 @subsubheading Synopsis
14833
14834 @smallexample
14835 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
14836 @end smallexample
14837
14838 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
14839 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
14840 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
14841 command below).
14842
14843 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
14844
14845 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
14846
14847 @subsubheading Example
14848
14849 @smallexample
14850 (@value{GDBP})
14851 -break-condition 1 1
14852 ^done
14853 (@value{GDBP})
14854 -break-list
14855 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
14856 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
14857 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
14858 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
14859 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
14860 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
14861 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
14862 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
14863 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",cond="1",
14864 times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
14865 (@value{GDBP})
14866 @end smallexample
14867
14868 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
14869 @findex -break-delete
14870
14871 @subsubheading Synopsis
14872
14873 @smallexample
14874 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
14875 @end smallexample
14876
14877 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
14878 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
14879
14880 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
14881
14882 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
14883
14884 @subsubheading Example
14885
14886 @smallexample
14887 (@value{GDBP})
14888 -break-delete 1
14889 ^done
14890 (@value{GDBP})
14891 -break-list
14892 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
14893 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
14894 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
14895 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
14896 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
14897 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
14898 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
14899 body=[]@}
14900 (@value{GDBP})
14901 @end smallexample
14902
14903 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
14904 @findex -break-disable
14905
14906 @subsubheading Synopsis
14907
14908 @smallexample
14909 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
14910 @end smallexample
14911
14912 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
14913 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
14914
14915 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
14916
14917 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
14918
14919 @subsubheading Example
14920
14921 @smallexample
14922 (@value{GDBP})
14923 -break-disable 2
14924 ^done
14925 (@value{GDBP})
14926 -break-list
14927 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
14928 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
14929 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
14930 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
14931 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
14932 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
14933 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
14934 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
14935 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}]@}
14936 (@value{GDBP})
14937 @end smallexample
14938
14939 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
14940 @findex -break-enable
14941
14942 @subsubheading Synopsis
14943
14944 @smallexample
14945 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
14946 @end smallexample
14947
14948 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
14949
14950 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
14951
14952 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
14953
14954 @subsubheading Example
14955
14956 @smallexample
14957 (@value{GDBP})
14958 -break-enable 2
14959 ^done
14960 (@value{GDBP})
14961 -break-list
14962 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
14963 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
14964 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
14965 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
14966 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
14967 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
14968 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
14969 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
14970 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@}]@}
14971 (@value{GDBP})
14972 @end smallexample
14973
14974 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
14975 @findex -break-info
14976
14977 @subsubheading Synopsis
14978
14979 @smallexample
14980 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
14981 @end smallexample
14982
14983 @c REDUNDANT???
14984 Get information about a single breakpoint.
14985
14986 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
14987
14988 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
14989
14990 @subsubheading Example
14991 N.A.
14992
14993 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
14994 @findex -break-insert
14995
14996 @subsubheading Synopsis
14997
14998 @smallexample
14999 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -r ]
15000 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
15001 [ -p @var{thread} ] [ @var{line} | @var{addr} ]
15002 @end smallexample
15003
15004 @noindent
15005 If specified, @var{line}, can be one of:
15006
15007 @itemize @bullet
15008 @item function
15009 @c @item +offset
15010 @c @item -offset
15011 @c @item linenum
15012 @item filename:linenum
15013 @item filename:function
15014 @item *address
15015 @end itemize
15016
15017 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
15018
15019 @table @samp
15020 @item -t
15021 Insert a tempoary breakpoint.
15022 @item -h
15023 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
15024 @item -c @var{condition}
15025 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
15026 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
15027 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
15028 @item -r
15029 Insert a regular breakpoint in all the functions whose names match the
15030 given regular expression. Other flags are not applicable to regular
15031 expresson.
15032 @end table
15033
15034 @subsubheading Result
15035
15036 The result is in the form:
15037
15038 @smallexample
15039 ^done,bkptno="@var{number}",func="@var{funcname}",
15040 file="@var{filename}",line="@var{lineno}"
15041 @end smallexample
15042
15043 @noindent
15044 where @var{number} is the @value{GDBN} number for this breakpoint, @var{funcname}
15045 is the name of the function where the breakpoint was inserted,
15046 @var{filename} is the name of the source file which contains this
15047 function, and @var{lineno} is the source line number within that file.
15048
15049 Note: this format is open to change.
15050 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
15051
15052 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15053
15054 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
15055 @samp{hbreak}, @samp{thbreak}, and @samp{rbreak}.
15056
15057 @subsubheading Example
15058
15059 @smallexample
15060 (@value{GDBP})
15061 -break-insert main
15062 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
15063 (@value{GDBP})
15064 -break-insert -t foo
15065 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",line="11"@}
15066 (@value{GDBP})
15067 -break-list
15068 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
15069 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
15070 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
15071 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
15072 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
15073 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
15074 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
15075 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
15076 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",line="4",times="0"@},
15077 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
15078 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",line="11",times="0"@}]@}
15079 (@value{GDBP})
15080 -break-insert -r foo.*
15081 ~int foo(int, int);
15082 ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",line="11"@}
15083 (@value{GDBP})
15084 @end smallexample
15085
15086 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
15087 @findex -break-list
15088
15089 @subsubheading Synopsis
15090
15091 @smallexample
15092 -break-list
15093 @end smallexample
15094
15095 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
15096
15097 @table @samp
15098 @item Number
15099 number of the breakpoint
15100 @item Type
15101 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
15102 @item Disposition
15103 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
15104 or @samp{nokeep}
15105 @item Enabled
15106 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
15107 @item Address
15108 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
15109 @item What
15110 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
15111 name, line number
15112 @item Times
15113 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
15114 @end table
15115
15116 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
15117 @code{body} field is an empty list.
15118
15119 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15120
15121 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
15122
15123 @subsubheading Example
15124
15125 @smallexample
15126 (@value{GDBP})
15127 -break-list
15128 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
15129 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
15130 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
15131 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
15132 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
15133 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
15134 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
15135 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
15136 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",times="0"@},
15137 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
15138 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",line="13",times="0"@}]@}
15139 (@value{GDBP})
15140 @end smallexample
15141
15142 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
15143
15144 @smallexample
15145 (@value{GDBP})
15146 -break-list
15147 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
15148 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
15149 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
15150 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
15151 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
15152 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
15153 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
15154 body=[]@}
15155 (@value{GDBP})
15156 @end smallexample
15157
15158 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
15159 @findex -break-watch
15160
15161 @subsubheading Synopsis
15162
15163 @smallexample
15164 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
15165 @end smallexample
15166
15167 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
15168 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e. a watchpoint that triggers either on a
15169 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
15170 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e. it will
15171 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
15172 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
15173 i.e. it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
15174 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting watchpoints}.
15175
15176 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
15177 breakpoints inserted.
15178
15179 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15180
15181 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
15182 @samp{rwatch}.
15183
15184 @subsubheading Example
15185
15186 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
15187
15188 @smallexample
15189 (@value{GDBP})
15190 -break-watch x
15191 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
15192 (@value{GDBP})
15193 -exec-continue
15194 ^running
15195 ^done,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
15196 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
15197 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",line="5"@}
15198 (@value{GDBP})
15199 @end smallexample
15200
15201 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
15202 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
15203 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
15204
15205 @smallexample
15206 (@value{GDBP})
15207 -break-watch C
15208 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
15209 (@value{GDBP})
15210 -exec-continue
15211 ^running
15212 ^done,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
15213 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
15214 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
15215 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
15216 (@value{GDBP})
15217 -exec-continue
15218 ^running
15219 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
15220 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
15221 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
15222 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
15223 (@value{GDBP})
15224 @end smallexample
15225
15226 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
15227 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
15228 deleted.
15229
15230 @smallexample
15231 (@value{GDBP})
15232 -break-watch C
15233 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
15234 (@value{GDBP})
15235 -break-list
15236 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
15237 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
15238 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
15239 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
15240 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
15241 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
15242 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
15243 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
15244 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
15245 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
15246 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
15247 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="0"@}]@}
15248 (@value{GDBP})
15249 -exec-continue
15250 ^running
15251 ^done,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
15252 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
15253 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
15254 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
15255 (@value{GDBP})
15256 -break-list
15257 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
15258 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
15259 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
15260 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
15261 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
15262 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
15263 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
15264 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
15265 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
15266 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@},
15267 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
15268 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",times="-5"@}]@}
15269 (@value{GDBP})
15270 -exec-continue
15271 ^running
15272 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
15273 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
15274 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
15275 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
15276 (@value{GDBP})
15277 -break-list
15278 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
15279 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
15280 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
15281 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
15282 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
15283 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
15284 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
15285 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
15286 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
15287 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",times="1"@}]@}
15288 (@value{GDBP})
15289 @end smallexample
15290
15291 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
15292 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
15293 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
15294
15295 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
15296 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
15297 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
15298 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
15299
15300 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
15301 @c @subheading -data-assign
15302 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
15303 @c @subsubheading GDB command
15304 @c set variable
15305 @c @subsubheading Example
15306 @c N.A.
15307
15308 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
15309 @findex -data-disassemble
15310
15311 @subsubheading Synopsis
15312
15313 @smallexample
15314 -data-disassemble
15315 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
15316 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
15317 -- @var{mode}
15318 @end smallexample
15319
15320 @noindent
15321 Where:
15322
15323 @table @samp
15324 @item @var{start-addr}
15325 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
15326 @item @var{end-addr}
15327 is the end address
15328 @item @var{filename}
15329 is the name of the file to disassemble
15330 @item @var{linenum}
15331 is the line number to disassemble around
15332 @item @var{lines}
15333 is the the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
15334 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
15335 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
15336 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
15337 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
15338 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
15339 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
15340 are displayed.
15341 @item @var{mode}
15342 is either 0 (meaning only disassembly) or 1 (meaning mixed source and
15343 disassembly).
15344 @end table
15345
15346 @subsubheading Result
15347
15348 The output for each instruction is composed of four fields:
15349
15350 @itemize @bullet
15351 @item Address
15352 @item Func-name
15353 @item Offset
15354 @item Instruction
15355 @end itemize
15356
15357 Note that whatever included in the instruction field, is not manipulated
15358 directely by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e. it is not possible to adjust its format.
15359
15360 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15361
15362 There's no direct mapping from this command to the CLI.
15363
15364 @subsubheading Example
15365
15366 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
15367
15368 @smallexample
15369 (@value{GDBP})
15370 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
15371 ^done,
15372 asm_insns=[
15373 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
15374 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
15375 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
15376 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
15377 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
15378 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
15379 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
15380 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
15381 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
15382 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
15383 (@value{GDBP})
15384 @end smallexample
15385
15386 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
15387 @code{main}.
15388
15389 @smallexample
15390 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
15391 ^done,asm_insns=[
15392 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
15393 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
15394 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
15395 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
15396 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
15397 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
15398 [@dots{}]
15399 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
15400 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
15401 (@value{GDBP})
15402 @end smallexample
15403
15404 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
15405
15406 @smallexample
15407 (@value{GDBP})
15408 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
15409 ^done,asm_insns=[
15410 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
15411 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
15412 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
15413 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
15414 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
15415 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
15416 (@value{GDBP})
15417 @end smallexample
15418
15419 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
15420
15421 @smallexample
15422 (@value{GDBP})
15423 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
15424 ^done,asm_insns=[
15425 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
15426 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
15427 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
15428 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
15429 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
15430 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
15431 file="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb/ \
15432 testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line_asm_insn=[
15433 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
15434 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
15435 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
15436 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
15437 (@value{GDBP})
15438 @end smallexample
15439
15440
15441 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
15442 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
15443
15444 @subsubheading Synopsis
15445
15446 @smallexample
15447 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
15448 @end smallexample
15449
15450 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
15451 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
15452 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
15453
15454 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15455
15456 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
15457 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
15458 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
15459
15460 @subsubheading Example
15461
15462 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
15463 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
15464 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
15465 output.
15466
15467 @smallexample
15468 211-data-evaluate-expression A
15469 211^done,value="1"
15470 (@value{GDBP})
15471 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
15472 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
15473 (@value{GDBP})
15474 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
15475 411^done,value="4"
15476 (@value{GDBP})
15477 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
15478 511^done,value="4"
15479 (@value{GDBP})
15480 @end smallexample
15481
15482
15483 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
15484 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
15485
15486 @subsubheading Synopsis
15487
15488 @smallexample
15489 -data-list-changed-registers
15490 @end smallexample
15491
15492 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
15493
15494 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15495
15496 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
15497 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
15498
15499 @subsubheading Example
15500
15501 On a PPC MBX board:
15502
15503 @smallexample
15504 (@value{GDBP})
15505 -exec-continue
15506 ^running
15507
15508 (@value{GDBP})
15509 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",frame=@{func="main",
15510 args=[],file="try.c",line="5"@}
15511 (@value{GDBP})
15512 -data-list-changed-registers
15513 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
15514 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
15515 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
15516 (@value{GDBP})
15517 @end smallexample
15518
15519
15520 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
15521 @findex -data-list-register-names
15522
15523 @subsubheading Synopsis
15524
15525 @smallexample
15526 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
15527 @end smallexample
15528
15529 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
15530 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
15531 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
15532 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
15533 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
15534 include empty register names.
15535
15536 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15537
15538 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
15539 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
15540 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
15541
15542 @subsubheading Example
15543
15544 For the PPC MBX board:
15545 @smallexample
15546 (@value{GDBP})
15547 -data-list-register-names
15548 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
15549 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
15550 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
15551 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
15552 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
15553 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
15554 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
15555 (@value{GDBP})
15556 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
15557 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
15558 (@value{GDBP})
15559 @end smallexample
15560
15561 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
15562 @findex -data-list-register-values
15563
15564 @subsubheading Synopsis
15565
15566 @smallexample
15567 -data-list-register-values @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
15568 @end smallexample
15569
15570 Display the registers' contents. @var{fmt} is the format according to
15571 which the registers' contents are to be returned, followed by an optional
15572 list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A missing list of
15573 numbers indicates that the contents of all the registers must be returned.
15574
15575 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
15576
15577 @table @code
15578 @item x
15579 Hexadecimal
15580 @item o
15581 Octal
15582 @item t
15583 Binary
15584 @item d
15585 Decimal
15586 @item r
15587 Raw
15588 @item N
15589 Natural
15590 @end table
15591
15592 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15593
15594 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
15595 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
15596
15597 @subsubheading Example
15598
15599 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
15600 don't appear in the actual output):
15601
15602 @smallexample
15603 (@value{GDBP})
15604 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
15605 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
15606 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
15607 (@value{GDBP})
15608 -data-list-register-values x
15609 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
15610 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
15611 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
15612 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
15613 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
15614 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
15615 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
15616 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
15617 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
15618 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
15619 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
15620 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
15621 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
15622 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
15623 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
15624 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
15625 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
15626 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
15627 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
15628 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
15629 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
15630 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
15631 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
15632 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
15633 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
15634 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
15635 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
15636 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
15637 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
15638 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
15639 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
15640 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
15641 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
15642 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
15643 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
15644 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
15645 (@value{GDBP})
15646 @end smallexample
15647
15648
15649 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
15650 @findex -data-read-memory
15651
15652 @subsubheading Synopsis
15653
15654 @smallexample
15655 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
15656 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
15657 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
15658 @end smallexample
15659
15660 @noindent
15661 where:
15662
15663 @table @samp
15664 @item @var{address}
15665 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
15666 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
15667 quoted using the C convention.
15668
15669 @item @var{word-format}
15670 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
15671 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
15672 ,Output formats}).
15673
15674 @item @var{word-size}
15675 The size of each memory word in bytes.
15676
15677 @item @var{nr-rows}
15678 The number of rows in the output table.
15679
15680 @item @var{nr-cols}
15681 The number of columns in the output table.
15682
15683 @item @var{aschar}
15684 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
15685 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
15686 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
15687 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
15688
15689 @item @var{byte-offset}
15690 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
15691 @end table
15692
15693 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
15694 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
15695 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
15696 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
15697 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
15698 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
15699 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
15700 @samp{addr}.
15701
15702 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
15703 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
15704 @samp{prev-page}.
15705
15706 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15707
15708 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
15709 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
15710
15711 @subsubheading Example
15712
15713 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
15714 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
15715 word. Display each word in hex.
15716
15717 @smallexample
15718 (@value{GDBP})
15719 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
15720 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
15721 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
15722 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
15723 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
15724 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
15725 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
15726 (@value{GDBP})
15727 @end smallexample
15728
15729 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
15730 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
15731
15732 @smallexample
15733 (@value{GDBP})
15734 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
15735 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
15736 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
15737 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
15738 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
15739 (@value{GDBP})
15740 @end smallexample
15741
15742 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
15743 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
15744 used as the non-printable character.
15745
15746 @smallexample
15747 (@value{GDBP})
15748 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
15749 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
15750 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
15751 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
15752 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
15753 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
15754 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
15755 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
15756 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
15757 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
15758 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
15759 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
15760 (@value{GDBP})
15761 @end smallexample
15762
15763 @subheading The @code{-display-delete} Command
15764 @findex -display-delete
15765
15766 @subsubheading Synopsis
15767
15768 @smallexample
15769 -display-delete @var{number}
15770 @end smallexample
15771
15772 Delete the display @var{number}.
15773
15774 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15775
15776 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete display}.
15777
15778 @subsubheading Example
15779 N.A.
15780
15781
15782 @subheading The @code{-display-disable} Command
15783 @findex -display-disable
15784
15785 @subsubheading Synopsis
15786
15787 @smallexample
15788 -display-disable @var{number}
15789 @end smallexample
15790
15791 Disable display @var{number}.
15792
15793 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15794
15795 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable display}.
15796
15797 @subsubheading Example
15798 N.A.
15799
15800
15801 @subheading The @code{-display-enable} Command
15802 @findex -display-enable
15803
15804 @subsubheading Synopsis
15805
15806 @smallexample
15807 -display-enable @var{number}
15808 @end smallexample
15809
15810 Enable display @var{number}.
15811
15812 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15813
15814 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable display}.
15815
15816 @subsubheading Example
15817 N.A.
15818
15819
15820 @subheading The @code{-display-insert} Command
15821 @findex -display-insert
15822
15823 @subsubheading Synopsis
15824
15825 @smallexample
15826 -display-insert @var{expression}
15827 @end smallexample
15828
15829 Display @var{expression} every time the program stops.
15830
15831 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15832
15833 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{display}.
15834
15835 @subsubheading Example
15836 N.A.
15837
15838
15839 @subheading The @code{-display-list} Command
15840 @findex -display-list
15841
15842 @subsubheading Synopsis
15843
15844 @smallexample
15845 -display-list
15846 @end smallexample
15847
15848 List the displays. Do not show the current values.
15849
15850 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15851
15852 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info display}.
15853
15854 @subsubheading Example
15855 N.A.
15856
15857
15858 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
15859 @findex -environment-cd
15860
15861 @subsubheading Synopsis
15862
15863 @smallexample
15864 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
15865 @end smallexample
15866
15867 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
15868
15869 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15870
15871 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
15872
15873 @subsubheading Example
15874
15875 @smallexample
15876 (@value{GDBP})
15877 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
15878 ^done
15879 (@value{GDBP})
15880 @end smallexample
15881
15882
15883 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
15884 @findex -environment-directory
15885
15886 @subsubheading Synopsis
15887
15888 @smallexample
15889 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
15890 @end smallexample
15891
15892 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
15893 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
15894 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
15895 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
15896 occurs as normal.
15897 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
15898 multiple directories in a single command
15899 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
15900 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
15901 If blanks are needed as
15902 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
15903 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
15904 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-seperator
15905 character must not be used
15906 in any directory name.
15907 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
15908
15909 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15910
15911 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
15912
15913 @subsubheading Example
15914
15915 @smallexample
15916 (@value{GDBP})
15917 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
15918 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
15919 (@value{GDBP})
15920 -environment-directory ""
15921 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
15922 (@value{GDBP})
15923 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
15924 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
15925 (@value{GDBP})
15926 -environment-directory -r
15927 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
15928 (@value{GDBP})
15929 @end smallexample
15930
15931
15932 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
15933 @findex -environment-path
15934
15935 @subsubheading Synopsis
15936
15937 @smallexample
15938 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
15939 @end smallexample
15940
15941 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
15942 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
15943 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
15944 supplied in addition to the
15945 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
15946 occurs as normal.
15947 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
15948 multiple directories in a single command
15949 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
15950 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
15951 If blanks are needed as
15952 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
15953 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
15954 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-seperator
15955 character must not be used
15956 in any directory name.
15957 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
15958
15959
15960 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
15961
15962 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
15963
15964 @subsubheading Example
15965
15966 @smallexample
15967 (@value{GDBP})
15968 -environment-path
15969 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
15970 (@value{GDBP})
15971 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
15972 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
15973 (@value{GDBP})
15974 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
15975 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
15976 (@value{GDBP})
15977 @end smallexample
15978
15979
15980 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
15981 @findex -environment-pwd
15982
15983 @subsubheading Synopsis
15984
15985 @smallexample
15986 -environment-pwd
15987 @end smallexample
15988
15989 Show the current working directory.
15990
15991 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
15992
15993 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
15994
15995 @subsubheading Example
15996
15997 @smallexample
15998 (@value{GDBP})
15999 -environment-pwd
16000 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
16001 (@value{GDBP})
16002 @end smallexample
16003
16004 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
16005 @node GDB/MI Program Control
16006 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program control
16007
16008 @subsubheading Program termination
16009
16010 As a result of execution, the inferior program can run to completion, if
16011 it doesn't encounter any breakpoints. In this case the output will
16012 include an exit code, if the program has exited exceptionally.
16013
16014 @subsubheading Examples
16015
16016 @noindent
16017 Program exited normally:
16018
16019 @smallexample
16020 (@value{GDBP})
16021 -exec-run
16022 ^running
16023 (@value{GDBP})
16024 x = 55
16025 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
16026 (@value{GDBP})
16027 @end smallexample
16028
16029 @noindent
16030 Program exited exceptionally:
16031
16032 @smallexample
16033 (@value{GDBP})
16034 -exec-run
16035 ^running
16036 (@value{GDBP})
16037 x = 55
16038 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
16039 (@value{GDBP})
16040 @end smallexample
16041
16042 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
16043 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
16044
16045 @smallexample
16046 (@value{GDBP})
16047 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
16048 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
16049 @end smallexample
16050
16051
16052 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
16053 @findex -exec-abort
16054
16055 @subsubheading Synopsis
16056
16057 @smallexample
16058 -exec-abort
16059 @end smallexample
16060
16061 Kill the inferior running program.
16062
16063 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16064
16065 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
16066
16067 @subsubheading Example
16068 N.A.
16069
16070
16071 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
16072 @findex -exec-arguments
16073
16074 @subsubheading Synopsis
16075
16076 @smallexample
16077 -exec-arguments @var{args}
16078 @end smallexample
16079
16080 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
16081 @samp{-exec-run}.
16082
16083 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16084
16085 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
16086
16087 @subsubheading Example
16088
16089 @c FIXME!
16090 Don't have one around.
16091
16092
16093 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
16094 @findex -exec-continue
16095
16096 @subsubheading Synopsis
16097
16098 @smallexample
16099 -exec-continue
16100 @end smallexample
16101
16102 Asynchronous command. Resumes the execution of the inferior program
16103 until a breakpoint is encountered, or until the inferior exits.
16104
16105 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16106
16107 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
16108
16109 @subsubheading Example
16110
16111 @smallexample
16112 -exec-continue
16113 ^running
16114 (@value{GDBP})
16115 @@Hello world
16116 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="2",frame=@{func="foo",args=[],
16117 file="hello.c",line="13"@}
16118 (@value{GDBP})
16119 @end smallexample
16120
16121
16122 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
16123 @findex -exec-finish
16124
16125 @subsubheading Synopsis
16126
16127 @smallexample
16128 -exec-finish
16129 @end smallexample
16130
16131 Asynchronous command. Resumes the execution of the inferior program
16132 until the current function is exited. Displays the results returned by
16133 the function.
16134
16135 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16136
16137 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
16138
16139 @subsubheading Example
16140
16141 Function returning @code{void}.
16142
16143 @smallexample
16144 -exec-finish
16145 ^running
16146 (@value{GDBP})
16147 @@hello from foo
16148 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
16149 file="hello.c",line="7"@}
16150 (@value{GDBP})
16151 @end smallexample
16152
16153 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
16154 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
16155 value itself.
16156
16157 @smallexample
16158 -exec-finish
16159 ^running
16160 (@value{GDBP})
16161 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
16162 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
16163 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
16164 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
16165 (@value{GDBP})
16166 @end smallexample
16167
16168
16169 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
16170 @findex -exec-interrupt
16171
16172 @subsubheading Synopsis
16173
16174 @smallexample
16175 -exec-interrupt
16176 @end smallexample
16177
16178 Asynchronous command. Interrupts the background execution of the target.
16179 Note how the token associated with the stop message is the one for the
16180 execution command that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt
16181 itself only appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
16182 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
16183
16184 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16185
16186 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
16187
16188 @subsubheading Example
16189
16190 @smallexample
16191 (@value{GDBP})
16192 111-exec-continue
16193 111^running
16194
16195 (@value{GDBP})
16196 222-exec-interrupt
16197 222^done
16198 (@value{GDBP})
16199 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
16200 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",line="13"@}
16201 (@value{GDBP})
16202
16203 (@value{GDBP})
16204 -exec-interrupt
16205 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
16206 (@value{GDBP})
16207 @end smallexample
16208
16209
16210 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
16211 @findex -exec-next
16212
16213 @subsubheading Synopsis
16214
16215 @smallexample
16216 -exec-next
16217 @end smallexample
16218
16219 Asynchronous command. Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping
16220 when the beginning of the next source line is reached.
16221
16222 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16223
16224 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
16225
16226 @subsubheading Example
16227
16228 @smallexample
16229 -exec-next
16230 ^running
16231 (@value{GDBP})
16232 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
16233 (@value{GDBP})
16234 @end smallexample
16235
16236
16237 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
16238 @findex -exec-next-instruction
16239
16240 @subsubheading Synopsis
16241
16242 @smallexample
16243 -exec-next-instruction
16244 @end smallexample
16245
16246 Asynchronous command. Executes one machine instruction. If the
16247 instruction is a function call continues until the function returns. If
16248 the program stops at an instruction in the middle of a source line, the
16249 address will be printed as well.
16250
16251 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16252
16253 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
16254
16255 @subsubheading Example
16256
16257 @smallexample
16258 (@value{GDBP})
16259 -exec-next-instruction
16260 ^running
16261
16262 (@value{GDBP})
16263 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
16264 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
16265 (@value{GDBP})
16266 @end smallexample
16267
16268
16269 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
16270 @findex -exec-return
16271
16272 @subsubheading Synopsis
16273
16274 @smallexample
16275 -exec-return
16276 @end smallexample
16277
16278 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
16279 Displays the new current frame.
16280
16281 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16282
16283 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
16284
16285 @subsubheading Example
16286
16287 @smallexample
16288 (@value{GDBP})
16289 200-break-insert callee4
16290 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
16291 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
16292 (@value{GDBP})
16293 000-exec-run
16294 000^running
16295 (@value{GDBP})
16296 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
16297 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
16298 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
16299 (@value{GDBP})
16300 205-break-delete
16301 205^done
16302 (@value{GDBP})
16303 111-exec-return
16304 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
16305 args=[@{name="strarg",
16306 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
16307 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
16308 (@value{GDBP})
16309 @end smallexample
16310
16311
16312 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
16313 @findex -exec-run
16314
16315 @subsubheading Synopsis
16316
16317 @smallexample
16318 -exec-run
16319 @end smallexample
16320
16321 Asynchronous command. Starts execution of the inferior from the
16322 beginning. The inferior executes until either a breakpoint is
16323 encountered or the program exits.
16324
16325 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16326
16327 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
16328
16329 @subsubheading Example
16330
16331 @smallexample
16332 (@value{GDBP})
16333 -break-insert main
16334 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
16335 (@value{GDBP})
16336 -exec-run
16337 ^running
16338 (@value{GDBP})
16339 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",bkptno="1",
16340 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
16341 (@value{GDBP})
16342 @end smallexample
16343
16344
16345 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
16346 @findex -exec-show-arguments
16347
16348 @subsubheading Synopsis
16349
16350 @smallexample
16351 -exec-show-arguments
16352 @end smallexample
16353
16354 Print the arguments of the program.
16355
16356 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16357
16358 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
16359
16360 @subsubheading Example
16361 N.A.
16362
16363 @c @subheading -exec-signal
16364
16365 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
16366 @findex -exec-step
16367
16368 @subsubheading Synopsis
16369
16370 @smallexample
16371 -exec-step
16372 @end smallexample
16373
16374 Asynchronous command. Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping
16375 when the beginning of the next source line is reached, if the next
16376 source line is not a function call. If it is, stop at the first
16377 instruction of the called function.
16378
16379 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16380
16381 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
16382
16383 @subsubheading Example
16384
16385 Stepping into a function:
16386
16387 @smallexample
16388 -exec-step
16389 ^running
16390 (@value{GDBP})
16391 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
16392 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
16393 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",line="11"@}
16394 (@value{GDBP})
16395 @end smallexample
16396
16397 Regular stepping:
16398
16399 @smallexample
16400 -exec-step
16401 ^running
16402 (@value{GDBP})
16403 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
16404 (@value{GDBP})
16405 @end smallexample
16406
16407
16408 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
16409 @findex -exec-step-instruction
16410
16411 @subsubheading Synopsis
16412
16413 @smallexample
16414 -exec-step-instruction
16415 @end smallexample
16416
16417 Asynchronous command. Resumes the inferior which executes one machine
16418 instruction. The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
16419 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
16420 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed as
16421 well.
16422
16423 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16424
16425 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
16426
16427 @subsubheading Example
16428
16429 @smallexample
16430 (@value{GDBP})
16431 -exec-step-instruction
16432 ^running
16433
16434 (@value{GDBP})
16435 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
16436 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",line="10"@}
16437 (@value{GDBP})
16438 -exec-step-instruction
16439 ^running
16440
16441 (@value{GDBP})
16442 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
16443 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",line="10"@}
16444 (@value{GDBP})
16445 @end smallexample
16446
16447
16448 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
16449 @findex -exec-until
16450
16451 @subsubheading Synopsis
16452
16453 @smallexample
16454 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
16455 @end smallexample
16456
16457 Asynchronous command. Executes the inferior until the @var{location}
16458 specified in the argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior
16459 executes until a source line greater than the current one is reached.
16460 The reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
16461
16462 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16463
16464 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
16465
16466 @subsubheading Example
16467
16468 @smallexample
16469 (@value{GDBP})
16470 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
16471 ^running
16472 (@value{GDBP})
16473 x = 55
16474 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
16475 file="recursive2.c",line="6"@}
16476 (@value{GDBP})
16477 @end smallexample
16478
16479 @ignore
16480 @subheading -file-clear
16481 Is this going away????
16482 @end ignore
16483
16484
16485 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
16486 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
16487
16488 @subsubheading Synopsis
16489
16490 @smallexample
16491 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
16492 @end smallexample
16493
16494 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
16495 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
16496 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
16497 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
16498 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
16499 notification.
16500
16501 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16502
16503 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
16504
16505 @subsubheading Example
16506
16507 @smallexample
16508 (@value{GDBP})
16509 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
16510 ^done
16511 (@value{GDBP})
16512 @end smallexample
16513
16514
16515 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
16516 @findex -file-exec-file
16517
16518 @subsubheading Synopsis
16519
16520 @smallexample
16521 -file-exec-file @var{file}
16522 @end smallexample
16523
16524 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
16525 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
16526 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
16527 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
16528 notification.
16529
16530 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16531
16532 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
16533
16534 @subsubheading Example
16535
16536 @smallexample
16537 (@value{GDBP})
16538 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
16539 ^done
16540 (@value{GDBP})
16541 @end smallexample
16542
16543
16544 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
16545 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
16546
16547 @subsubheading Synopsis
16548
16549 @smallexample
16550 -file-list-exec-sections
16551 @end smallexample
16552
16553 List the sections of the current executable file.
16554
16555 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16556
16557 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
16558 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
16559 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
16560
16561 @subsubheading Example
16562 N.A.
16563
16564
16565 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
16566 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
16567
16568 @subsubheading Synopsis
16569
16570 @smallexample
16571 -file-list-exec-source-file
16572 @end smallexample
16573
16574 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
16575 to the current source file for the current executable.
16576
16577 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16578
16579 There's no @value{GDBN} command which directly corresponds to this one.
16580
16581 @subsubheading Example
16582
16583 @smallexample
16584 (@value{GDBP})
16585 123-file-list-exec-source-file
16586 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c"
16587 (@value{GDBP})
16588 @end smallexample
16589
16590
16591 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
16592 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
16593
16594 @subsubheading Synopsis
16595
16596 @smallexample
16597 -file-list-exec-source-files
16598 @end smallexample
16599
16600 List the source files for the current executable.
16601
16602 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16603
16604 There's no @value{GDBN} command which directly corresponds to this one.
16605 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
16606
16607 @subsubheading Example
16608 N.A.
16609
16610
16611 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
16612 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
16613
16614 @subsubheading Synopsis
16615
16616 @smallexample
16617 -file-list-shared-libraries
16618 @end smallexample
16619
16620 List the shared libraries in the program.
16621
16622 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16623
16624 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}.
16625
16626 @subsubheading Example
16627 N.A.
16628
16629
16630 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
16631 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
16632
16633 @subsubheading Synopsis
16634
16635 @smallexample
16636 -file-list-symbol-files
16637 @end smallexample
16638
16639 List symbol files.
16640
16641 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16642
16643 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
16644
16645 @subsubheading Example
16646 N.A.
16647
16648
16649 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
16650 @findex -file-symbol-file
16651
16652 @subsubheading Synopsis
16653
16654 @smallexample
16655 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
16656 @end smallexample
16657
16658 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
16659 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
16660 produced, except for a completion notification.
16661
16662 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16663
16664 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
16665
16666 @subsubheading Example
16667
16668 @smallexample
16669 (@value{GDBP})
16670 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
16671 ^done
16672 (@value{GDBP})
16673 @end smallexample
16674
16675 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
16676 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
16677 @section Miscellaneous @value{GDBN} commands in @sc{gdb/mi}
16678
16679 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
16680
16681 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
16682 @findex -gdb-exit
16683
16684 @subsubheading Synopsis
16685
16686 @smallexample
16687 -gdb-exit
16688 @end smallexample
16689
16690 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
16691
16692 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16693
16694 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
16695
16696 @subsubheading Example
16697
16698 @smallexample
16699 (@value{GDBP})
16700 -gdb-exit
16701 @end smallexample
16702
16703 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
16704 @findex -gdb-set
16705
16706 @subsubheading Synopsis
16707
16708 @smallexample
16709 -gdb-set
16710 @end smallexample
16711
16712 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
16713 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
16714
16715 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16716
16717 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
16718
16719 @subsubheading Example
16720
16721 @smallexample
16722 (@value{GDBP})
16723 -gdb-set $foo=3
16724 ^done
16725 (@value{GDBP})
16726 @end smallexample
16727
16728
16729 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
16730 @findex -gdb-show
16731
16732 @subsubheading Synopsis
16733
16734 @smallexample
16735 -gdb-show
16736 @end smallexample
16737
16738 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
16739
16740 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
16741
16742 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
16743
16744 @subsubheading Example
16745
16746 @smallexample
16747 (@value{GDBP})
16748 -gdb-show annotate
16749 ^done,value="0"
16750 (@value{GDBP})
16751 @end smallexample
16752
16753 @c @subheading -gdb-source
16754
16755
16756 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
16757 @findex -gdb-version
16758
16759 @subsubheading Synopsis
16760
16761 @smallexample
16762 -gdb-version
16763 @end smallexample
16764
16765 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
16766
16767 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16768
16769 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @value{GDBN} by default shows this
16770 information when you start an interactive session.
16771
16772 @subsubheading Example
16773
16774 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
16775 @c box in TeX.
16776 @smallexample
16777 (@value{GDBP})
16778 -gdb-version
16779 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
16780 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
16781 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
16782 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
16783 ~ certain conditions.
16784 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
16785 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
16786 ~ details.
16787 ~This GDB was configured as
16788 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
16789 ^done
16790 (@value{GDBP})
16791 @end smallexample
16792
16793 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
16794 @findex -interpreter-exec
16795
16796 @subheading Synopsis
16797
16798 @smallexample
16799 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
16800 @end smallexample
16801
16802 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
16803
16804 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
16805
16806 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
16807
16808 @subheading Example
16809
16810 @smallexample
16811 (@value{GDBP})
16812 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
16813 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
16814 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
16815 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
16816 ^done
16817 (@value{GDBP})
16818 @end smallexample
16819
16820 @ignore
16821 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
16822 @node GDB/MI Kod Commands
16823 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Kod Commands
16824
16825 The Kod commands are not implemented.
16826
16827 @c @subheading -kod-info
16828
16829 @c @subheading -kod-list
16830
16831 @c @subheading -kod-list-object-types
16832
16833 @c @subheading -kod-show
16834
16835 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
16836 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
16837 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
16838
16839 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
16840
16841 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
16842
16843 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
16844
16845 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
16846
16847 @c @subheading -overlay-map
16848
16849 @c @subheading -overlay-off
16850
16851 @c @subheading -overlay-on
16852
16853 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
16854
16855 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
16856 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
16857 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
16858
16859 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
16860
16861 @c @subheading -signal-handle
16862
16863 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
16864
16865 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
16866 @end ignore
16867
16868
16869 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
16870 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
16871 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
16872
16873
16874 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
16875 @findex -stack-info-frame
16876
16877 @subsubheading Synopsis
16878
16879 @smallexample
16880 -stack-info-frame
16881 @end smallexample
16882
16883 Get info on the current frame.
16884
16885 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16886
16887 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
16888 (without arguments).
16889
16890 @subsubheading Example
16891 N.A.
16892
16893 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
16894 @findex -stack-info-depth
16895
16896 @subsubheading Synopsis
16897
16898 @smallexample
16899 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
16900 @end smallexample
16901
16902 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
16903 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
16904
16905 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16906
16907 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
16908
16909 @subsubheading Example
16910
16911 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
16912
16913 @smallexample
16914 (@value{GDBP})
16915 -stack-info-depth
16916 ^done,depth="12"
16917 (@value{GDBP})
16918 -stack-info-depth 4
16919 ^done,depth="4"
16920 (@value{GDBP})
16921 -stack-info-depth 12
16922 ^done,depth="12"
16923 (@value{GDBP})
16924 -stack-info-depth 11
16925 ^done,depth="11"
16926 (@value{GDBP})
16927 -stack-info-depth 13
16928 ^done,depth="12"
16929 (@value{GDBP})
16930 @end smallexample
16931
16932 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
16933 @findex -stack-list-arguments
16934
16935 @subsubheading Synopsis
16936
16937 @smallexample
16938 -stack-list-arguments @var{show-values}
16939 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
16940 @end smallexample
16941
16942 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
16943 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
16944 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole call
16945 stack.
16946
16947 The @var{show-values} argument must have a value of 0 or 1. A value of
16948 0 means that only the names of the arguments are listed, a value of 1
16949 means that both names and values of the arguments are printed.
16950
16951 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
16952
16953 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
16954 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
16955 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
16956
16957 @subsubheading Example
16958
16959 @smallexample
16960 (@value{GDBP})
16961 -stack-list-frames
16962 ^done,
16963 stack=[
16964 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
16965 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
16966 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
16967 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
16968 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
16969 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
16970 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
16971 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
16972 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
16973 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
16974 (@value{GDBP})
16975 -stack-list-arguments 0
16976 ^done,
16977 stack-args=[
16978 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
16979 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
16980 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
16981 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
16982 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
16983 (@value{GDBP})
16984 -stack-list-arguments 1
16985 ^done,
16986 stack-args=[
16987 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
16988 frame=@{level="1",
16989 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
16990 frame=@{level="2",args=[
16991 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
16992 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
16993 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
16994 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
16995 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
16996 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
16997 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
16998 (@value{GDBP})
16999 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
17000 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
17001 (@value{GDBP})
17002 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
17003 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
17004 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
17005 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
17006 (@value{GDBP})
17007 @end smallexample
17008
17009 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
17010
17011
17012 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
17013 @findex -stack-list-frames
17014
17015 @subsubheading Synopsis
17016
17017 @smallexample
17018 -stack-list-frames [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
17019 @end smallexample
17020
17021 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
17022 following info:
17023
17024 @table @samp
17025 @item @var{level}
17026 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e. the innermost function.
17027 @item @var{addr}
17028 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
17029 @item @var{func}
17030 Function name.
17031 @item @var{file}
17032 File name of the source file where the function lives.
17033 @item @var{line}
17034 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
17035 @end table
17036
17037 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
17038 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
17039 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
17040 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level.
17041
17042 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17043
17044 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
17045
17046 @subsubheading Example
17047
17048 Full stack backtrace:
17049
17050 @smallexample
17051 (@value{GDBP})
17052 -stack-list-frames
17053 ^done,stack=
17054 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
17055 file="recursive2.c",line="11"@},
17056 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17057 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17058 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17059 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17060 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17061 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17062 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17063 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17064 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17065 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17066 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17067 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17068 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17069 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17070 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17071 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17072 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17073 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17074 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17075 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17076 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
17077 file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
17078 (@value{GDBP})
17079 @end smallexample
17080
17081 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
17082
17083 @smallexample
17084 (@value{GDBP})
17085 -stack-list-frames 3 5
17086 ^done,stack=
17087 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17088 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17089 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17090 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@},
17091 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17092 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
17093 (@value{GDBP})
17094 @end smallexample
17095
17096 Show a single frame:
17097
17098 @smallexample
17099 (@value{GDBP})
17100 -stack-list-frames 3 3
17101 ^done,stack=
17102 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
17103 file="recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
17104 (@value{GDBP})
17105 @end smallexample
17106
17107
17108 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
17109 @findex -stack-list-locals
17110
17111 @subsubheading Synopsis
17112
17113 @smallexample
17114 -stack-list-locals @var{print-values}
17115 @end smallexample
17116
17117 Display the local variable names for the current frame. With an
17118 argument of 0 prints only the names of the variables, with argument of 1
17119 prints also their values.
17120
17121 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17122
17123 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
17124
17125 @subsubheading Example
17126
17127 @smallexample
17128 (@value{GDBP})
17129 -stack-list-locals 0
17130 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
17131 (@value{GDBP})
17132 -stack-list-locals 1
17133 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
17134 @{name="C",value="3"@}]
17135 (@value{GDBP})
17136 @end smallexample
17137
17138
17139 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
17140 @findex -stack-select-frame
17141
17142 @subsubheading Synopsis
17143
17144 @smallexample
17145 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
17146 @end smallexample
17147
17148 Change the current frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
17149 the stack.
17150
17151 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17152
17153 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
17154 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
17155
17156 @subsubheading Example
17157
17158 @smallexample
17159 (@value{GDBP})
17160 -stack-select-frame 2
17161 ^done
17162 (@value{GDBP})
17163 @end smallexample
17164
17165 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17166 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
17167 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
17168
17169
17170 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
17171 @findex -symbol-info-address
17172
17173 @subsubheading Synopsis
17174
17175 @smallexample
17176 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
17177 @end smallexample
17178
17179 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
17180
17181 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17182
17183 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
17184
17185 @subsubheading Example
17186 N.A.
17187
17188
17189 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
17190 @findex -symbol-info-file
17191
17192 @subsubheading Synopsis
17193
17194 @smallexample
17195 -symbol-info-file
17196 @end smallexample
17197
17198 Show the file for the symbol.
17199
17200 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17201
17202 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
17203 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
17204
17205 @subsubheading Example
17206 N.A.
17207
17208
17209 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
17210 @findex -symbol-info-function
17211
17212 @subsubheading Synopsis
17213
17214 @smallexample
17215 -symbol-info-function
17216 @end smallexample
17217
17218 Show which function the symbol lives in.
17219
17220 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17221
17222 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
17223
17224 @subsubheading Example
17225 N.A.
17226
17227
17228 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
17229 @findex -symbol-info-line
17230
17231 @subsubheading Synopsis
17232
17233 @smallexample
17234 -symbol-info-line
17235 @end smallexample
17236
17237 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
17238
17239 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17240
17241 The corresponding @value{GDBN} comamnd is @samp{info line}.
17242 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
17243
17244 @subsubheading Example
17245 N.A.
17246
17247
17248 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
17249 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
17250
17251 @subsubheading Synopsis
17252
17253 @smallexample
17254 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
17255 @end smallexample
17256
17257 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
17258
17259 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17260
17261 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
17262
17263 @subsubheading Example
17264 N.A.
17265
17266
17267 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
17268 @findex -symbol-list-functions
17269
17270 @subsubheading Synopsis
17271
17272 @smallexample
17273 -symbol-list-functions
17274 @end smallexample
17275
17276 List the functions in the executable.
17277
17278 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17279
17280 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
17281 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
17282
17283 @subsubheading Example
17284 N.A.
17285
17286
17287 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
17288 @findex -symbol-list-lines
17289
17290 @subsubheading Synopsis
17291
17292 @smallexample
17293 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
17294 @end smallexample
17295
17296 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
17297 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
17298 ascending PC order.
17299
17300 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17301
17302 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
17303
17304 @subsubheading Example
17305 @smallexample
17306 (@value{GDBP})
17307 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
17308 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
17309 (@value{GDBP})
17310 @end smallexample
17311
17312
17313 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
17314 @findex -symbol-list-types
17315
17316 @subsubheading Synopsis
17317
17318 @smallexample
17319 -symbol-list-types
17320 @end smallexample
17321
17322 List all the type names.
17323
17324 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17325
17326 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
17327 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
17328
17329 @subsubheading Example
17330 N.A.
17331
17332
17333 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
17334 @findex -symbol-list-variables
17335
17336 @subsubheading Synopsis
17337
17338 @smallexample
17339 -symbol-list-variables
17340 @end smallexample
17341
17342 List all the global and static variable names.
17343
17344 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17345
17346 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
17347
17348 @subsubheading Example
17349 N.A.
17350
17351
17352 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
17353 @findex -symbol-locate
17354
17355 @subsubheading Synopsis
17356
17357 @smallexample
17358 -symbol-locate
17359 @end smallexample
17360
17361 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17362
17363 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
17364
17365 @subsubheading Example
17366 N.A.
17367
17368
17369 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
17370 @findex -symbol-type
17371
17372 @subsubheading Synopsis
17373
17374 @smallexample
17375 -symbol-type @var{variable}
17376 @end smallexample
17377
17378 Show type of @var{variable}.
17379
17380 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17381
17382 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
17383 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
17384
17385 @subsubheading Example
17386 N.A.
17387
17388
17389 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17390 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
17391 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
17392
17393
17394 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
17395 @findex -target-attach
17396
17397 @subsubheading Synopsis
17398
17399 @smallexample
17400 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{file}
17401 @end smallexample
17402
17403 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of @value{GDBN}.
17404
17405 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
17406
17407 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
17408
17409 @subsubheading Example
17410 N.A.
17411
17412
17413 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
17414 @findex -target-compare-sections
17415
17416 @subsubheading Synopsis
17417
17418 @smallexample
17419 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
17420 @end smallexample
17421
17422 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
17423 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
17424
17425 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17426
17427 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
17428
17429 @subsubheading Example
17430 N.A.
17431
17432
17433 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
17434 @findex -target-detach
17435
17436 @subsubheading Synopsis
17437
17438 @smallexample
17439 -target-detach
17440 @end smallexample
17441
17442 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output.
17443
17444 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
17445
17446 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
17447
17448 @subsubheading Example
17449
17450 @smallexample
17451 (@value{GDBP})
17452 -target-detach
17453 ^done
17454 (@value{GDBP})
17455 @end smallexample
17456
17457
17458 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
17459 @findex -target-disconnect
17460
17461 @subsubheading Synopsis
17462
17463 @example
17464 -target-disconnect
17465 @end example
17466
17467 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output.
17468
17469 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
17470
17471 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
17472
17473 @subsubheading Example
17474
17475 @smallexample
17476 (@value{GDBP})
17477 -target-disconnect
17478 ^done
17479 (@value{GDBP})
17480 @end smallexample
17481
17482
17483 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
17484 @findex -target-download
17485
17486 @subsubheading Synopsis
17487
17488 @smallexample
17489 -target-download
17490 @end smallexample
17491
17492 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
17493 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
17494
17495 @table @samp
17496 @item section
17497 The name of the section.
17498 @item section-sent
17499 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
17500 @item section-size
17501 The size of the section.
17502 @item total-sent
17503 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
17504 @item total-size
17505 The size of the overall executable to download.
17506 @end table
17507
17508 @noindent
17509 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
17510 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
17511
17512 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
17513 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
17514
17515 @table @samp
17516 @item section
17517 The name of the section.
17518 @item section-size
17519 The size of the section.
17520 @item total-size
17521 The size of the overall executable to download.
17522 @end table
17523
17524 @noindent
17525 At the end, a summary is printed.
17526
17527 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17528
17529 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
17530
17531 @subsubheading Example
17532
17533 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
17534 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
17535
17536 @smallexample
17537 (@value{GDBP})
17538 -target-download
17539 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
17540 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
17541 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
17542 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
17543 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
17544 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
17545 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
17546 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
17547 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
17548 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
17549 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
17550 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
17551 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
17552 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
17553 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
17554 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
17555 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
17556 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
17557 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
17558 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
17559 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
17560 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
17561 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
17562 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
17563 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
17564 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
17565 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
17566 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
17567 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
17568 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
17569 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
17570 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
17571 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
17572 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
17573 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
17574 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
17575 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
17576 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
17577 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
17578 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
17579 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
17580 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
17581 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
17582 write-rate="429"
17583 (@value{GDBP})
17584 @end smallexample
17585
17586
17587 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
17588 @findex -target-exec-status
17589
17590 @subsubheading Synopsis
17591
17592 @smallexample
17593 -target-exec-status
17594 @end smallexample
17595
17596 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
17597 not, for instance).
17598
17599 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17600
17601 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
17602
17603 @subsubheading Example
17604 N.A.
17605
17606
17607 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
17608 @findex -target-list-available-targets
17609
17610 @subsubheading Synopsis
17611
17612 @smallexample
17613 -target-list-available-targets
17614 @end smallexample
17615
17616 List the possible targets to connect to.
17617
17618 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17619
17620 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
17621
17622 @subsubheading Example
17623 N.A.
17624
17625
17626 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
17627 @findex -target-list-current-targets
17628
17629 @subsubheading Synopsis
17630
17631 @smallexample
17632 -target-list-current-targets
17633 @end smallexample
17634
17635 Describe the current target.
17636
17637 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17638
17639 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
17640 other things).
17641
17642 @subsubheading Example
17643 N.A.
17644
17645
17646 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
17647 @findex -target-list-parameters
17648
17649 @subsubheading Synopsis
17650
17651 @smallexample
17652 -target-list-parameters
17653 @end smallexample
17654
17655 @c ????
17656
17657 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17658
17659 No equivalent.
17660
17661 @subsubheading Example
17662 N.A.
17663
17664
17665 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
17666 @findex -target-select
17667
17668 @subsubheading Synopsis
17669
17670 @smallexample
17671 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
17672 @end smallexample
17673
17674 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
17675
17676 @table @samp
17677 @item @var{type}
17678 The type of target, for instance @samp{async}, @samp{remote}, etc.
17679 @item @var{parameters}
17680 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
17681 Commands for managing targets}, for more details.
17682 @end table
17683
17684 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
17685 which the target program is, in the following form:
17686
17687 @smallexample
17688 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
17689 args=[@var{arg list}]
17690 @end smallexample
17691
17692 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17693
17694 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
17695
17696 @subsubheading Example
17697
17698 @smallexample
17699 (@value{GDBP})
17700 -target-select async /dev/ttya
17701 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
17702 (@value{GDBP})
17703 @end smallexample
17704
17705 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17706 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
17707 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
17708
17709
17710 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
17711 @findex -thread-info
17712
17713 @subsubheading Synopsis
17714
17715 @smallexample
17716 -thread-info
17717 @end smallexample
17718
17719 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} command
17720
17721 No equivalent.
17722
17723 @subsubheading Example
17724 N.A.
17725
17726
17727 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-all-threads} Command
17728 @findex -thread-list-all-threads
17729
17730 @subsubheading Synopsis
17731
17732 @smallexample
17733 -thread-list-all-threads
17734 @end smallexample
17735
17736 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17737
17738 The equivalent @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info threads}.
17739
17740 @subsubheading Example
17741 N.A.
17742
17743
17744 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
17745 @findex -thread-list-ids
17746
17747 @subsubheading Synopsis
17748
17749 @smallexample
17750 -thread-list-ids
17751 @end smallexample
17752
17753 Produces a list of the currently known @value{GDBN} thread ids. At the
17754 end of the list it also prints the total number of such threads.
17755
17756 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17757
17758 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
17759
17760 @subsubheading Example
17761
17762 No threads present, besides the main process:
17763
17764 @smallexample
17765 (@value{GDBP})
17766 -thread-list-ids
17767 ^done,thread-ids=@{@},number-of-threads="0"
17768 (@value{GDBP})
17769 @end smallexample
17770
17771
17772 Several threads:
17773
17774 @smallexample
17775 (@value{GDBP})
17776 -thread-list-ids
17777 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
17778 number-of-threads="3"
17779 (@value{GDBP})
17780 @end smallexample
17781
17782
17783 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
17784 @findex -thread-select
17785
17786 @subsubheading Synopsis
17787
17788 @smallexample
17789 -thread-select @var{threadnum}
17790 @end smallexample
17791
17792 Make @var{threadnum} the current thread. It prints the number of the new
17793 current thread, and the topmost frame for that thread.
17794
17795 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
17796
17797 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
17798
17799 @subsubheading Example
17800
17801 @smallexample
17802 (@value{GDBP})
17803 -exec-next
17804 ^running
17805 (@value{GDBP})
17806 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
17807 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
17808 (@value{GDBP})
17809 -thread-list-ids
17810 ^done,
17811 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
17812 number-of-threads="3"
17813 (@value{GDBP})
17814 -thread-select 3
17815 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
17816 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
17817 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
17818 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
17819 (@value{GDBP})
17820 @end smallexample
17821
17822 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17823 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
17824 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
17825
17826 The tracepoint commands are not yet implemented.
17827
17828 @c @subheading -trace-actions
17829
17830 @c @subheading -trace-delete
17831
17832 @c @subheading -trace-disable
17833
17834 @c @subheading -trace-dump
17835
17836 @c @subheading -trace-enable
17837
17838 @c @subheading -trace-exists
17839
17840 @c @subheading -trace-find
17841
17842 @c @subheading -trace-frame-number
17843
17844 @c @subheading -trace-info
17845
17846 @c @subheading -trace-insert
17847
17848 @c @subheading -trace-list
17849
17850 @c @subheading -trace-pass-count
17851
17852 @c @subheading -trace-save
17853
17854 @c @subheading -trace-start
17855
17856 @c @subheading -trace-stop
17857
17858
17859 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
17860 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
17861 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
17862
17863
17864 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
17865
17866 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
17867 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
17868 used by @code{Insight}.
17869
17870 The two main reasons for that are:
17871
17872 @enumerate 1
17873 @item
17874 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
17875
17876 @item
17877 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
17878 now).
17879 @end enumerate
17880
17881 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
17882 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
17883 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
17884 hints about their use.
17885
17886 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
17887 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
17888 least, the following operations:
17889
17890 @itemize @bullet
17891 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
17892 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
17893 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
17894 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
17895 @end itemize
17896
17897 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
17898
17899 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
17900 The basic idea behind variable objects is the creation of a named object
17901 to represent a variable, an expression, a memory location or even a CPU
17902 register. For each object created, a set of operations is available for
17903 examining or changing its properties.
17904
17905 Furthermore, complex data types, such as C structures, are represented
17906 in a tree format. For instance, the @code{struct} type variable is the
17907 root and the children will represent the struct members. If a child
17908 is itself of a complex type, it will also have children of its own.
17909 Appropriate language differences are handled for C, C@t{++} and Java.
17910
17911 When returning the actual values of the objects, this facility allows
17912 for the individual selection of the display format used in the result
17913 creation. It can be chosen among: binary, decimal, hexadecimal, octal
17914 and natural. Natural refers to a default format automatically
17915 chosen based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
17916 for pointers, etc.).
17917
17918 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
17919 access this functionality:
17920
17921 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
17922 @item @strong{Operation}
17923 @tab @strong{Description}
17924
17925 @item @code{-var-create}
17926 @tab create a variable object
17927 @item @code{-var-delete}
17928 @tab delete the variable object and its children
17929 @item @code{-var-set-format}
17930 @tab set the display format of this variable
17931 @item @code{-var-show-format}
17932 @tab show the display format of this variable
17933 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
17934 @tab tells how many children this object has
17935 @item @code{-var-list-children}
17936 @tab return a list of the object's children
17937 @item @code{-var-info-type}
17938 @tab show the type of this variable object
17939 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
17940 @tab print what this variable object represents
17941 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
17942 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
17943 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
17944 @tab get the value of this variable
17945 @item @code{-var-assign}
17946 @tab set the value of this variable
17947 @item @code{-var-update}
17948 @tab update the variable and its children
17949 @end multitable
17950
17951 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
17952 how it can be used.
17953
17954 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
17955
17956 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
17957 @findex -var-create
17958
17959 @subsubheading Synopsis
17960
17961 @smallexample
17962 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
17963 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*"@} @var{expression}
17964 @end smallexample
17965
17966 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
17967 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
17968 register.
17969
17970 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
17971 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
17972 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
17973 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} on that format.
17974 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
17975
17976 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
17977 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
17978 frame should be used.
17979
17980 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
17981 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
17982
17983 @itemize @bullet
17984 @item
17985 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
17986
17987 @item
17988 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
17989
17990 @item
17991 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
17992 @end itemize
17993
17994 @subsubheading Result
17995
17996 This operation returns the name, number of children and the type of the
17997 object created. Type is returned as a string as the ones generated by
17998 the @value{GDBN} CLI:
17999
18000 @smallexample
18001 name="@var{name}",numchild="N",type="@var{type}"
18002 @end smallexample
18003
18004
18005 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
18006 @findex -var-delete
18007
18008 @subsubheading Synopsis
18009
18010 @smallexample
18011 -var-delete @var{name}
18012 @end smallexample
18013
18014 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
18015
18016 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
18017
18018
18019 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
18020 @findex -var-set-format
18021
18022 @subsubheading Synopsis
18023
18024 @smallexample
18025 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
18026 @end smallexample
18027
18028 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
18029 @var{format-spec}.
18030
18031 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
18032
18033 @smallexample
18034 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
18035 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural@}
18036 @end smallexample
18037
18038
18039 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
18040 @findex -var-show-format
18041
18042 @subsubheading Synopsis
18043
18044 @smallexample
18045 -var-show-format @var{name}
18046 @end smallexample
18047
18048 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
18049
18050 @smallexample
18051 @var{format} @expansion{}
18052 @var{format-spec}
18053 @end smallexample
18054
18055
18056 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
18057 @findex -var-info-num-children
18058
18059 @subsubheading Synopsis
18060
18061 @smallexample
18062 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
18063 @end smallexample
18064
18065 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
18066
18067 @smallexample
18068 numchild=@var{n}
18069 @end smallexample
18070
18071
18072 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
18073 @findex -var-list-children
18074
18075 @subsubheading Synopsis
18076
18077 @smallexample
18078 -var-list-children @var{name}
18079 @end smallexample
18080
18081 Returns a list of the children of the specified variable object:
18082
18083 @smallexample
18084 numchild=@var{n},children=[@{name=@var{name},
18085 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
18086 @end smallexample
18087
18088
18089 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
18090 @findex -var-info-type
18091
18092 @subsubheading Synopsis
18093
18094 @smallexample
18095 -var-info-type @var{name}
18096 @end smallexample
18097
18098 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
18099 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
18100 @value{GDBN} CLI:
18101
18102 @smallexample
18103 type=@var{typename}
18104 @end smallexample
18105
18106
18107 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
18108 @findex -var-info-expression
18109
18110 @subsubheading Synopsis
18111
18112 @smallexample
18113 -var-info-expression @var{name}
18114 @end smallexample
18115
18116 Returns what is represented by the variable object @var{name}:
18117
18118 @smallexample
18119 lang=@var{lang-spec},exp=@var{expression}
18120 @end smallexample
18121
18122 @noindent
18123 where @var{lang-spec} is @code{@{"C" | "C++" | "Java"@}}.
18124
18125 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
18126 @findex -var-show-attributes
18127
18128 @subsubheading Synopsis
18129
18130 @smallexample
18131 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
18132 @end smallexample
18133
18134 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
18135
18136 @smallexample
18137 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
18138 @end smallexample
18139
18140 @noindent
18141 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
18142
18143 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
18144 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
18145
18146 @subsubheading Synopsis
18147
18148 @smallexample
18149 -var-evaluate-expression @var{name}
18150 @end smallexample
18151
18152 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
18153 object and returns its value as a string in the current format specified
18154 for the object:
18155
18156 @smallexample
18157 value=@var{value}
18158 @end smallexample
18159
18160 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
18161 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
18162
18163 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
18164 @findex -var-assign
18165
18166 @subsubheading Synopsis
18167
18168 @smallexample
18169 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
18170 @end smallexample
18171
18172 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
18173 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
18174 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
18175 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
18176
18177 @subsubheading Example
18178
18179 @smallexample
18180 (@value{GDBP})
18181 -var-assign var1 3
18182 ^done,value="3"
18183 (@value{GDBP})
18184 -var-update *
18185 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
18186 (@value{GDBP})
18187 @end smallexample
18188
18189 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
18190 @findex -var-update
18191
18192 @subsubheading Synopsis
18193
18194 @smallexample
18195 -var-update @{@var{name} | "*"@}
18196 @end smallexample
18197
18198 Update the value of the variable object @var{name} by evaluating its
18199 expression after fetching all the new values from memory or registers.
18200 A @samp{*} causes all existing variable objects to be updated.
18201
18202
18203 @node Annotations
18204 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
18205
18206 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
18207 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
18208 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
18209 relatively high level.
18210
18211 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseeded by @sc{gdb/mi}
18212 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
18213
18214 @ignore
18215 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
18216 @end ignore
18217
18218 @menu
18219 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
18220 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
18221 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
18222 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
18223 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
18224 * Annotations for Running::
18225 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
18226 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
18227 @end menu
18228
18229 @node Annotations Overview
18230 @section What is an Annotation?
18231 @cindex annotations
18232
18233 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
18234 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
18235 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
18236 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
18237 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
18238 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
18239 cannot contain newline characters.
18240
18241 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
18242 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
18243 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
18244 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
18245 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
18246 means those three characters as output.
18247
18248 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
18249 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
18250 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
18251 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
18252 is for no anntations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
18253 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
18254 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
18255 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
18256 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}). This chapter
18257 describes level 3 annotations.
18258
18259 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
18260
18261 @smallexample
18262 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
18263 GNU gdb 6.0
18264 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
18265 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
18266 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
18267 under certain conditions.
18268 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
18269 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
18270 for details.
18271 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
18272
18273 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
18274 (gdb)
18275 ^Z^Zprompt
18276 @kbd{quit}
18277
18278 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
18279 $
18280 @end smallexample
18281
18282 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
18283 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
18284 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
18285 output from @value{GDBN}.
18286
18287 @node Server Prefix
18288 @section The Server Prefix
18289 @cindex server prefix for annotations
18290
18291 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
18292 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }. This
18293 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
18294 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
18295 pressed on a line by itself.
18296
18297 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
18298 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
18299 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
18300
18301 @node Prompting
18302 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
18303
18304 @cindex annotations for prompts
18305 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
18306 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
18307 over, etc.
18308
18309 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
18310 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
18311 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
18312 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
18313 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
18314 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
18315 features the following annotations:
18316
18317 @smallexample
18318 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
18319 ^Z^Zprompt
18320 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
18321 @end smallexample
18322
18323 The input types are
18324
18325 @table @code
18326 @findex pre-prompt
18327 @findex prompt
18328 @findex post-prompt
18329 @item prompt
18330 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
18331
18332 @findex pre-commands
18333 @findex commands
18334 @findex post-commands
18335 @item commands
18336 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
18337 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
18338
18339 @findex pre-overload-choice
18340 @findex overload-choice
18341 @findex post-overload-choice
18342 @item overload-choice
18343 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
18344
18345 @findex pre-query
18346 @findex query
18347 @findex post-query
18348 @item query
18349 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
18350
18351 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue
18352 @findex prompt-for-continue
18353 @findex post-prompt-for-continue
18354 @item prompt-for-continue
18355 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
18356 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
18357 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
18358 presence of annotations.
18359 @end table
18360
18361 @node Errors
18362 @section Errors
18363 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
18364
18365 @findex quit
18366 @smallexample
18367 ^Z^Zquit
18368 @end smallexample
18369
18370 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
18371
18372 @findex error
18373 @smallexample
18374 ^Z^Zerror
18375 @end smallexample
18376
18377 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
18378
18379 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
18380 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
18381 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
18382 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
18383 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
18384 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
18385 to the top level.
18386
18387 @findex error-begin
18388 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
18389
18390 @smallexample
18391 ^Z^Zerror-begin
18392 @end smallexample
18393
18394 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
18395 message.
18396
18397 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
18398 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
18399 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
18400
18401 @node Invalidation
18402 @section Invalidation Notices
18403
18404 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
18405 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
18406 changed.
18407
18408 @table @code
18409 @findex frames-invalid
18410 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
18411
18412 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
18413 have changed.
18414
18415 @findex breakpoints-invalid
18416 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
18417
18418 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
18419 deleted a breakpoint.
18420 @end table
18421
18422 @node Annotations for Running
18423 @section Running the Program
18424 @cindex annotations for running programs
18425
18426 @findex starting
18427 @findex stopping
18428 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
18429 @code{step} or @code{continue},
18430
18431 @smallexample
18432 ^Z^Zstarting
18433 @end smallexample
18434
18435 is output. When the program stops,
18436
18437 @smallexample
18438 ^Z^Zstopped
18439 @end smallexample
18440
18441 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
18442 annotations describe how the program stopped.
18443
18444 @table @code
18445 @findex exited
18446 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
18447 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
18448 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
18449
18450 @findex signalled
18451 @findex signal-name
18452 @findex signal-name-end
18453 @findex signal-string
18454 @findex signal-string-end
18455 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
18456 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
18457 annotation continues:
18458
18459 @smallexample
18460 @var{intro-text}
18461 ^Z^Zsignal-name
18462 @var{name}
18463 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
18464 @var{middle-text}
18465 ^Z^Zsignal-string
18466 @var{string}
18467 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
18468 @var{end-text}
18469 @end smallexample
18470
18471 @noindent
18472 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
18473 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
18474 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}.
18475 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
18476 user's benefit and have no particular format.
18477
18478 @findex signal
18479 @item ^Z^Zsignal
18480 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
18481 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
18482 terminated with it.
18483
18484 @findex breakpoint
18485 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
18486 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
18487
18488 @findex watchpoint
18489 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
18490 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
18491 @end table
18492
18493 @node Source Annotations
18494 @section Displaying Source
18495 @cindex annotations for source display
18496
18497 @findex source
18498 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
18499
18500 @smallexample
18501 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
18502 @end smallexample
18503
18504 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
18505 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
18506 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
18507 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
18508 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
18509 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
18510 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
18511 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
18512 source which is being displayed. @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
18513 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
18514 depend on the language).
18515
18516 @node GDB Bugs
18517 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
18518 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
18519 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
18520
18521 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
18522
18523 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
18524 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
18525 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
18526 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
18527
18528 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
18529 information that enables us to fix the bug.
18530
18531 @menu
18532 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
18533 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
18534 @end menu
18535
18536 @node Bug Criteria
18537 @section Have you found a bug?
18538 @cindex bug criteria
18539
18540 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
18541
18542 @itemize @bullet
18543 @cindex fatal signal
18544 @cindex debugger crash
18545 @cindex crash of debugger
18546 @item
18547 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
18548 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
18549
18550 @cindex error on valid input
18551 @item
18552 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
18553 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
18554 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
18555
18556 @cindex invalid input
18557 @item
18558 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
18559 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
18560 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
18561 for traditional practice''.
18562
18563 @item
18564 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
18565 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
18566 @end itemize
18567
18568 @node Bug Reporting
18569 @section How to report bugs
18570 @cindex bug reports
18571 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
18572
18573 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
18574 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
18575 contact that organization first.
18576
18577 You can find contact information for many support companies and
18578 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
18579 distribution.
18580 @c should add a web page ref...
18581
18582 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
18583 @value{GDBN}. The prefered method is to submit them directly using
18584 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
18585 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
18586 be used.
18587
18588 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
18589 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
18590 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
18591 @samp{bug-gdb}.
18592
18593 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
18594 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
18595 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
18596 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
18597 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
18598 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
18599 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
18600 bug reports to the mailing list.
18601
18602 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
18603 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
18604 fact or leave it out, state it!
18605
18606 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
18607 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
18608 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
18609 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
18610 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
18611 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
18612 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
18613 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
18614 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
18615
18616 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
18617 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
18618 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
18619 self-contained.
18620
18621 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
18622 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
18623 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
18624 bugs properly.
18625
18626 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
18627
18628 @itemize @bullet
18629 @item
18630 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
18631 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
18632 version}.
18633
18634 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
18635 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
18636
18637 @item
18638 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
18639 version number.
18640
18641 @item
18642 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.
18643 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
18644
18645 @item
18646 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
18647 debugging---e.g. ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
18648 C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
18649 information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
18650 compilers.
18651
18652 @item
18653 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
18654 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
18655 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
18656 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
18657
18658 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
18659 and then we might not encounter the bug.
18660
18661 @item
18662 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
18663 reproduce the bug.
18664
18665 @item
18666 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
18667 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
18668
18669 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
18670 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
18671 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
18672 a chance to make a mistake.
18673
18674 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
18675 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
18676 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
18677 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
18678 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
18679 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
18680 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
18681 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
18682
18683 @item
18684 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
18685 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
18686 it by context, not by line number.
18687
18688 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
18689 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
18690
18691 @end itemize
18692
18693 Here are some things that are not necessary:
18694
18695 @itemize @bullet
18696 @item
18697 A description of the envelope of the bug.
18698
18699 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
18700 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
18701 changes will not affect it.
18702
18703 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
18704 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
18705 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
18706 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
18707
18708 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
18709 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
18710 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
18711 less time, and so on.
18712
18713 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
18714 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
18715
18716 @item
18717 A patch for the bug.
18718
18719 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
18720 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
18721 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
18722 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
18723
18724 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
18725 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
18726 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
18727 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
18728
18729 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
18730 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
18731 help us to understand.
18732
18733 @item
18734 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
18735
18736 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
18737 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
18738 @end itemize
18739
18740 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
18741 @c and consists of the two following files:
18742 @c rluser.texinfo
18743 @c inc-hist.texinfo
18744 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
18745 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
18746 @include rluser.texinfo
18747 @include inc-hist.texinfo
18748
18749
18750 @node Formatting Documentation
18751 @appendix Formatting Documentation
18752
18753 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
18754 @cindex reference card
18755 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
18756 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
18757 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
18758 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
18759 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
18760 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
18761
18762 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
18763 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
18764
18765 @smallexample
18766 make refcard.dvi
18767 @end smallexample
18768
18769 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
18770 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
18771 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
18772 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
18773 your @sc{dvi} output program.
18774
18775 @cindex documentation
18776
18777 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
18778 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
18779 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
18780 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
18781 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
18782 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
18783
18784 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
18785 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
18786 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
18787 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
18788 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
18789 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
18790 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
18791 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
18792
18793 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
18794 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
18795 @code{makeinfo}.
18796
18797 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
18798 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
18799 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
18800
18801 @smallexample
18802 cd gdb
18803 make gdb.info
18804 @end smallexample
18805
18806 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
18807 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
18808 Texinfo definitions file.
18809
18810 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
18811 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
18812 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
18813 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
18814 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
18815 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
18816 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
18817
18818 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
18819 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
18820 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
18821 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
18822 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
18823 directory.
18824
18825 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
18826 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
18827 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
18828 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
18829
18830 @smallexample
18831 make gdb.dvi
18832 @end smallexample
18833
18834 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
18835
18836 @node Installing GDB
18837 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
18838 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
18839 @cindex installation
18840 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}, and source tree subdirectories
18841
18842 @value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
18843 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
18844 build the @code{gdb} program.
18845 @iftex
18846 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
18847 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
18848 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
18849 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
18850 @end iftex
18851
18852 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
18853 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
18854 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
18855
18856 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
18857 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
18858
18859 @table @code
18860 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
18861 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
18862
18863 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
18864 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
18865
18866 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
18867 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
18868
18869 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
18870 @sc{gnu} include files
18871
18872 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
18873 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
18874
18875 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
18876 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
18877
18878 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
18879 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
18880
18881 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
18882 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
18883
18884 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
18885 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
18886 @end table
18887
18888 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
18889 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
18890 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
18891
18892 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
18893 if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
18894 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
18895 argument.
18896
18897 For example:
18898
18899 @smallexample
18900 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
18901 ./configure @var{host}
18902 make
18903 @end smallexample
18904
18905 @noindent
18906 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
18907 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
18908 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
18909 correct value by examining your system.)
18910
18911 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
18912 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
18913 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
18914 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
18915
18916 @need 750
18917 @code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
18918 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
18919 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
18920
18921 @smallexample
18922 sh configure @var{host}
18923 @end smallexample
18924
18925 If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
18926 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
18927 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
18928 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
18929 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
18930
18931 You should run the @code{configure} script from the top directory in the
18932 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
18933 @code{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
18934 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
18935 if you run the first @code{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
18936 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
18937 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
18938 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
18939 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
18940
18941 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
18942 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
18943 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
18944 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
18945 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
18946
18947 @menu
18948 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
18949 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
18950 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
18951 @end menu
18952
18953 @node Separate Objdir
18954 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
18955
18956 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
18957 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
18958 host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
18959 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
18960 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
18961 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
18962 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
18963 program specified there.
18964
18965 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
18966 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
18967 (You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
18968 itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
18969 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
18970 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
18971
18972 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
18973 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
18974
18975 @smallexample
18976 @group
18977 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
18978 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
18979 cd ../gdb-sun4
18980 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
18981 make
18982 @end group
18983 @end smallexample
18984
18985 When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
18986 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
18987 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
18988 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
18989 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
18990 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
18991
18992 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
18993 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
18994 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
18995 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
18996 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
18997
18998 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
18999 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
19000 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
19001 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
19002 You specify a cross-debugging target by
19003 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
19004
19005 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
19006 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
19007 called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
19008
19009 The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
19010 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
19011 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
19012 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
19013 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
19014
19015 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
19016 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
19017 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
19018 with each other.
19019
19020 @node Config Names
19021 @section Specifying names for hosts and targets
19022
19023 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
19024 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
19025 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
19026 of information in the following pattern:
19027
19028 @smallexample
19029 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
19030 @end smallexample
19031
19032 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
19033 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
19034 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
19035
19036 The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
19037 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
19038 aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
19039 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
19040 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
19041 abbreviations---for example:
19042
19043 @smallexample
19044 % sh config.sub i386-linux
19045 i386-pc-linux-gnu
19046 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
19047 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
19048 % sh config.sub hp9k700
19049 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
19050 % sh config.sub sun4
19051 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
19052 % sh config.sub sun3
19053 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
19054 % sh config.sub i986v
19055 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
19056 @end smallexample
19057
19058 @noindent
19059 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
19060 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
19061
19062 @node Configure Options
19063 @section @code{configure} options
19064
19065 Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
19066 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
19067 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
19068 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
19069
19070 @smallexample
19071 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
19072 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
19073 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
19074 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
19075 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
19076 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
19077 @var{host}
19078 @end smallexample
19079
19080 @noindent
19081 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
19082 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
19083 @samp{--}.
19084
19085 @table @code
19086 @item --help
19087 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
19088
19089 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
19090 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
19091 @file{@var{dir}}.
19092
19093 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
19094 Configure the source to install programs under directory
19095 @file{@var{dir}}.
19096
19097 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
19098 @need 2000
19099 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
19100 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
19101 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
19102 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
19103 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
19104 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
19105 directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
19106 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
19107 directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
19108 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
19109 @var{dirname}.
19110
19111 @item --norecursion
19112 Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
19113 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
19114
19115 @item --target=@var{target}
19116 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
19117 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
19118 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
19119
19120 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
19121
19122 @item @var{host} @dots{}
19123 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
19124
19125 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
19126 @end table
19127
19128 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
19129 needed for special purposes only.
19130
19131 @node Maintenance Commands
19132 @appendix Maintenance Commands
19133 @cindex maintenance commands
19134 @cindex internal commands
19135
19136 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
19137 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers.
19138 These commands are provided here for reference.
19139
19140 @table @code
19141 @kindex maint info breakpoints
19142 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
19143 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
19144 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
19145 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
19146 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
19147 is shown:
19148
19149 @table @code
19150 @item breakpoint
19151 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
19152
19153 @item watchpoint
19154 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
19155
19156 @item longjmp
19157 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
19158 @code{longjmp} calls.
19159
19160 @item longjmp resume
19161 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
19162
19163 @item until
19164 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
19165
19166 @item finish
19167 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
19168
19169 @item shlib events
19170 Shared library events.
19171
19172 @end table
19173
19174 @kindex maint internal-error
19175 @kindex maint internal-warning
19176 @item maint internal-error
19177 @itemx maint internal-warning
19178 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
19179 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
19180 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
19181 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
19182 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
19183 @value{GDBN} session.
19184
19185 @smallexample
19186 (gdb) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
19187 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
19188 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
19189 debugging may prove unreliable.
19190 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
19191 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
19192 (gdb)
19193 @end smallexample
19194
19195 Takes an optional parameter that is used as the text of the error or
19196 warning message.
19197
19198 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
19199 @item maint print dummy-frames
19200
19201 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
19202
19203 @smallexample
19204 (gdb) @kbd{b add}
19205 @dots{}
19206 (gdb) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
19207 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
19208 58 return (a + b);
19209 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
19210 @dots{}
19211 (gdb) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
19212 0x1a57c80: pc=0x01014068 fp=0x0200bddc sp=0x0200bdd6
19213 top=0x0200bdd4 id=@{stack=0x200bddc,code=0x101405c@}
19214 call_lo=0x01014000 call_hi=0x01014001
19215 (gdb)
19216 @end smallexample
19217
19218 Takes an optional file parameter.
19219
19220 @kindex maint print registers
19221 @kindex maint print raw-registers
19222 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
19223 @kindex maint print register-groups
19224 @item maint print registers
19225 @itemx maint print raw-registers
19226 @itemx maint print cooked-registers
19227 @itemx maint print register-groups
19228 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
19229
19230 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
19231 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
19232 includes the (cooked) value of all registers; and the command
19233 @code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
19234 register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
19235 @value{GDBN} Internals}.
19236
19237 Takes an optional file parameter.
19238
19239 @kindex maint print reggroups
19240 @item maint print reggroups
19241 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures.
19242
19243 Takes an optional file parameter.
19244
19245 @smallexample
19246 (gdb) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
19247 Group Type
19248 general user
19249 float user
19250 all user
19251 vector user
19252 system user
19253 save internal
19254 restore internal
19255 @end smallexample
19256
19257 @kindex maint set profile
19258 @kindex maint show profile
19259 @cindex profiling GDB
19260 @item maint set profile
19261 @itemx maint show profile
19262 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
19263
19264 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
19265 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
19266 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
19267 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
19268 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
19269 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
19270 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
19271
19272 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
19273 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
19274
19275 @end table
19276
19277
19278 @node Remote Protocol
19279 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
19280
19281 @menu
19282 * Overview::
19283 * Packets::
19284 * Stop Reply Packets::
19285 * General Query Packets::
19286 * Register Packet Format::
19287 * Examples::
19288 * File-I/O remote protocol extension::
19289 @end menu
19290
19291 @node Overview
19292 @section Overview
19293
19294 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
19295 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
19296 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
19297 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
19298
19299 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
19300 transmitted and received data respectfully.
19301
19302 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
19303 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
19304 @cindex remote serial protocol
19305 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
19306 sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
19307 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
19308 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
19309
19310 @smallexample
19311 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
19312 @end smallexample
19313 @noindent
19314
19315 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
19316 @noindent
19317 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
19318 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
19319 eight bit unsigned checksum).
19320
19321 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
19322 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
19323
19324 @smallexample
19325 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
19326 @end smallexample
19327
19328 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
19329 @noindent
19330 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
19331 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
19332 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
19333
19334 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
19335 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
19336 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
19337 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
19338 retransmission):
19339
19340 @smallexample
19341 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
19342 <- @code{+}
19343 @end smallexample
19344 @noindent
19345
19346 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
19347 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
19348 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
19349 when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
19350
19351 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
19352 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
19353 exceptions).
19354
19355 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
19356 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
19357 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
19358 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
19359
19360 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
19361 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
19362 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
19363
19364 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
19365 means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
19366 which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
19367 @samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
19368 where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
19369 characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
19370 value greater than 126 should not be used.
19371
19372 Some remote systems have used a different run-length encoding mechanism
19373 loosely refered to as the cisco encoding. Following the @samp{*}
19374 character are two hex digits that indicate the size of the packet.
19375
19376 So:
19377 @smallexample
19378 "@code{0* }"
19379 @end smallexample
19380 @noindent
19381 means the same as "0000".
19382
19383 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
19384 error number. That number is not well defined.
19385
19386 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
19387 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
19388 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
19389 on that response.
19390
19391 A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
19392 @samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
19393 optional.
19394
19395 @node Packets
19396 @section Packets
19397
19398 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
19399 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
19400
19401 @table @r
19402
19403 @item @code{!} --- extended mode
19404 @cindex @code{!} packet
19405
19406 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
19407 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
19408 debugged.
19409
19410 Reply:
19411 @table @samp
19412 @item OK
19413 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
19414 @end table
19415
19416 @item @code{?} --- last signal
19417 @cindex @code{?} packet
19418
19419 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
19420 step and continue.
19421
19422 Reply:
19423 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
19424
19425 @item @code{a} --- reserved
19426
19427 Reserved for future use.
19428
19429 @item @code{A}@var{arglen}@code{,}@var{argnum}@code{,}@var{arg}@code{,@dots{}} --- set program arguments @strong{(reserved)}
19430 @cindex @code{A} packet
19431
19432 Initialized @samp{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
19433 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream @var{arg}.
19434 See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
19435
19436 Reply:
19437 @table @samp
19438 @item OK
19439 @item E@var{NN}
19440 @end table
19441
19442 @item @code{b}@var{baud} --- set baud @strong{(deprecated)}
19443 @cindex @code{b} packet
19444
19445 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
19446
19447 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
19448 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
19449 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
19450
19451 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
19452 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
19453 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
19454 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
19455 of view, nothing actually happened.}
19456
19457 @item @code{B}@var{addr},@var{mode} --- set breakpoint @strong{(deprecated)}
19458 @cindex @code{B} packet
19459
19460 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
19461 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
19462
19463 This packet has been replaced by the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets
19464 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
19465
19466 @item @code{c}@var{addr} --- continue
19467 @cindex @code{c} packet
19468
19469 @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
19470 current address.
19471
19472 Reply:
19473 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
19474
19475 @item @code{C}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr} --- continue with signal
19476 @cindex @code{C} packet
19477
19478 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
19479 @code{;}@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
19480
19481 Reply:
19482 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
19483
19484 @item @code{d} --- toggle debug @strong{(deprecated)}
19485 @cindex @code{d} packet
19486
19487 Toggle debug flag.
19488
19489 @item @code{D} --- detach
19490 @cindex @code{D} packet
19491
19492 Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target
19493 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
19494
19495 Reply:
19496 @table @samp
19497 @item @emph{no response}
19498 @value{GDBN} does not check for any response after sending this packet.
19499 @end table
19500
19501 @item @code{e} --- reserved
19502
19503 Reserved for future use.
19504
19505 @item @code{E} --- reserved
19506
19507 Reserved for future use.
19508
19509 @item @code{f} --- reserved
19510
19511 Reserved for future use.
19512
19513 @item @code{F}@var{RC}@code{,}@var{EE}@code{,}@var{CF}@code{;}@var{XX} --- Reply to target's F packet.
19514 @cindex @code{F} packet
19515
19516 This packet is send by @value{GDBN} as reply to a @code{F} request packet
19517 sent by the target. This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension.
19518 @xref{File-I/O remote protocol extension}, for the specification.
19519
19520 @item @code{g} --- read registers
19521 @anchor{read registers packet}
19522 @cindex @code{g} packet
19523
19524 Read general registers.
19525
19526 Reply:
19527 @table @samp
19528 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
19529 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
19530 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
19531 each register and their position within the @samp{g} @var{packet} are
19532 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros @var{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}
19533 and @var{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The specification of several standard
19534 @code{g} packets is specified below.
19535 @item E@var{NN}
19536 for an error.
19537 @end table
19538
19539 @item @code{G}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write regs
19540 @cindex @code{G} packet
19541
19542 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of the @var{XX@dots{}}
19543 data.
19544
19545 Reply:
19546 @table @samp
19547 @item OK
19548 for success
19549 @item E@var{NN}
19550 for an error
19551 @end table
19552
19553 @item @code{h} --- reserved
19554
19555 Reserved for future use.
19556
19557 @item @code{H}@var{c}@var{t@dots{}} --- set thread
19558 @cindex @code{H} packet
19559
19560 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
19561 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
19562 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
19563 operations. The thread designator @var{t@dots{}} may be -1, meaning all
19564 the threads, a thread number, or zero which means pick any thread.
19565
19566 Reply:
19567 @table @samp
19568 @item OK
19569 for success
19570 @item E@var{NN}
19571 for an error
19572 @end table
19573
19574 @c FIXME: JTC:
19575 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
19576 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
19577 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
19578 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
19579 @c described. For example:
19580 @c
19581 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
19582 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
19583 @c otherwise returns current registers.
19584 @c
19585 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
19586 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
19587 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
19588
19589 @item @code{i}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{nnn} --- cycle step @strong{(draft)}
19590 @anchor{cycle step packet}
19591 @cindex @code{i} packet
19592
19593 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @code{,}@var{nnn} is
19594 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
19595 step starting at that address.
19596
19597 @item @code{I} --- signal then cycle step @strong{(reserved)}
19598 @cindex @code{I} packet
19599
19600 @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle step packet}.
19601
19602 @item @code{j} --- reserved
19603
19604 Reserved for future use.
19605
19606 @item @code{J} --- reserved
19607
19608 Reserved for future use.
19609
19610 @item @code{k} --- kill request
19611 @cindex @code{k} packet
19612
19613 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
19614 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
19615 thread?)}.
19616
19617 @item @code{K} --- reserved
19618
19619 Reserved for future use.
19620
19621 @item @code{l} --- reserved
19622
19623 Reserved for future use.
19624
19625 @item @code{L} --- reserved
19626
19627 Reserved for future use.
19628
19629 @item @code{m}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- read memory
19630 @cindex @code{m} packet
19631
19632 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
19633 Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that sized memory transfers are
19634 assumed using word aligned accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory
19635 transfer mechanism is needed.}
19636
19637 Reply:
19638 @table @samp
19639 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
19640 @var{XX@dots{}} is mem contents. Can be fewer bytes than requested if able
19641 to read only part of the data. Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume
19642 that sized memory transfers are assumed using word aligned
19643 accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory transfer mechanism is
19644 needed.}
19645 @item E@var{NN}
19646 @var{NN} is errno
19647 @end table
19648
19649 @item @code{M}@var{addr},@var{length}@code{:}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write mem
19650 @cindex @code{M} packet
19651
19652 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
19653 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data.
19654
19655 Reply:
19656 @table @samp
19657 @item OK
19658 for success
19659 @item E@var{NN}
19660 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
19661 written).
19662 @end table
19663
19664 @item @code{n} --- reserved
19665
19666 Reserved for future use.
19667
19668 @item @code{N} --- reserved
19669
19670 Reserved for future use.
19671
19672 @item @code{o} --- reserved
19673
19674 Reserved for future use.
19675
19676 @item @code{O} --- reserved
19677
19678 Reserved for future use.
19679
19680 @item @code{p}@var{n@dots{}} --- read reg @strong{(reserved)}
19681 @cindex @code{p} packet
19682
19683 @xref{write register packet}.
19684
19685 Reply:
19686 @table @samp
19687 @item @var{r@dots{}.}
19688 The hex encoded value of the register in target byte order.
19689 @end table
19690
19691 @item @code{P}@var{n@dots{}}@code{=}@var{r@dots{}} --- write register
19692 @anchor{write register packet}
19693 @cindex @code{P} packet
19694
19695 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}, which contains two hex
19696 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
19697
19698 Reply:
19699 @table @samp
19700 @item OK
19701 for success
19702 @item E@var{NN}
19703 for an error
19704 @end table
19705
19706 @item @code{q}@var{query} --- general query
19707 @anchor{general query packet}
19708 @cindex @code{q} packet
19709
19710 Request info about @var{query}. In general @value{GDBN} queries have a
19711 leading upper case letter. Custom vendor queries should use a company
19712 prefix (in lower case) ex: @samp{qfsf.var}. @var{query} may optionally
19713 be followed by a @samp{,} or @samp{;} separated list. Stubs must ensure
19714 that they match the full @var{query} name.
19715
19716 Reply:
19717 @table @samp
19718 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
19719 Hex encoded data from query. The reply can not be empty.
19720 @item E@var{NN}
19721 error reply
19722 @item
19723 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
19724 @end table
19725
19726 @item @code{Q}@var{var}@code{=}@var{val} --- general set
19727 @cindex @code{Q} packet
19728
19729 Set value of @var{var} to @var{val}.
19730
19731 @xref{general query packet}, for a discussion of naming conventions.
19732
19733 @item @code{r} --- reset @strong{(deprecated)}
19734 @cindex @code{r} packet
19735
19736 Reset the entire system.
19737
19738 @item @code{R}@var{XX} --- remote restart
19739 @cindex @code{R} packet
19740
19741 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
19742 This packet is only available in extended mode.
19743
19744 Reply:
19745 @table @samp
19746 @item @emph{no reply}
19747 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
19748 @end table
19749
19750 @item @code{s}@var{addr} --- step
19751 @cindex @code{s} packet
19752
19753 @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
19754 same address.
19755
19756 Reply:
19757 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
19758
19759 @item @code{S}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr} --- step with signal
19760 @anchor{step with signal packet}
19761 @cindex @code{S} packet
19762
19763 Like @samp{C} but step not continue.
19764
19765 Reply:
19766 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
19767
19768 @item @code{t}@var{addr}@code{:}@var{PP}@code{,}@var{MM} --- search
19769 @cindex @code{t} packet
19770
19771 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
19772 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
19773 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
19774
19775 @item @code{T}@var{XX} --- thread alive
19776 @cindex @code{T} packet
19777
19778 Find out if the thread XX is alive.
19779
19780 Reply:
19781 @table @samp
19782 @item OK
19783 thread is still alive
19784 @item E@var{NN}
19785 thread is dead
19786 @end table
19787
19788 @item @code{u} --- reserved
19789
19790 Reserved for future use.
19791
19792 @item @code{U} --- reserved
19793
19794 Reserved for future use.
19795
19796 @item @code{v} --- reserved
19797
19798 Reserved for future use.
19799
19800 @item @code{V} --- reserved
19801
19802 Reserved for future use.
19803
19804 @item @code{w} --- reserved
19805
19806 Reserved for future use.
19807
19808 @item @code{W} --- reserved
19809
19810 Reserved for future use.
19811
19812 @item @code{x} --- reserved
19813
19814 Reserved for future use.
19815
19816 @item @code{X}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}@var{:}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write mem (binary)
19817 @cindex @code{X} packet
19818
19819 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes, @var{XX@dots{}}
19820 is binary data. The characters @code{$}, @code{#}, and @code{0x7d} are
19821 escaped using @code{0x7d}.
19822
19823 Reply:
19824 @table @samp
19825 @item OK
19826 for success
19827 @item E@var{NN}
19828 for an error
19829 @end table
19830
19831 @item @code{y} --- reserved
19832
19833 Reserved for future use.
19834
19835 @item @code{Y} reserved
19836
19837 Reserved for future use.
19838
19839 @item @code{z}@var{type}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove breakpoint or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
19840 @itemx @code{Z}@var{type}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert breakpoint or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
19841 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
19842 @cindex @code{z} packet
19843 @cindex @code{Z} packets
19844
19845 Insert (@code{Z}) or remove (@code{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
19846 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
19847 @var{length} bytes.
19848
19849 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
19850 separately.
19851
19852 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
19853 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
19854 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
19855 @code{Z}@var{type}@dots{} and @code{z}@var{type}@dots{} packet pair. To
19856 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
19857 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
19858
19859 @item @code{z}@code{0}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove memory breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
19860 @item @code{Z}@code{0}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert memory breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
19861 @cindex @code{z0} packet
19862 @cindex @code{Z0} packet
19863
19864 Insert (@code{Z0}) or remove (@code{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
19865 @code{addr} of size @code{length}.
19866
19867 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
19868 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
19869 @code{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
19870 breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
19871 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
19872
19873 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
19874 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
19875 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
19876 target, is not defined.}
19877
19878 Reply:
19879 @table @samp
19880 @item OK
19881 success
19882 @item
19883 not supported
19884 @item E@var{NN}
19885 for an error
19886 @end table
19887
19888 @item @code{z}@code{1}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove hardware breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
19889 @item @code{Z}@code{1}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert hardware breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
19890 @cindex @code{z1} packet
19891 @cindex @code{Z1} packet
19892
19893 Insert (@code{Z1}) or remove (@code{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
19894 address @code{addr} of size @code{length}.
19895
19896 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
19897 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
19898
19899 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
19900 movement.}
19901
19902 Reply:
19903 @table @samp
19904 @item OK
19905 success
19906 @item
19907 not supported
19908 @item E@var{NN}
19909 for an error
19910 @end table
19911
19912 @item @code{z}@code{2}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove write watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
19913 @item @code{Z}@code{2}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert write watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
19914 @cindex @code{z2} packet
19915 @cindex @code{Z2} packet
19916
19917 Insert (@code{Z2}) or remove (@code{z2}) a write watchpoint.
19918
19919 Reply:
19920 @table @samp
19921 @item OK
19922 success
19923 @item
19924 not supported
19925 @item E@var{NN}
19926 for an error
19927 @end table
19928
19929 @item @code{z}@code{3}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove read watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
19930 @item @code{Z}@code{3}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert read watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
19931 @cindex @code{z3} packet
19932 @cindex @code{Z3} packet
19933
19934 Insert (@code{Z3}) or remove (@code{z3}) a read watchpoint.
19935
19936 Reply:
19937 @table @samp
19938 @item OK
19939 success
19940 @item
19941 not supported
19942 @item E@var{NN}
19943 for an error
19944 @end table
19945
19946 @item @code{z}@code{4}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove access watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
19947 @item @code{Z}@code{4}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert access watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
19948 @cindex @code{z4} packet
19949 @cindex @code{Z4} packet
19950
19951 Insert (@code{Z4}) or remove (@code{z4}) an access watchpoint.
19952
19953 Reply:
19954 @table @samp
19955 @item OK
19956 success
19957 @item
19958 not supported
19959 @item E@var{NN}
19960 for an error
19961 @end table
19962
19963 @end table
19964
19965 @node Stop Reply Packets
19966 @section Stop Reply Packets
19967 @cindex stop reply packets
19968
19969 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
19970 receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
19971 @samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
19972 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @samp{signal
19973 number} is poorly defined. In general one of the UNIX signal numbering
19974 conventions is used.
19975
19976 @table @samp
19977
19978 @item S@var{AA}
19979 @var{AA} is the signal number
19980
19981 @item @code{T}@var{AA}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}
19982 @cindex @code{T} packet reply
19983
19984 @var{AA} = two hex digit signal number; @var{n...} = register number
19985 (hex), @var{r...} = target byte ordered register contents, size defined
19986 by @code{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}; @var{n...} = @samp{thread}, @var{r...} =
19987 thread process ID, this is a hex integer; @var{n...} = (@samp{watch} |
19988 @samp{rwatch} | @samp{awatch}, @var{r...} = data address, this is a hex
19989 integer; @var{n...} = other string not starting with valid hex digit.
19990 @value{GDBN} should ignore this @var{n...}, @var{r...} pair and go on
19991 to the next. This way we can extend the protocol.
19992
19993 @item W@var{AA}
19994
19995 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
19996 applicable to certain targets.
19997
19998 @item X@var{AA}
19999
20000 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
20001
20002 @item N@var{AA};@var{t@dots{}};@var{d@dots{}};@var{b@dots{}} @strong{(obsolete)}
20003
20004 @var{AA} = signal number; @var{t@dots{}} = address of symbol
20005 @code{_start}; @var{d@dots{}} = base of data section; @var{b@dots{}} =
20006 base of bss section. @emph{Note: only used by Cisco Systems targets.
20007 The difference between this reply and the @samp{qOffsets} query is that
20008 the @samp{N} packet may arrive spontaneously whereas the @samp{qOffsets}
20009 is a query initiated by the host debugger.}
20010
20011 @item O@var{XX@dots{}}
20012
20013 @var{XX@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data. This can happen at
20014 any time while the program is running and the debugger should continue
20015 to wait for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc.
20016
20017 @item F@var{call-id}@code{,}@var{parameter@dots{}}
20018
20019 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
20020 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
20021 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
20022 @xref{File-I/O remote protocol extension}, for a list of implemented
20023 system calls.
20024
20025 @var{parameter@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for this very
20026 system call.
20027
20028 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to call
20029 a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies with
20030 an appropriate @code{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next reply
20031 packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or
20032 @samp{s} action is expected to be continued.
20033 @xref{File-I/O remote protocol extension}, for more details.
20034
20035 @end table
20036
20037 @node General Query Packets
20038 @section General Query Packets
20039
20040 The following set and query packets have already been defined.
20041
20042 @table @r
20043
20044 @item @code{q}@code{C} --- current thread
20045
20046 Return the current thread id.
20047
20048 Reply:
20049 @table @samp
20050 @item @code{QC}@var{pid}
20051 Where @var{pid} is a HEX encoded 16 bit process id.
20052 @item *
20053 Any other reply implies the old pid.
20054 @end table
20055
20056 @item @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo} -- all thread ids
20057
20058 @code{q}@code{sThreadInfo}
20059
20060 Obtain a list of active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
20061 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
20062 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
20063 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
20064 be the @code{qf}@code{ThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
20065 sequence will be the @code{qs}@code{ThreadInfo} query.
20066
20067 NOTE: replaces the @code{qL} query (see below).
20068
20069 Reply:
20070 @table @samp
20071 @item @code{m}@var{id}
20072 A single thread id
20073 @item @code{m}@var{id},@var{id}@dots{}
20074 a comma-separated list of thread ids
20075 @item @code{l}
20076 (lower case 'el') denotes end of list.
20077 @end table
20078
20079 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
20080 more thread ids, in big-endian hex, separated by commas. @value{GDBN}
20081 will respond to each reply with a request for more thread ids (using the
20082 @code{qs} form of the query), until the target responds with @code{l}
20083 (lower-case el, for @code{'last'}).
20084
20085 @item @code{q}@code{ThreadExtraInfo}@code{,}@var{id} --- extra thread info
20086
20087 Where @var{id} is a thread-id in big-endian hex. Obtain a printable
20088 string description of a thread's attributes from the target OS. This
20089 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting for
20090 @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is displayed
20091 in @value{GDBN}'s @samp{info threads} display. Some examples of
20092 possible thread extra info strings are ``Runnable'', or ``Blocked on
20093 Mutex''.
20094
20095 Reply:
20096 @table @samp
20097 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
20098 Where @var{XX@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, comprising
20099 the printable string containing the extra information about the thread's
20100 attributes.
20101 @end table
20102
20103 @item @code{q}@code{L}@var{startflag}@var{threadcount}@var{nextthread} --- query @var{LIST} or @var{threadLIST} @strong{(deprecated)}
20104
20105 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
20106 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
20107 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
20108 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
20109 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
20110 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
20111
20112 NOTE: this query is replaced by the @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo} query
20113 (see above).
20114
20115 Reply:
20116 @table @samp
20117 @item @code{q}@code{M}@var{count}@var{done}@var{argthread}@var{thread@dots{}}
20118 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
20119 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
20120 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
20121 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread@dots{}}
20122 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
20123 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
20124 @end table
20125
20126 @item @code{q}@code{CRC:}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- compute CRC of memory block
20127
20128 Reply:
20129 @table @samp
20130 @item @code{E}@var{NN}
20131 An error (such as memory fault)
20132 @item @code{C}@var{CRC32}
20133 A 32 bit cyclic redundancy check of the specified memory region.
20134 @end table
20135
20136 @item @code{q}@code{Offsets} --- query sect offs
20137
20138 Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
20139 image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
20140 response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
20141 offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
20142
20143 Reply:
20144 @table @samp
20145 @item @code{Text=}@var{xxx}@code{;Data=}@var{yyy}@code{;Bss=}@var{zzz}
20146 @end table
20147
20148 @item @code{q}@code{P}@var{mode}@var{threadid} --- thread info request
20149
20150 Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
20151 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
20152
20153 Reply:
20154 @table @samp
20155 @item *
20156 @end table
20157
20158 See @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
20159
20160 @item @code{q}@code{Rcmd,}@var{command} --- remote command
20161
20162 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
20163 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output string.
20164 Before the final result packet, the target may also respond with a
20165 number of intermediate @code{O}@var{output} console output packets.
20166 @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a stubs's
20167 interpreter may have security implications}.
20168
20169 Reply:
20170 @table @samp
20171 @item OK
20172 A command response with no output.
20173 @item @var{OUTPUT}
20174 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
20175 @item @code{E}@var{NN}
20176 Indicate a badly formed request.
20177 @item @samp{}
20178 When @samp{q}@samp{Rcmd} is not recognized.
20179 @end table
20180
20181 @item @code{qSymbol::} --- symbol lookup
20182
20183 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
20184 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
20185
20186 Reply:
20187 @table @samp
20188 @item @code{OK}
20189 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
20190 @item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
20191 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
20192 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
20193 @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name} message, described below.
20194 @end table
20195
20196 @item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name} --- symbol value
20197
20198 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
20199
20200 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
20201 target has previously requested.
20202
20203 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
20204 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
20205 will be empty.
20206
20207 Reply:
20208 @table @samp
20209 @item @code{OK}
20210 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
20211 @item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
20212 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
20213 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
20214 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
20215 @end table
20216
20217 @end table
20218
20219 @node Register Packet Format
20220 @section Register Packet Format
20221
20222 The following @samp{g}/@samp{G} packets have previously been defined.
20223 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
20224 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
20225 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transfered in target
20226 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transfered
20227 most-significant - least-significant.
20228
20229 @table @r
20230
20231 @item MIPS32
20232
20233 All registers are transfered as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
20234 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
20235 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
20236
20237 @item MIPS64
20238
20239 All registers are transfered as sixty-four bit quantities (including
20240 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
20241 as @code{MIPS32}.
20242
20243 @end table
20244
20245 @node Examples
20246 @section Examples
20247
20248 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
20249 does not get any direct output:
20250
20251 @smallexample
20252 -> @code{R00}
20253 <- @code{+}
20254 @emph{target restarts}
20255 -> @code{?}
20256 <- @code{+}
20257 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
20258 -> @code{+}
20259 @end smallexample
20260
20261 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
20262
20263 @smallexample
20264 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
20265 <- @code{+}
20266 -> @code{s}
20267 <- @code{+}
20268 @emph{time passes}
20269 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
20270 -> @code{+}
20271 -> @code{g}
20272 <- @code{+}
20273 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
20274 -> @code{+}
20275 @end smallexample
20276
20277 @node File-I/O remote protocol extension
20278 @section File-I/O remote protocol extension
20279 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
20280
20281 @menu
20282 * File-I/O Overview::
20283 * Protocol basics::
20284 * The `F' request packet::
20285 * The `F' reply packet::
20286 * Memory transfer::
20287 * The Ctrl-C message::
20288 * Console I/O::
20289 * The isatty call::
20290 * The system call::
20291 * List of supported calls::
20292 * Protocol specific representation of datatypes::
20293 * Constants::
20294 * File-I/O Examples::
20295 @end menu
20296
20297 @node File-I/O Overview
20298 @subsection File-I/O Overview
20299 @cindex file-i/o overview
20300
20301 The File I/O remote protocol extension (short: File-I/O) allows the
20302 target to use the hosts file system and console I/O when calling various
20303 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
20304 remote protocol packet to the host system which then performs the needed
20305 actions and returns with an adequate response packet to the target system.
20306 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
20307
20308 The protocol is defined host- and target-system independent. It uses
20309 it's own independent representation of datatypes and values. Both,
20310 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
20311 translating the system dependent values into the unified protocol values
20312 when data is transmitted.
20313
20314 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only
20315 when GDB is waiting for the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s}
20316 packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
20317 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
20318 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interuptible by target signals. It
20319 is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt (Ctrl-C), though.
20320
20321 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
20322 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
20323 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
20324 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
20325 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
20326
20327 @smallexample
20328 (gdb) continue
20329 <- target requests 'system call X'
20330 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
20331 -> GDB returns result
20332 ... target continues, GDB returns to wait for the target
20333 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
20334 @end smallexample
20335
20336 The protocol is only used for files on the host file system and
20337 for I/O on the console. Character or block special devices, pipes,
20338 named pipes or sockets or any other communication method on the host
20339 system are not supported by this protocol.
20340
20341 @node Protocol basics
20342 @subsection Protocol basics
20343 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
20344
20345 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet, as request as well
20346 as as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
20347 @value{GDBN} is waiting for the continuing or stepping target, the
20348 File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
20349 of a former @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
20350 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
20351 to call the appropriate host system call:
20352
20353 @itemize @bullet
20354 @item
20355 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
20356
20357 @item
20358 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
20359 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
20360 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
20361 Numerical control values are given in a protocol specific representation.
20362
20363 @end itemize
20364
20365 At that point @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
20366
20367 @itemize @bullet
20368 @item
20369 If parameter pointer values are given, which point to data needed as input
20370 to a system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
20371 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
20372 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
20373 packet.
20374
20375 @item
20376 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
20377 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
20378
20379 @item
20380 @value{GDBN} calls the system call
20381
20382 @item
20383 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
20384
20385 @item
20386 If pointer parameters in the request packet point to buffer space in which
20387 a system call is expected to copy data to, the data is transmitted to the
20388 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
20389 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
20390 packet.
20391
20392 @end itemize
20393
20394 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
20395 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
20396
20397 @itemize @bullet
20398 @item
20399 Return value.
20400
20401 @item
20402 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
20403
20404 @item
20405 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
20406
20407 @end itemize
20408
20409 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
20410 the latest continue or step action.
20411
20412 @node The `F' request packet
20413 @subsection The @code{F} request packet
20414 @cindex file-i/o request packet
20415 @cindex @code{F} request packet
20416
20417 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
20418
20419 @table @samp
20420
20421 @smallexample
20422 @code{F}@var{call-id}@code{,}@var{parameter@dots{}}
20423 @end smallexample
20424
20425 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
20426 This is just the name of the function.
20427
20428 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
20429
20430 @end table
20431
20432 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the real values in case
20433 of scalar datatypes, as pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
20434 datatypes and unspecified memory areas or as pointer/length pairs in case
20435 of string parameters. These are appended to the call-id, each separated
20436 from its predecessor by a comma. All values are transmitted in ASCII
20437 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
20438
20439 @node The `F' reply packet
20440 @subsection The @code{F} reply packet
20441 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
20442 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
20443
20444 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
20445
20446 @table @samp
20447
20448 @smallexample
20449 @code{F}@var{retcode}@code{,}@var{errno}@code{,}@var{Ctrl-C flag}@code{;}@var{call specific attachment}
20450 @end smallexample
20451
20452 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
20453
20454 @var{errno} is the errno set by the call, in protocol specific representation.
20455 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
20456
20457 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only send if the user requested a break. In this
20458 case, @var{errno} must be send as well, even if the call was successful.
20459 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character 'C':
20460
20461 @smallexample
20462 F0,0,C
20463 @end smallexample
20464
20465 @noindent
20466 or, if the call was interupted before the host call has been performed:
20467
20468 @smallexample
20469 F-1,4,C
20470 @end smallexample
20471
20472 @noindent
20473 assuming 4 is the protocol specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
20474
20475 @end table
20476
20477 @node Memory transfer
20478 @subsection Memory transfer
20479 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
20480
20481 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write as e.g.@:
20482 a @code{struct stat} is expected to be in a protocol specific format with
20483 all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. This should be done by
20484 the target before the @code{F} packet is sent resp.@: by @value{GDBN} before
20485 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
20486 data should point to the already coerced data at any time.
20487
20488 @node The Ctrl-C message
20489 @subsection The Ctrl-C message
20490 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
20491
20492 A special case is, if the @var{Ctrl-C flag} is set in the @value{GDBN}
20493 reply packet. In this case the target should behave, as if it had
20494 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
20495 interupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
20496 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
20497 packet. In this case, it's important for the target to know, in which
20498 state the system call was interrupted. Since this action is by design
20499 not an atomic operation, we have to differ between two cases:
20500
20501 @itemize @bullet
20502 @item
20503 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
20504
20505 @item
20506 The system call on the host has been finished.
20507
20508 @end itemize
20509
20510 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
20511 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
20512 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
20513 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
20514 system call has been finished --- successful or not --- and should behave
20515 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
20516
20517 @value{GDBN} must behave reliable. If the system call has not been called
20518 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
20519 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
20520 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finshed by
20521 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as they fit.
20522 The @code{F} packet may only be send when either nothing has happened
20523 or the full action has been completed.
20524
20525 @node Console I/O
20526 @subsection Console I/O
20527 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
20528
20529 By default and if not explicitely closed by the target system, the file
20530 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
20531 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
20532 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
20533 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
20534 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
20535 conditions is met:
20536
20537 @itemize @bullet
20538 @item
20539 The user presses @kbd{Ctrl-C}. The behaviour is as explained above, the
20540 @code{read}
20541 system call is treated as finished.
20542
20543 @item
20544 The user presses @kbd{Enter}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
20545 line feed.
20546
20547 @item
20548 The user presses @kbd{Ctrl-D}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
20549 character, especially no Ctrl-D is appended to the input.
20550
20551 @end itemize
20552
20553 If the user has typed more characters as fit in the buffer given to
20554 the read call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
20555 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target or debugging
20556 is stopped on users request.
20557
20558 @node The isatty call
20559 @subsection The isatty(3) call
20560 @cindex isatty call, file-i/o protocol
20561
20562 A special case in this protocol is the library call @code{isatty} which
20563 is implemented as it's own call inside of this protocol. It returns
20564 1 to the target if the file descriptor given as parameter is attached
20565 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
20566 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
20567 needed.
20568
20569 @node The system call
20570 @subsection The system(3) call
20571 @cindex system call, file-i/o protocol
20572
20573 The other special case in this protocol is the @code{system} call which
20574 is implemented as it's own call, too. @value{GDBN} is taking over the full
20575 task of calling the necessary host calls to perform the @code{system}
20576 call. The return value of @code{system} is simplified before it's returned
20577 to the target. Basically, the only signal transmitted back is @code{EINTR}
20578 in case the user pressed @kbd{Ctrl-C}. Otherwise the return value consists
20579 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
20580
20581 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is refused to be called
20582 by @value{GDBN} by default. The user has to allow this call explicitly by
20583 entering
20584
20585 @table @samp
20586 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed 1
20587 @item @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1}
20588 @end table
20589
20590 Disabling the @code{system} call is done by
20591
20592 @table @samp
20593 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed 0
20594 @item @code{set remote system-call-allowed 0}
20595 @end table
20596
20597 The current setting is shown by typing
20598
20599 @table @samp
20600 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
20601 @item @code{show remote system-call-allowed}
20602 @end table
20603
20604 @node List of supported calls
20605 @subsection List of supported calls
20606 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
20607
20608 @menu
20609 * open::
20610 * close::
20611 * read::
20612 * write::
20613 * lseek::
20614 * rename::
20615 * unlink::
20616 * stat/fstat::
20617 * gettimeofday::
20618 * isatty::
20619 * system::
20620 @end menu
20621
20622 @node open
20623 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
20624 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
20625
20626 @smallexample
20627 @exdent Synopsis:
20628 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
20629 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
20630
20631 @exdent Request:
20632 Fopen,pathptr/len,flags,mode
20633 @end smallexample
20634
20635 @noindent
20636 @code{flags} is the bitwise or of the following values:
20637
20638 @table @code
20639 @item O_CREAT
20640 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
20641 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
20642 are concerned.
20643
20644 @item O_EXCL
20645 When used with O_CREAT, if the file already exists it is
20646 an error and open() fails.
20647
20648 @item O_TRUNC
20649 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
20650 writing (O_RDWR or O_WRONLY is given) it will be
20651 truncated to length 0.
20652
20653 @item O_APPEND
20654 The file is opened in append mode.
20655
20656 @item O_RDONLY
20657 The file is opened for reading only.
20658
20659 @item O_WRONLY
20660 The file is opened for writing only.
20661
20662 @item O_RDWR
20663 The file is opened for reading and writing.
20664
20665 @noindent
20666 Each other bit is silently ignored.
20667
20668 @end table
20669
20670 @noindent
20671 @code{mode} is the bitwise or of the following values:
20672
20673 @table @code
20674 @item S_IRUSR
20675 User has read permission.
20676
20677 @item S_IWUSR
20678 User has write permission.
20679
20680 @item S_IRGRP
20681 Group has read permission.
20682
20683 @item S_IWGRP
20684 Group has write permission.
20685
20686 @item S_IROTH
20687 Others have read permission.
20688
20689 @item S_IWOTH
20690 Others have write permission.
20691
20692 @noindent
20693 Each other bit is silently ignored.
20694
20695 @end table
20696
20697 @smallexample
20698 @exdent Return value:
20699 open returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
20700 occured.
20701
20702 @exdent Errors:
20703 @end smallexample
20704
20705 @table @code
20706 @item EEXIST
20707 pathname already exists and O_CREAT and O_EXCL were used.
20708
20709 @item EISDIR
20710 pathname refers to a directory.
20711
20712 @item EACCES
20713 The requested access is not allowed.
20714
20715 @item ENAMETOOLONG
20716 pathname was too long.
20717
20718 @item ENOENT
20719 A directory component in pathname does not exist.
20720
20721 @item ENODEV
20722 pathname refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
20723
20724 @item EROFS
20725 pathname refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
20726 write access was requested.
20727
20728 @item EFAULT
20729 pathname is an invalid pointer value.
20730
20731 @item ENOSPC
20732 No space on device to create the file.
20733
20734 @item EMFILE
20735 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
20736
20737 @item ENFILE
20738 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
20739 has been reached.
20740
20741 @item EINTR
20742 The call was interrupted by the user.
20743 @end table
20744
20745 @node close
20746 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
20747 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
20748
20749 @smallexample
20750 @exdent Synopsis:
20751 int close(int fd);
20752
20753 @exdent Request:
20754 Fclose,fd
20755
20756 @exdent Return value:
20757 close returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
20758
20759 @exdent Errors:
20760 @end smallexample
20761
20762 @table @code
20763 @item EBADF
20764 fd isn't a valid open file descriptor.
20765
20766 @item EINTR
20767 The call was interrupted by the user.
20768 @end table
20769
20770 @node read
20771 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
20772 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
20773
20774 @smallexample
20775 @exdent Synopsis:
20776 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
20777
20778 @exdent Request:
20779 Fread,fd,bufptr,count
20780
20781 @exdent Return value:
20782 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
20783 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
20784 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
20785
20786 @exdent Errors:
20787 @end smallexample
20788
20789 @table @code
20790 @item EBADF
20791 fd is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
20792 reading.
20793
20794 @item EFAULT
20795 buf is an invalid pointer value.
20796
20797 @item EINTR
20798 The call was interrupted by the user.
20799 @end table
20800
20801 @node write
20802 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
20803 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
20804
20805 @smallexample
20806 @exdent Synopsis:
20807 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
20808
20809 @exdent Request:
20810 Fwrite,fd,bufptr,count
20811
20812 @exdent Return value:
20813 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
20814 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
20815 is returned.
20816
20817 @exdent Errors:
20818 @end smallexample
20819
20820 @table @code
20821 @item EBADF
20822 fd is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
20823 writing.
20824
20825 @item EFAULT
20826 buf is an invalid pointer value.
20827
20828 @item EFBIG
20829 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
20830 host specific maximum file size allowed.
20831
20832 @item ENOSPC
20833 No space on device to write the data.
20834
20835 @item EINTR
20836 The call was interrupted by the user.
20837 @end table
20838
20839 @node lseek
20840 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
20841 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
20842
20843 @smallexample
20844 @exdent Synopsis:
20845 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
20846
20847 @exdent Request:
20848 Flseek,fd,offset,flag
20849 @end smallexample
20850
20851 @code{flag} is one of:
20852
20853 @table @code
20854 @item SEEK_SET
20855 The offset is set to offset bytes.
20856
20857 @item SEEK_CUR
20858 The offset is set to its current location plus offset
20859 bytes.
20860
20861 @item SEEK_END
20862 The offset is set to the size of the file plus offset
20863 bytes.
20864 @end table
20865
20866 @smallexample
20867 @exdent Return value:
20868 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
20869 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
20870 value of -1 is returned.
20871
20872 @exdent Errors:
20873 @end smallexample
20874
20875 @table @code
20876 @item EBADF
20877 fd is not a valid open file descriptor.
20878
20879 @item ESPIPE
20880 fd is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
20881
20882 @item EINVAL
20883 flag is not a proper value.
20884
20885 @item EINTR
20886 The call was interrupted by the user.
20887 @end table
20888
20889 @node rename
20890 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
20891 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
20892
20893 @smallexample
20894 @exdent Synopsis:
20895 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
20896
20897 @exdent Request:
20898 Frename,oldpathptr/len,newpathptr/len
20899
20900 @exdent Return value:
20901 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
20902
20903 @exdent Errors:
20904 @end smallexample
20905
20906 @table @code
20907 @item EISDIR
20908 newpath is an existing directory, but oldpath is not a
20909 directory.
20910
20911 @item EEXIST
20912 newpath is a non-empty directory.
20913
20914 @item EBUSY
20915 oldpath or newpath is a directory that is in use by some
20916 process.
20917
20918 @item EINVAL
20919 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
20920 of itself.
20921
20922 @item ENOTDIR
20923 A component used as a directory in oldpath or new
20924 path is not a directory. Or oldpath is a directory
20925 and newpath exists but is not a directory.
20926
20927 @item EFAULT
20928 oldpathptr or newpathptr are invalid pointer values.
20929
20930 @item EACCES
20931 No access to the file or the path of the file.
20932
20933 @item ENAMETOOLONG
20934
20935 oldpath or newpath was too long.
20936
20937 @item ENOENT
20938 A directory component in oldpath or newpath does not exist.
20939
20940 @item EROFS
20941 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
20942
20943 @item ENOSPC
20944 The device containing the file has no room for the new
20945 directory entry.
20946
20947 @item EINTR
20948 The call was interrupted by the user.
20949 @end table
20950
20951 @node unlink
20952 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
20953 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
20954
20955 @smallexample
20956 @exdent Synopsis:
20957 int unlink(const char *pathname);
20958
20959 @exdent Request:
20960 Funlink,pathnameptr/len
20961
20962 @exdent Return value:
20963 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
20964
20965 @exdent Errors:
20966 @end smallexample
20967
20968 @table @code
20969 @item EACCES
20970 No access to the file or the path of the file.
20971
20972 @item EPERM
20973 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
20974
20975 @item EBUSY
20976 The file pathname cannot be unlinked because it's
20977 being used by another process.
20978
20979 @item EFAULT
20980 pathnameptr is an invalid pointer value.
20981
20982 @item ENAMETOOLONG
20983 pathname was too long.
20984
20985 @item ENOENT
20986 A directory component in pathname does not exist.
20987
20988 @item ENOTDIR
20989 A component of the path is not a directory.
20990
20991 @item EROFS
20992 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
20993
20994 @item EINTR
20995 The call was interrupted by the user.
20996 @end table
20997
20998 @node stat/fstat
20999 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
21000 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
21001 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
21002
21003 @smallexample
21004 @exdent Synopsis:
21005 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
21006 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
21007
21008 @exdent Request:
21009 Fstat,pathnameptr/len,bufptr
21010 Ffstat,fd,bufptr
21011
21012 @exdent Return value:
21013 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
21014
21015 @exdent Errors:
21016 @end smallexample
21017
21018 @table @code
21019 @item EBADF
21020 fd is not a valid open file.
21021
21022 @item ENOENT
21023 A directory component in pathname does not exist or the
21024 path is an empty string.
21025
21026 @item ENOTDIR
21027 A component of the path is not a directory.
21028
21029 @item EFAULT
21030 pathnameptr is an invalid pointer value.
21031
21032 @item EACCES
21033 No access to the file or the path of the file.
21034
21035 @item ENAMETOOLONG
21036 pathname was too long.
21037
21038 @item EINTR
21039 The call was interrupted by the user.
21040 @end table
21041
21042 @node gettimeofday
21043 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
21044 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
21045
21046 @smallexample
21047 @exdent Synopsis:
21048 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
21049
21050 @exdent Request:
21051 Fgettimeofday,tvptr,tzptr
21052
21053 @exdent Return value:
21054 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
21055
21056 @exdent Errors:
21057 @end smallexample
21058
21059 @table @code
21060 @item EINVAL
21061 tz is a non-NULL pointer.
21062
21063 @item EFAULT
21064 tvptr and/or tzptr is an invalid pointer value.
21065 @end table
21066
21067 @node isatty
21068 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
21069 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
21070
21071 @smallexample
21072 @exdent Synopsis:
21073 int isatty(int fd);
21074
21075 @exdent Request:
21076 Fisatty,fd
21077
21078 @exdent Return value:
21079 Returns 1 if fd refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
21080
21081 @exdent Errors:
21082 @end smallexample
21083
21084 @table @code
21085 @item EINTR
21086 The call was interrupted by the user.
21087 @end table
21088
21089 @node system
21090 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
21091 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
21092
21093 @smallexample
21094 @exdent Synopsis:
21095 int system(const char *command);
21096
21097 @exdent Request:
21098 Fsystem,commandptr/len
21099
21100 @exdent Return value:
21101 The value returned is -1 on error and the return status
21102 of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
21103 command is returned, which is extracted from the hosts
21104 system return value by calling WEXITSTATUS(retval).
21105 In case /bin/sh could not be executed, 127 is returned.
21106
21107 @exdent Errors:
21108 @end smallexample
21109
21110 @table @code
21111 @item EINTR
21112 The call was interrupted by the user.
21113 @end table
21114
21115 @node Protocol specific representation of datatypes
21116 @subsection Protocol specific representation of datatypes
21117 @cindex protocol specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
21118
21119 @menu
21120 * Integral datatypes::
21121 * Pointer values::
21122 * struct stat::
21123 * struct timeval::
21124 @end menu
21125
21126 @node Integral datatypes
21127 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral datatypes
21128 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
21129
21130 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are
21131
21132 @smallexample
21133 int@r{,} unsigned int@r{,} long@r{,} unsigned long@r{,} mode_t @r{and} time_t
21134 @end smallexample
21135
21136 @code{Int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
21137 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
21138
21139 @code{Long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
21140
21141 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
21142 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
21143
21144 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
21145
21146 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
21147 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
21148 byte order.
21149
21150 @node Pointer values
21151 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer values
21152 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
21153
21154 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
21155 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
21156 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
21157 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
21158
21159 @smallexample
21160 @code{1aaf/12}
21161 @end smallexample
21162
21163 @noindent
21164 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
21165 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
21166 the trailing null byte. Example:
21167
21168 @smallexample
21169 ``hello, world'' at address 0x123456
21170 @end smallexample
21171
21172 @noindent
21173 is transmitted as
21174
21175 @smallexample
21176 @code{123456/d}
21177 @end smallexample
21178
21179 @node struct stat
21180 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
21181 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
21182
21183 The buffer of type struct stat used by the target and @value{GDBN} is defined
21184 as follows:
21185
21186 @smallexample
21187 struct stat @{
21188 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
21189 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
21190 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
21191 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
21192 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
21193 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
21194 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
21195 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
21196 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
21197 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
21198 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
21199 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
21200 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
21201 @};
21202 @end smallexample
21203
21204 The integral datatypes are conforming to the definitions given in the
21205 approriate section (see @ref{Integral datatypes}, for details) so this
21206 structure is of size 64 bytes.
21207
21208 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
21209 range of values.
21210
21211 @smallexample
21212 st_dev: 0 file
21213 1 console
21214
21215 st_ino: No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
21216
21217 st_mode: Valid mode bits are described in Appendix C. Any other
21218 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
21219
21220 st_uid: No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
21221
21222 st_gid: No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
21223
21224 st_rdev: No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
21225
21226 st_atime, st_mtime, st_ctime:
21227 These values have a host and file system dependent
21228 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts the file systems
21229 don't support exact timing values.
21230 @end smallexample
21231
21232 The target gets a struct stat of the above representation and is
21233 responsible to coerce it to the target representation before
21234 continuing.
21235
21236 Note that due to size differences between the host and target
21237 representation of stat members, these members could eventually
21238 get truncated on the target.
21239
21240 @node struct timeval
21241 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
21242 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
21243
21244 The buffer of type struct timeval used by the target and @value{GDBN}
21245 is defined as follows:
21246
21247 @smallexample
21248 struct timeval @{
21249 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
21250 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
21251 @};
21252 @end smallexample
21253
21254 The integral datatypes are conforming to the definitions given in the
21255 approriate section (see @ref{Integral datatypes}, for details) so this
21256 structure is of size 8 bytes.
21257
21258 @node Constants
21259 @subsection Constants
21260 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
21261
21262 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
21263 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are resposible to translate these
21264 values before and after the call as needed.
21265
21266 @menu
21267 * Open flags::
21268 * mode_t values::
21269 * Errno values::
21270 * Lseek flags::
21271 * Limits::
21272 @end menu
21273
21274 @node Open flags
21275 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open flags
21276 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
21277
21278 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
21279
21280 @smallexample
21281 O_RDONLY 0x0
21282 O_WRONLY 0x1
21283 O_RDWR 0x2
21284 O_APPEND 0x8
21285 O_CREAT 0x200
21286 O_TRUNC 0x400
21287 O_EXCL 0x800
21288 @end smallexample
21289
21290 @node mode_t values
21291 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t values
21292 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
21293
21294 All values are given in octal representation.
21295
21296 @smallexample
21297 S_IFREG 0100000
21298 S_IFDIR 040000
21299 S_IRUSR 0400
21300 S_IWUSR 0200
21301 S_IXUSR 0100
21302 S_IRGRP 040
21303 S_IWGRP 020
21304 S_IXGRP 010
21305 S_IROTH 04
21306 S_IWOTH 02
21307 S_IXOTH 01
21308 @end smallexample
21309
21310 @node Errno values
21311 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno values
21312 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
21313
21314 All values are given in decimal representation.
21315
21316 @smallexample
21317 EPERM 1
21318 ENOENT 2
21319 EINTR 4
21320 EBADF 9
21321 EACCES 13
21322 EFAULT 14
21323 EBUSY 16
21324 EEXIST 17
21325 ENODEV 19
21326 ENOTDIR 20
21327 EISDIR 21
21328 EINVAL 22
21329 ENFILE 23
21330 EMFILE 24
21331 EFBIG 27
21332 ENOSPC 28
21333 ESPIPE 29
21334 EROFS 30
21335 ENAMETOOLONG 91
21336 EUNKNOWN 9999
21337 @end smallexample
21338
21339 EUNKNOWN is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
21340 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
21341
21342 @node Lseek flags
21343 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek flags
21344 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
21345
21346 @smallexample
21347 SEEK_SET 0
21348 SEEK_CUR 1
21349 SEEK_END 2
21350 @end smallexample
21351
21352 @node Limits
21353 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
21354 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
21355
21356 All values are given in decimal representation.
21357
21358 @smallexample
21359 INT_MIN -2147483648
21360 INT_MAX 2147483647
21361 UINT_MAX 4294967295
21362 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
21363 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
21364 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
21365 @end smallexample
21366
21367 @node File-I/O Examples
21368 @subsection File-I/O Examples
21369 @cindex file-i/o examples
21370
21371 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
21372 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
21373
21374 @smallexample
21375 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
21376 @emph{request memory read from target}
21377 -> @code{m1234,6}
21378 <- XXXXXX
21379 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
21380 -> @code{F6}
21381 @end smallexample
21382
21383 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
21384 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
21385
21386 @smallexample
21387 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
21388 @emph{request memory write to target}
21389 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
21390 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
21391 -> @code{F6}
21392 @end smallexample
21393
21394 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
21395 file descriptor (EBADF):
21396
21397 @smallexample
21398 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
21399 -> @code{F-1,9}
21400 @end smallexample
21401
21402 Example sequence of a read call, user presses Ctrl-C before syscall on
21403 host is called:
21404
21405 @smallexample
21406 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
21407 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
21408 <- @code{T02}
21409 @end smallexample
21410
21411 Example sequence of a read call, user presses Ctrl-C after syscall on
21412 host is called:
21413
21414 @smallexample
21415 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
21416 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
21417 <- @code{T02}
21418 @end smallexample
21419
21420 @include agentexpr.texi
21421
21422 @include gpl.texi
21423
21424 @include fdl.texi
21425
21426 @node Index
21427 @unnumbered Index
21428
21429 @printindex cp
21430
21431 @tex
21432 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
21433 % meantime:
21434 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
21435 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
21436 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
21437 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
21438 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
21439 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
21440 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
21441 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
21442 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
21443 \page\colophon
21444 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
21445 @end tex
21446
21447 @bye
This page took 0.473688 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.